A Tribute to 60 IPI World Press Freedom Heroes
Transcription
A Tribute to 60 IPI World Press Freedom Heroes
WOrDs OF FrEEDOM A Tribute to 60 IPI World Press Freedom Heroes ISBN 978-3-9503007-0-3 WOrDs OF FrEEDOM A Tribute to 60 IPI World Press Freedom Heroes Words of Freedom · A Tribute to 60 IPI World Press Freedom Heroes WOrDs OF FrEEDOM A Tribute to 60 IPI World Press Freedom Heroes This book is brought to you with the friendly support of Words of Freedom: A Tribute to 60 IPI Press Freedom Heroes ISBN 978-3-9503007-0-3 Publisher: The International Press Institute Spiegelgasse 2 1010 Vienna Austria Ph.: (43) 1 5129011 Fax: (43) 1 5129014 Email: ipi@freemedia.at Printed by: Lindenau Productions, 1030 Vienna, Austria Cover photo: gettyimages All rights reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopying, recording, or by any information storage and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher. 4 INternatIonal Press InstItute The Vienna-based International Press Institute (IPI) is a global network of editors, media executives and leading journalists. It is dedicated to the furtherance and safeguarding of press freedom, the protection of freedom of opinion and expression, the promotion of the free flow of news and information and the improvement of the practices of journalism. For more information on IPI and its work, write to: International Press Institute Spiegelgasse 2/29 1010 Vienna Austria ipi@freemedia.at www.freemedia.at. In 2010, IPI celebrated its 60-year anniversary. This publication featuring IPI’s 60 World Press Freedom Heroes is a tribute to that year-long celebration and to the journalists who fight for and uphold IPI’s values. 5 CORPORATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 60 ET SEQ. OF THE SWIS AND RADIO AND TV SYSTEMS FOUNDATIONS, OTHER INSTITUT OFTHENETEARNINGS,IFANY,OFTHEINSTITUTESHALLENURET H: PUBLICATIONS, SEMINARS, CONFERENCES, EXCHANGE PRO VIDEOS AND ELECTRONIC MATERIAL ON THE INTERNET, THE SE RYING OUT THESE PURPOSES, THE INSTITUTE SHALL PROMOT OR NATIONAL COMMITTEE ASSUMES ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL OR NALCOMMITTEE.¶ARTICLEII¶MEMBERSHIP¶1.FULLMEMBE YJOURNALS,NEWSAGENCIESORTVANDRADIOBROADCASTIN TUTESOBJECTIVESANDWHO,INSEEKINGMEMBERSHIP,DECL EAMBLEABOVE.¶2.FULLMEMBERSHIPCANBEACQUIREDAS LONESHALLHAVETHEPOWERTOINITIALLYDETERMINEWHET LLBEMADETOTHEINSTITUTE’SDIRECTOR,WHOALONESHALL TIMATE AUTHORITY OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶ 3. MEMBERS A NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NEWS AGENCY, TV OR RADIO BROA TERNET SERVICE MAY BE REPRESENTED BY MORE THAN ONE F ESOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESSANDDESIROUSOFCO-OPERATIN MEMBERSOFJOURNALISMFACULTIES,LAWYERSANDADVISO F DEPARTMENTS/SECTIONS OF NEWSPAPERS, MAGAZINES, BR RENTAFFAIRSPROGRAMMEEDITORSORPRESENTERS,PERSON LISTS GROUP) FROM ANY ONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, RADIO D PROVIDING THE APPLICANTS PROCURE WRITTEN APPROVAL RE NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BE MADE TO S.INCOUNTRIESWHERETHEREARENONATIONALCOMMITTEE NEWHETHERORNOTTOENROLTHEAPPLICANTS.INALLCASES ATE IN ALL THE ACTIVITIES OF THE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY SHAL EMEMBERSHIPSHALLBEHALFTHEDUESFORASSOCIATEMEM AND 2, TO COMMUNICATIONS DEPARTMENTS OF UNIVERSITI ADCASTINGFIELDS.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSMAYPARTICIPA UTHORITYOFTHEEXECUTIVEBOARD.THENUMBEROFTHEIRD EEXECUTIVEBOARD.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSSHALLHAVEN THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL BE FIXED BY THE DIRECTOR WIT WHOSHALLACTCONTRARYTOTHEPRINCIPLESSETOUTINTHE BOARD, BUT EXPULSION SHALL NOT BE ORDERED EXCEPT ON TOGETHER WITH THE STATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED CAUSES, SH OARDSHALLBEGRANTEDTOSUCHMEMBER,IFTHATMEMBERS EXT GENERAL ASSEMBLY IN WHICH CASE A MAJORITY VOTE O BEROFTHEINSTITUTE;NOTICEOFSUCHACTIONSHALLBEGIVE SOBLIGATIONSTOTHEINSTITUTE,UPTOTHETIMETHATMEMB ONSIDERSTHATTHEREISFUNDAMENTALCHANGEINTHECOND LEIIOFTHEPRESENTCONSTITUTION.¶ARTICLEIII¶NATIONALC Contents 9 11 13 15 Foreword Introduction Sponsor’s Note Preamble of the Constitution of the International Press Institute 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32 34 36 38 40 42 44 46 48 50 52 54 56 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 74 76 78 80 82 84 86 88 90 92 94 Aslam Ali Rudolf Augstein Omar Belhouchet Kenneth Best Hubert Beuve-Méry J. Jesús Blancornelas Grémah Boukar Koura José Burgos, Jr. Lydia Cacho Guillermo Cano Juan Pablo Cárdenas Pedro Joaquín Chamorro May Chidiac Suk-Chae Choi Júlio de Mesquita Neto Jiří Dienstbier Hrant Dink Harold Evans Antonio Fontán Laurence Gandar Akbar Ganji Gao Yu Katharine Graham Veronica Guerin Shiro Hara Amira Hass Tara Singh Hayer Đoàn Viê´t Hoa.t Abdi İpekçi Kemal Kurspahić Daoud Kuttab Gwen Lister Mochtar Lubis Kronid Lyubarsky Savea Sano Malifa Veran Matić Adam Michnik Fred M'membe Indro Montanelli Nizar Nayouf 96 98 100 102 104 106 108 110 112 114 116 118 120 122 124 126 128 130 132 134 Freedom Neruda Pius Njawé Germán Ornes Anna Politkovskaya Percy Qoboza Raúl Rivero Nuno Rocha Pap Saine Yoani Sánchez Faraj Sarkohi Nedim Şener Arun Shourie André Sibomana U Thaung Jacobo Timerman Ricardo Uceda Eleni Vlachou Lasantha Wickrematunge C.E.L Wickremesinghe José Rubén Zamora 137 139 141 143 145 Editor’s Note Contributors and authors Production credits Photo credits Index E;INSTITUTINTERNATIONALDELAPRESSE,INFRENCH;INSTIT UTE. ¶ 3. THE OFFICIAL LANGUAGES OF THE INSTITUTE SHALL B IP CORPORATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 60 ET SEQ. OF THE SW RS AND RADIO AND TV SYSTEMS FOUNDATIONS, OTHER INSTIT RTOFTHENETEARNINGS,IFANY,OFTHEINSTITUTESHALLENUR UGH: PUBLICATIONS, SEMINARS, CONFERENCES, EXCHANGE P OR VIDEOS AND ELECTRONIC MATERIAL ON THE INTERNET, THE ARRYING OUT THESE PURPOSES, THE INSTITUTE SHALL PROM ER OR NATIONAL COMMITTEE ASSUMES ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL TIONALCOMMITTEE.¶ARTICLEII¶MEMBERSHIP¶1.FULLMEM HLYJOURNALS,NEWSAGENCIESORTVANDRADIOBROADCAS STITUTESOBJECTIVESANDWHO,INSEEKINGMEMBERSHIP,D PREAMBLEABOVE.¶2.FULLMEMBERSHIPCANBEACQUIREDA HALONESHALLHAVETHEPOWERTOINITIALLYDETERMINEWH HALLBEMADETOTHEINSTITUTE’SDIRECTOR,WHOALONESHA E ULTIMATE AUTHORITY OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶ 3. MEMB OF A NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NEWS AGENCY, TV OR RADIO BR INTERNET SERVICE MAY BE REPRESENTED BY MORE THAN ON IPLESOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESSANDDESIROUSOFCO-OPERA S,MEMBERSOFJOURNALISMFACULTIES,LAWYERSANDADVI S OF DEPARTMENTS/SECTIONS OF NEWSPAPERS, MAGAZINES URRENTAFFAIRSPROGRAMMEEDITORSORPRESENTERS,PERS NALISTS GROUP) FROM ANY ONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, RA TED PROVIDING THE APPLICANTS PROCURE WRITTEN APPROV ARE NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BE MADE NTS.INCOUNTRIESWHERETHEREARENONATIONALCOMMITT MINEWHETHERORNOTTOENROLTHEAPPLICANTS.INALLCA CIPATE IN ALL THE ACTIVITIES OF THE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY SH ATEMEMBERSHIPSHALLBEHALFTHEDUESFORASSOCIATEM HS 1 AND 2, TO COMMUNICATIONS DEPARTMENTS OF UNIVERS ROADCASTINGFIELDS.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSMAYPARTIC EAUTHORITYOFTHEEXECUTIVEBOARD.THENUMBEROFTHEI THEEXECUTIVEBOARD.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSSHALLHAV BY THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL BE FIXED BY THE DIRECTOR W TEWHOSHALLACTCONTRARYTOTHEPRINCIPLESSETOUTIN VE BOARD, BUT EXPULSION SHALL NOT BE ORDERED EXCEPT O N, TOGETHER WITH THE STATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED CAUSES EBOARDSHALLBEGRANTEDTOSUCHMEMBER,IFTHATMEMBE E NEXT GENERAL ASSEMBLY IN WHICH CASE A MAJORITY VOT EMBEROFTHEINSTITUTE;NOTICEOFSUCHACTIONSHALLBEG RHISOBLIGATIONSTOTHEINSTITUTE,UPTOTHETIMETHATME foreWord Ten years ago I had the pleasure of helping a committee of International Press Institute members choose editors, journalists and publishers for inclusion in a booklet of 50 press freedom heroes, commemorating the 50th anniversary of the institute. The celebration of those 50 heroes took place in Boston in the United States of America. This year that list is extended to 60 heroes to celebrate IPI’s 60th anniversary. Indeed it is a great honour being part of such an admirable endeavour to create a journalism pantheon which, I believe, is the first of its kind. It rectifies a long-standing omission by the press to create a permanent record of a representative group of the remarkable men and women throughout the world who fought great – sometimes insurmountable – odds in carrying out their duty to uphold press freedom and keep the public informed. But there was heartache, too, and it was brought on by the recognition that there were so many journalists who showed immense determination and courage in both unearthing the information and publishing it while so many powerful, often ruthless and brutal, forces were ranged against them. There were so many and yet we have been able to recognise only a few. We had to make anguished choices. The heartache was even more painful as we read of their achievements, invariably astounding and always defying those in authority and powerful criminal mafias who sought secrecy and used every means, no matter how foul, they could muster to try to ensure it. These were men and women who had set off on a career in journalism, pen or keyboard in hand, who felt and believed, almost instinctively, that the search for truth and its speedy dissemination to the public at large transcended attempts to keep matters secret and the public in ignorance. And those pens and keyboards were the only instruments they had which they could use against authoritarian dictates to keep silent the guns, bludgeons, instruments of torture and prison bars that were ranged against them. Journalists are a singular breed of people. Their work is regarded as a civilian activity which normally requires people engaged in that sphere merely adequately to apply themselves to the job at hand. There may be instances, not frequent, where a call is made on them to exhibit courage and steadfastness in meeting the ethical standards their jobs require. But journalists are almost constantly facing challenges because they are confronted by a society where there is a persistent undercurrent of officialdom and commercial interests seeking to keep information about maladministration, corruption and other wrong-doing secret. And that is the information that journalists believe the public has a right to know about. The dangers facing journalists have been growing and records show that an ever-increasing number of them are killed in the line of duty. But there are also numerous journalists who are threatened, arrested, detained, beaten up and tortured, sometimes with their papers or broadcast stations being attacked or closed down. It is a remarkable testimony to their courage that they carry on delving for the truth despite the attacks on them. The salient feature of all these stories is that in every one of these journalists was a solitary combatant. They were not part of an army or a group. Most had support from their news organisations but when it came to the knife-edge issue, every one of them was on their own. Three categories of heroes were chosen: * Press Freedom Defenders: persons who have made a significant contribution to press freedom by providing independent news coverage, opinions and views under difficult and often dangerous conditions. To defend press freedom, they have risked arrest, imprisonment and violence against themselves and their families. * The Victims of Press Freedom Violations: persons who were deliberately targeted and killed, because of their work or opinions. * Press Freedom Promoters & Protectors: persons who have (a) made critical contributions to press freedom on a global basis; or (b) profoundly strengthened the free press in their own country, often risking their careers and/or professional reputations in the process. My thanks go to the jury who made the current selections: IPI board members Mr. N. Ravi, editor, The Hindu, India; Ms. Galina Sidorova, editor-inchief, Sovershenno Sekrento, Russia, Ms. Ferai Tinç, columnist, Hurriyet Daily, Turkey; and IPI Fellow, Mr. H. David S. Greenway, columnist and former editorial page editor, The Boston Globe, USA. Raymond Louw, editor and publisher, Southern Africa Report, South Africa 9 E;INSTITUTINTERNATIONALDELAPRESSE,INFRENCH;INSTIT UTE. ¶ 3. THE OFFICIAL LANGUAGES OF THE INSTITUTE SHALL B IP CORPORATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 60 ET SEQ. OF THE SW RS AND RADIO AND TV SYSTEMS FOUNDATIONS, OTHER INSTIT RTOFTHENETEARNINGS,IFANY,OFTHEINSTITUTESHALLENUR UGH: PUBLICATIONS, SEMINARS, CONFERENCES, EXCHANGE P OR VIDEOS AND ELECTRONIC MATERIAL ON THE INTERNET, THE ARRYING OUT THESE PURPOSES, THE INSTITUTE SHALL PROM ER OR NATIONAL COMMITTEE ASSUMES ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL TIONALCOMMITTEE.¶ARTICLEII¶MEMBERSHIP¶1.FULLMEM HLYJOURNALS,NEWSAGENCIESORTVANDRADIOBROADCAS STITUTESOBJECTIVESANDWHO,INSEEKINGMEMBERSHIP,D PREAMBLEABOVE.¶2.FULLMEMBERSHIPCANBEACQUIREDA HALONESHALLHAVETHEPOWERTOINITIALLYDETERMINEWH HALLBEMADETOTHEINSTITUTE’SDIRECTOR,WHOALONESHA E ULTIMATE AUTHORITY OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶ 3. MEMB OF A NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NEWS AGENCY, TV OR RADIO BR INTERNET SERVICE MAY BE REPRESENTED BY MORE THAN ON IPLESOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESSANDDESIROUSOFCO-OPERA S,MEMBERSOFJOURNALISMFACULTIES,LAWYERSANDADVI S OF DEPARTMENTS/SECTIONS OF NEWSPAPERS, MAGAZINES URRENTAFFAIRSPROGRAMMEEDITORSORPRESENTERS,PERS NALISTS GROUP) FROM ANY ONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, RA TED PROVIDING THE APPLICANTS PROCURE WRITTEN APPROV ARE NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BE MADE NTS.INCOUNTRIESWHERETHEREARENONATIONALCOMMITT MINEWHETHERORNOTTOENROLTHEAPPLICANTS.INALLCA CIPATE IN ALL THE ACTIVITIES OF THE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY SH ATEMEMBERSHIPSHALLBEHALFTHEDUESFORASSOCIATEM HS 1 AND 2, TO COMMUNICATIONS DEPARTMENTS OF UNIVERS ROADCASTINGFIELDS.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSMAYPARTIC EAUTHORITYOFTHEEXECUTIVEBOARD.THENUMBEROFTHEI THEEXECUTIVEBOARD.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSSHALLHAV BY THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL BE FIXED BY THE DIRECTOR W TEWHOSHALLACTCONTRARYTOTHEPRINCIPLESSETOUTIN VE BOARD, BUT EXPULSION SHALL NOT BE ORDERED EXCEPT O N, TOGETHER WITH THE STATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED CAUSES EBOARDSHALLBEGRANTEDTOSUCHMEMBER,IFTHATMEMBE E NEXT GENERAL ASSEMBLY IN WHICH CASE A MAJORITY VOT EMBEROFTHEINSTITUTE;NOTICEOFSUCHACTIONSHALLBEG RHISOBLIGATIONSTOTHEINSTITUTE,UPTOTHETIMETHATME the undyIng flame of Press freedom Ten years ago in Boston, in a solemn ceremony marking its 50th year defending press freedom around the world, IPI honoured 50 World Press Freedom Heroes. They came from the four corners of the globe and were united by one golden common thread: their courageous determination to uphold press freedom, against all odds. If their nemeses – the killers, torturers, kidnappers, jailers and corrupt security and judicial officials – were hoping to make an example of them, and in doing so to deter those who would follow in their footsteps, they have resoundingly failed. Despite the perils associated with critical independent reporting and the harrowing tales of those who have taken on the oft corrupt repressive establishment, there is no shortage of bold reporters surging forward to push back the proverbial barricades. In doing so, they confirm that the force for freedom – embodied by reporters risking death, violent attack, torture, intimidation, unjust trial and imprisonment – is unstoppable. That force will not bow to the tactics of those who would prefer the truth to remain untold, and who use assassins and thugs shrouded in the cowardly cloak of impunity, to further this goal. The additional 10 World Press Freedom Heroes, chosen by IPI to make a full 60, in the organisation’s 60th anniversary year, bear further powerful testimony to this remarkable resilience. Only seven of the 10 new heroes are still alive. One is maimed for life. All have imprinted themselves on the consciousness of humanity. IPI’s 60 World Press Freedom Heroes are but the tip of the iceberg. They are flanked by many, many more brave journalists, who are no less courageous. In naming 60 World Press Freedom Heroes, IPI pays tribute to all of those journalists – including the many unsung heroes – who through their refusal to toe the line are keeping the flame of press freedom alive. International Press Institute Secretariat Vienna 11 E;INSTITUTINTERNATIONALDELAPRESSE,INFRENCH;INSTIT UTE. ¶ 3. THE OFFICIAL LANGUAGES OF THE INSTITUTE SHALL B IP CORPORATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 60 ET SEQ. OF THE SW RS AND RADIO AND TV SYSTEMS FOUNDATIONS, OTHER INSTIT RTOFTHENETEARNINGS,IFANY,OFTHEINSTITUTESHALLENUR UGH: PUBLICATIONS, SEMINARS, CONFERENCES, EXCHANGE P OR VIDEOS AND ELECTRONIC MATERIAL ON THE INTERNET, THE ARRYING OUT THESE PURPOSES, THE INSTITUTE SHALL PROM ER OR NATIONAL COMMITTEE ASSUMES ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL TIONALCOMMITTEE.¶ARTICLEII¶MEMBERSHIP¶1.FULLMEM HLYJOURNALS,NEWSAGENCIESORTVANDRADIOBROADCAS STITUTESOBJECTIVESANDWHO,INSEEKINGMEMBERSHIP,D PREAMBLEABOVE.¶2.FULLMEMBERSHIPCANBEACQUIREDA HALONESHALLHAVETHEPOWERTOINITIALLYDETERMINEWH HALLBEMADETOTHEINSTITUTE’SDIRECTOR,WHOALONESHA E ULTIMATE AUTHORITY OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶ 3. MEMB OF A NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NEWS AGENCY, TV OR RADIO BR INTERNET SERVICE MAY BE REPRESENTED BY MORE THAN ON IPLESOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESSANDDESIROUSOFCO-OPERA S,MEMBERSOFJOURNALISMFACULTIES,LAWYERSANDADVI S OF DEPARTMENTS/SECTIONS OF NEWSPAPERS, MAGAZINES URRENTAFFAIRSPROGRAMMEEDITORSORPRESENTERS,PERS NALISTS GROUP) FROM ANY ONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, RA TED PROVIDING THE APPLICANTS PROCURE WRITTEN APPROV ARE NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BE MADE NTS.INCOUNTRIESWHERETHEREARENONATIONALCOMMITT MINEWHETHERORNOTTOENROLTHEAPPLICANTS.INALLCA CIPATE IN ALL THE ACTIVITIES OF THE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY SH ATEMEMBERSHIPSHALLBEHALFTHEDUESFORASSOCIATEM HS 1 AND 2, TO COMMUNICATIONS DEPARTMENTS OF UNIVERS ROADCASTINGFIELDS.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSMAYPARTIC EAUTHORITYOFTHEEXECUTIVEBOARD.THENUMBEROFTHEI THEEXECUTIVEBOARD.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSSHALLHAV BY THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL BE FIXED BY THE DIRECTOR W TEWHOSHALLACTCONTRARYTOTHEPRINCIPLESSETOUTIN VE BOARD, BUT EXPULSION SHALL NOT BE ORDERED EXCEPT O N, TOGETHER WITH THE STATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED CAUSES EBOARDSHALLBEGRANTEDTOSUCHMEMBER,IFTHATMEMBE E NEXT GENERAL ASSEMBLY IN WHICH CASE A MAJORITY VOT EMBEROFTHEINSTITUTE;NOTICEOFSUCHACTIONSHALLBEG RHISOBLIGATIONSTOTHEINSTITUTE,UPTOTHETIMETHATME heroes to all of us Those of us in the financial and business worlds may not always agree with what we see in the press, but I know we can agree that freedom of the press is one of the strongest pillars of a free society. People who live in democracies tend to take this freedom for granted. But in today’s complex, interconnected world where the truth of what is happening in one country can affect decisions made in many other nations, freedom of information takes on a new, more global meaning. It is something we must continually fight to preserve, for we know it is what those who would restrict our freedom fear most. As Napoleon Bonaparte once said, “I fear the newspapers more than a hundred thousand bayonets.” That is why the heroes in this book are, in fact, heroes to all of us. They are fighting for a free- dom that we cherish. That freedom will always be tested, sometimes abused, occasionally restricted. But the search for truth – the shining of a light into the dark corners of the world – will always be fundamental to our individual liberty, and to our right to know. Without the truth it is impossible to have a just society and intelligent, informed people. I congratulate the International Press Institute for its 60 years of fighting for press freedom, and for giving us this book. It reminds us that the members of the press are heroes to us all. Alessandro Profumo Chief Executive, UniCredit Group 13 GUNDERSTAND BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARETHAT TO UND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL T ANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO¶BRING ABOUT UNDERSTAND URNALISTS OF THE WORLD. IN ACCORDANCE WITH T WARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶•THEFURTHERANC PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TOVIEWS. THE NEW LICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF ¶ OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ •T SIFAND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF TH PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSEN DERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IFTHE PEO ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF G¶PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMO •THEFURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OFFREEDOM O RESSION OFFURTHERANCE VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDI ES: ¶ • THE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FR ONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST THER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEND NALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIE G OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE A FORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTAND MENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGSTTHE JOURNALISTS ANDOB SO GANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS FOLLOWING NT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DE UBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VS YHAVEGOODINFORMATION. THEREFORE, AFUNDAMENTAL RDANCE WITH THIS BELIEFNATIONS.¶ THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORG ALANCED NEWS AMONG • THE IMPROVEM WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TOHAVE THE NEWS, FREE TRANS ER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY GOOD INFORMA T JOURNALISTS AND SOWITH AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTI D. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE THIS BELIEF THERE ISBETWE ESTAB ISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDING RE,A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMO NT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION STABLISHED ANORGANISATION TOFREE WORK TOWARDSTHE FO S.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE EXCHANGE OF AN WS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF EN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERA ¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE ANDING BETWEEN PEOPLESANDPEOPLES. IFPEOPLES ARETO RING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNA ANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTAND ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE P WARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANC EMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALIS LICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ •T CES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UN IF PEOPLES ARE TOSTEP UNDERSTAND ONEUNDERSTANDING ANOTHER, IT IS ESSEN FUNDAMENTAL TOWARDS A ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE ISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJEO ¶•THEFURTHERANCE ANDSAFEGUARDING OFFREEDOM RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDI UBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF V ONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF•THE PRACTICES OF ALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ THE IMPROVEM THER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION ER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT HAVE GOOD NALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ INTHEY ACCORDANCE WITHINFORMA THIS BELIE G¶OF FREEDOM OF THEWITH PRESS,THIS BY WHICH ISTHERE MEANT: FREE A D. IN ACCORDANCE BELIEF IS ESTAB MENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO NT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION NT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DE • THE PROMOTION OFTHEREFORE, THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AS YS.¶ HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. AFUNDAMENTAL PreamBle to the ConstItutIon of the InternatIonal Press InstItute World peace depends on understanding between peoples and peoples. If peoples are to understand one another, it is essential that they have good information. Therefore, a fundamental step towards understanding among peoples is to bring about understanding among the journalists of the world. In accordance with this belief there is established an organisation to work towards the following objectives: • The furtherance and safeguarding of freedom of the press, by which is meant: free access to the news, free transmission of news, free publication of newspapers, free expression of views • The achievement of understanding amongst journalists and so among peoples • The promotion of the free exchange of accurate and balanced news among nations • The improvement of the practices of journalism The words of the preamble are set as a backdrop for the ensuing photo pages 15 LOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGO NOFVIEWS.¶•THEACHIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGST ENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEND TION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTAN LISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING O OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION CCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPRO TANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFO TSOFTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISES Y WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSIO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE O DINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERS S IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIST E FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS HIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSO ESOFJOURNALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDIN UNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLES ONTOWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURT ON OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVE NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE SSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A F ORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISA ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLIC PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALAN LES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER UT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS ME OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PE OURNALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETW MENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH ON OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVE NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE SSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A F ORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISA ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLIC PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALAN LES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER IAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD IN aslam LD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHT alI S,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREEA OURNALISTS AND SO AMONG RTICLE I ¶ GENERAL ¶ 1. THE O RTICLEXIXINTHEUNUNIVER a TITUTINTERNATIONALDELA ¶ 3. THE OFFICIAL LANGUAGE RPORATION PURSUANT TO S D RADIO AND TV SYSTEMS FO THENETEARNINGS,IFANY,OF UBLICATIONS, SEMINARS, C EOS AND ELECTRONIC MATER NG OUT THESE PURPOSES, T NATIONAL COMMITTEE ASSU ALCOMMITTEE.¶ARTICLEII¶ OURNALS,NEWSAGENCIESO TESOBJECTIVESANDWHO,I Left: Aslam Ali, a family man, in happier days with his wife. Bottom right: Ali, seated second from left, with senior management of Pakistan Press International news agency. PAKISTAN 1924–1978 slam Ali is my hero, not only because he was my father, but also because he stood up for the journalistic principles of independence, fairness and objectivity when few dared to do so. When Pakistan Press International (PPI) was snatched from my father, I was at the impressionable age of 17. It was from him that I understood first-hand why it was so important to defend peoples’ right to speak, hear and publish, even if the effort destroyed you physically, emotionally and financially. PPI was set up in 1956 by Muazzam Ali. Aslam Ali joined the agency in 1964. During its existence the agency has had to face many threats. Surviving crisis after crisis, facing stoppage of telecommunication services and threats of closure, PPI continued to professionally cover the mass public movement against the government of General Ayub Khan. This independence was maintained despite pressure from Zulfiqar Ali Bhutto to toe the line of his Pakistan Peoples Party (PPP). PPI’s unwillingness to yield to these pressures was deeply resented by Bhutto. He expressed his annoyance with the agency not only privately, but also in public. At a press conference in Lahore on 3 March 1970, Bhutto threatened that Muazzam Ali and PPI would be “fixed up.” His comments led to a partial walkout by the newsmen covering the press conference. Bhutto continued his attacks on PPI, issuing wild allegations against it. When Aslam Ali, then General Manager of PPI, protested against the militant attitude of Bhutto, Bhutto’s party responded by organising rowdy demonstrations in front of PPI’s office to ‘protest’ against the agency. Upon assuming power in 1971, the Bhutto government became more aggressive. Maulana Kausar Niazi, minister of information and broad- casting, warned Muazzam Ali of “serious consequences” if the agency circulated stories against the government. When PPI continued its policy of independent political coverage, the Bhutto government set out to destroy PPI through various coercive measures to financially cripple it, ordering the suspension of the agency’s service to the government-controlled radio, television and the newspapers of the National Press Trust (NPT). Having failed to achieve the demise of PPI through financial strangulation, Bhutto ordered the agency taken away from the owners. The prime minister’s special assistant, Yousuf Buch, was assigned the task of preparing the plan for the transfer of PPI to a member of PPP. The chief minister of Sindh, Ghulam Mustafa Jatoi, in March 1975, directed Aslam Ali to transfer the shares of the agency to Latif Ibrahim Jamal. Jatoi warned that if the agency was not transferred, he had orders to proceed against Aslam Ali under the draconian emergency laws. Aslam Ali, however, declined to transfer the agency. After this refusal, Ali had to bear the full wrath of the government. Telephone and teleprinter lines of the agency would be disconnected without notice. Threats of arrest and assault became a painful routine. Telephone calls, in the middle of the night, were made, informing that police parties had been dispatched to arrest him. Such relentless harassment irreparably damaged Ali’s health. In a matter of just a few weeks he dropped from 145 pounds to barely 100 pounds, and lost most of his hair. He had aged years in such a short period, not only physically but also in spirit. The deterioration of his health was so dramatic and rapid that his family feared for his life. But Ali remained adamant that he would not compromise on the principles that had made PPI a respected name not only in Pakistan but also throughout the world. When the government realised it could not subdue Aslam Ali through financial pressures or threats to his person, they resorted to the ultimate act of cowardice – they threatened his family. S.N. Qutub, joint secretary of the Ministry of Information and Broadcasting, delivered the message to Ali that he should carefully consider the consequences of his refusal, especially since he had a wife and four young daughters. This threat to his family was too much to bear and Aslam Ali agreed to transfer the shares to the PPP nominee. PPI was transferred on 11 April 1975 for a paltry 163,000 rupees (about $3,000 USD); its true worth was hundreds of times that amount. The level of vengeance was such that even when Aslam Ali was advised by doctors to go abroad for treatment for diabetic complications, he was informed that his name was on the ‘exit control list,’ and that he would not be allowed to leave the country until he repented and apologised to the government. Ali refused. After the fall of the Bhutto government, the owners made an application to the authorities for the return of PPI as the transfer was made under duress and coercion. The appointed arbitrator ruled that the transfer had been illegal and the agency be returned to the original owners. Aslam Ali put his heart and soul into reviving the agency and, by maintaining a punishing schedule and long working hours, succeeded in reorganising the agency. Unfortunately, years of harassment had irreparably damaged his health, and he died on 13 February 1978, just three months after the agency was restored, at the age of 54. Written by Owais Aslam Ali, son of Aslam Ali and secretary general of the Pakistan Press Foundation. 17 rUdolf augsteIn GERMANY 1923–2002 Top to bottom: Rudolf Augstein being interviewed after his release from pre-trial detention, 1953; gesturing during a panel discussion; shortly after being arrested by criminal police in 1962. 18 d er Spiegel (The Mirror) was dubbed by its founder and owner Rudolf Augstein as “the heavy artillery of democracy.” Established immediately after World War II, it quickly became one of Germany’s most important publications, pioneering investigative reporting that uncovered cases that stunned the country and inspired press freedom after years of manipulative propaganda. The sixth of seven children, Augstein was born to a Catholic merchant on 5 November 1923 in Hanover, Germany. At the age of 9, he witnessed the rise of the Nazis, but Augstein’s bourgeois parents sent their son across town to a grammar school over which the Nazis had little influence. Even as a child Rudolf showed an aptitude for politics when in a school essay he commented that a German victory was unlikely. When he finished grammar school at 18, Augstein volunteered to write for the Hannoverschen Anzeiger (Hanover Gazette). Drafted into the army as a radio operator then artillery observer, he was sent to the Eastern Front until he was captured as a prisoner of war by the Allies in 1945. Upon his release at the end of the war, he charged into a career in journalism with the Hannoverschen Nachrichtenblatt (Hanover Newspaper). In an attempt to reach out to German civilians blundering in a post-war daze, the British occupiers launched Diese Woche (This Week) on 16 November 1946. At 23, young Augstein was politically spotless, so, making use of his, albeit scant, background in journalism, the British soon named him both publisher and editor-inchief, re-launching the news magazine as Der Spiegel on 4 January 1947. Within months, Augstein had created a formidable team of investigative reporters, whose eloquent writing and penetrating rummaging resulted in exquisite exposés of government corruption and ineptitude. As editor in chief, Augstein was often called to court to answer for articles he had published that wandered a little too close to the line. While others shied away from such controversy, Augstein was proud to face it head on. In 1962, he revealed that the army was in such a financial mess that it would be incapable of defending the country in the event of a communist attack; ordinarily, considering the state of post-war Germany, this would not have been a surprise, until one became aware of the exorbitant funds funnelled into Defence Minister Franz Josef Strauss’ budget. On 26 October 1962, 60 federal police stormed Der Spiegel’s new Hamburg office and arrested three of the magazine’s staff. Clearly incensed, the German police also issued a warrant for the magazine’s defence specialist, Conrad Ahlers, who had written the offending article and was arrested while holidaying in Spain. In essence, Ahlers exposed the secret NATO exercise ‘Fallex 62’ and alleged that the Western Alliance estimated a potential 15 million British and German civilian deaths and casualties in the event of an atomic war. By his calculations, Ahlers claimed West Germany was woefully under-prepared for such a catastrophe. Handing himself over to authorities on 27 October 1962, Augstein was arrested to the sound of worldwide protests and condemnation. Terrified of a return to the autocratic regime Adolf Hitler had imposed just a few years earlier, the German public took to the streets to defend their democratic liberties and right to a free, transparent press. So virulent was the public reaction to the government’s role in the closure of Der Spiegel and Augstein’s arrest that Strauss had to resign in December 1962. Der Spiegel fought to print the following week’s edition and continued to provide intelligent, pertinent reporting despite its presses being closed. Augstein’s story, however, had a little longer to play out. Incarcerated for treason for 104 days, he was released on 14 May 1965 when the accusations were proven unfounded. Continuing to be a powerful contributor to Germany’s recovery and development, Der Spiegel’s sententious reporting has won it widespread respect and established itself as one of Europe’s biggest selling dailies – with a circulation of more than a million each week. Over the years, Augstein had slowly been increasing his shares in the paper; by 1969, he finally bought out the last remaining share-holder, Günter Gaus, to become sole owner of Der Spiegel. Augstein continued to move the news magazine forward, starting TV programmes with the German stations RTL and SAT1. In recognition of his commitment to journalism, he was awarded two honorary degrees – one from the University of Bath in the United Kingdom and the other from Germany’s University of Wuppertal. As a hobbyist historian he published several bestseller books, and in December 1999, Augstein, who still wrote his hard-hitting column for his beloved publication, was named Journalist of the Century by 100 prominent German journalists. Following a lifetime of significant contributions to the defence and promotion of press freedom, two years before his death of pneumonia on 7 November 2002, aged 79, Augstein was heralded a hero by the International Press Institute. IAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, AFREE FUNDAM UrtHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OFFREEDOM OFTHE PRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREE ACCESSTOTHENEWS, TRANSMISSION ENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OFACCUR LD. ¶INACCORDANCE WITHTHIS BELIEF THERE ISIFESTABLISHED ANONO OURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND MENTAL TOWARDSUNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISTOBRINGABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTSOFTH S,WORK BYSTEP WHICH ISMEANT: FREE ACCESS NEWS, FREE TRANSMISS O TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCETO ANDTHE SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHIC OURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES. ¶ · THE PROMOTION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTSOF ANDTHE SO AMOF EWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING RTICLE ¶ GENERAL ¶ 1. THE ORGANISATION DEFENDS EVERYONE’S SENTIALTHATITHEY HAVEGOODINFORMATION. THEREFORE, AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONGPEOPLES RDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶•THEFURT RTICLE XIXFREE INTRANSMISSION THEUNOF UNIVERSAL DECLARATION OFHUMAN ESS TO THE NEWS, NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS.RIGHTS, ¶ • THE ACHIEVE TITUT DEANOTHER, LA PRESSE, FRENCH; INSTITUTO OMOTIONINTERNATIONAL OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWSIN AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OFINTERN THE PRACTIC D PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, AFUN ¶UARDING 3. THE OFFICIAL LANGUAGES THE INSTITUTE SHALL BE ENGLISH STANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ INOF ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATI OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREEOF TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLIC RPORATION PURSUANT SECTION 60 ET THE SWISS DINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTS ANDSOAMONGTO PEOPLES.¶ •THEPROMOTION OF THESEQ. FREEEXCHANGE OFACCURATE ANDCIVIL BALANCEDC N DSPEACE RADIO TV SYSTEMS FOUNDATIONS, OTHER INSTITUTIONS DEPENDSAND ONUNDERSTANDING BETWEENPEOPLES ANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLES ARETOUNDERSTAND ONEANOTHER,ITISAN ESSE UNDERSTANDING AMONGPEOPLESIF ISTOANY, BRINGABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONGTHE JOURNALISTS OFTHEWORLD. ¶THE INACCORD THE NET EARNINGS, THE INSTITUTE SHALL TO BE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶•THEFURTHERANCE ANDOF SAFEGUARDING OFFREEDOMOFTHE PRESS,BYENURE WHICHISMEANT: FREE ACCESS PRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMO UBLICATIONS, SEMINARS, CONFERENCES, EXCHANGE PROGRAMM THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PE OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDER EOS AND ELECTRONIC MATERIAL ON THE INTERNET, THE SENDING O THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUA NG OUT THESE THE INSTITUTE SHALL A FAIR TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREEPURPOSES, PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THEPROMOTE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTAND XCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶W NATIONAL ASSUMES ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL OR OTHERW ARE TO UNDERSTANDCOMMITTEE ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP T G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE¶ WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS¶ ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORKOF TO AL COMMITTEE. ARTICLE II ¶ MEMBERSHIP 1. FULL MEMBERSHIP EDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW OURNALS, NEWS AGENCIES OR TV AND RADIO BROADCASTING SYSTE GST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AM DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL T TES OBJECTIVES WHO, INSEEKING MEMBERSHIP, FOR ERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISAND TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE DECLARE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANC LLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH ISAS MEANT: FREE ACCESS MBLE ABOVE. ¶ACHIEVEMENT 2. FULLOF MEMBERSHIP CAN BE ACQUIRED FOLLOW PRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMO NE SHALL HAVE THE POWER TO INITIALLY DETERMINE WHETHER N THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLESOR AND PE OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDER BE MADE TOTHE INSTITUTE’S DIRECTOR, WHO ALONE SHALLHAVE TH THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUA TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTAND MATE OF THE BOARD. ¶¶OF3. MEMBERSHIP SHA XCHANGEAUTHORITY OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWSEXECUTIVE AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶W NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NEWS OR RADIO BROADCASTI ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THATAGENCY, THEY HAVE GOODTV INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP T G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TO RNET MAY BE REPRESENTED BY MORE THAN FULL MEM EDOM OFSERVICE THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS,ONE FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW GST JOURNALISTS AND SOOF AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCEDIN NEWS AM OF FREEDOM THE PRESS AND DESIROUS CO-OPERATING THE DEPENDS ONUNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLESAND PEOPLES. IFPEOPLESARETOOF UNDERSTAND ONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIAL T MBERS JOURNALISM FACULTIES, AND ADVISORS. ¶ · AS ERSTANDINGOF AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDINGLAWYERS AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANC LLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OFMAGAZINES, THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS EPARTMENTS/SECTIONS OF NEWSPAPERS, BROADCA PRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMO THE IMPROVEMENT OFPROGRAMME THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PE NT AFFAIRS EDITORS OR PRESENTERS, PERSONS HOLDI OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDER THERE IS ESTABLISHEDFROM AN ORGANISATION WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND TS GROUP) ANYTOONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, RADIO, TVSAFEGUA ORG TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTAND ROVIDING THE APPLICANTS PROCURE FROM T XCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THEWRITTEN IMPROVEMENT OFAPPROVAL THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶W ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP T NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BE MADE TO THE NA G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TO EDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW NGST COUNTRIES WHERE THERE ARE NO NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLIC JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AM WHETHER OR NOT TO ENROL APPLICANTS. IN ALL DEPENDSONUNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLESANDTHE PEOPLES. IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTAND ONECASES, ANOTHER,ITISENROL ESSENTIALT ERSTANDING AMONG IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THESHALL WORLD. ¶ INHAVE ACCORDANC ELLOWING IN ALL THEPEOPLES OFSAFEGUARDING THE INSTITUTE, THEY OBJECTIVES: ¶ACTIVITIES • THE FURTHERANCE AND OF FREEDOM OFBUT THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESSN PRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ •SHALL THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMO EMBERSHIP BE HALF THEDUES FOR ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PE ND TO COMMUNICATIONS DEPARTMENTS UNIVERSITIES AND C OOD2, INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDINGOF AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDER THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUA CASTING INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS MAY PARTICIPATE INAL TRANSMISSION OFFIELDS. NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTAND XCHANGE OF ACCURATE ANDEXECUTIVE BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶THE • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE OFDELEGAT JOURNALISM.¶W HORITY OFTHE BOARD. NUMBER OFPRACTICES THEIR ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP T XECUTIVE INSTITUTIONAL SHALL NO G THE JOURNALISTSBOARD. OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THISMEMBERS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN HAVE ORGANISATION TOVOTIN WORK TO OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW EEDOM EXECUTIVE SHALL BETOFIXED DIRECTOR WITH THE GST JOURNALISTS AND SOBOARD AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THEBY FREETHE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWSAG AM DEPENDS ONUNDERSTANDING BETWEENPEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTAND ONEIN ANOTHER, ITIS ESSENTIALT O SHALL ACT CONTRARY TO THE PRINCIPLES SET OUT THE PRESEN ERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANC ARD, EXPULSION SHALL NOT BE ORDERED EXCEPT THE APP LLOWINGBUT OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH ISON MEANT: FREE ACCESS PRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMO GETHER WITH STATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED CAUSES, SHALL G THE IMPROVEMENT OF THETHE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLESBE AND PE OODSHALL INFORMATION. A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDER RD BETHEREFORE, GRANTED TO SUCH MEMBER, THAT SHALL SO THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWINGIF OBJECTIVES: ¶MEMBER • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUA TTRANSMISSION GENERAL ASSEMBLY WHICHFREE CASE A MAJORITY VOTE OF MEMBE OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATIONIN OF NEWSPAPERS, EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTAND Clockwise from left: Rudolf Augstein seated with Der Spiegel director general, Detlev Becherlinks, at court, 1966; Augstein after being arrested under the suspicion of treason, 1963; Augstein with chief editor of Der Spiegel, Erich Böhme, 1985; Augstein gesturing in front of the 50th anniversary Der Spiegel cover. VIEWS.¶•THEACHIEVEMENT omar OF THE PRACTICES OF JOUR BelhouChet N.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMEN ED AN ORGANISATION TO W EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF RATE AND BALANCED NEW o DONEANOTHER,ITISESSEN FTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDA HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS ONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROM GBETWEENPEOPLESANDPE TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTA RTHERANCE AND SAFEGUAR VEMENTOFUNDERSTANDIN FJOURNALISM.¶WORLDPEA AMENTALSTEPTOWARDSU AL THAT THEY H D.¶INACCORD ,BYWHICHISM URNALISTS AN TICLE I ¶ GENER TICLEXIXINTH TUTINTERNAT 3. THE OFFICIAL PORATION PUR ALGERIA 1954– Above: Omar Belhouchet looks pensive during a Reporters Sans Frontières press conference held on International Press Freedom Day. Below: Belhouchet with fellow World Press Freedom Hero, Pius Njawé, at the 30th Anniversary of the Le Messager in Douala, Cameroon. n 17 May 1993, Omar Belhouchet’s two children walked safely through their school door before he turned to see assailants charging at him, firing. Flattening himself to the car seat and with his foot on the accelerator, he escaped with his life. It takes a brave man to continue after an assassination attempt; even braver after three, but Belhouchet’s commitment to press freedom and truth in Algeria is unwavering. He said: “Only democracy can save this country. That is why I publish. They can do what they want to us. We are ready for them and we are not afraid. Without a debate, there is only darkness here.” With a team of optimistic, enthusiastic journalists, Belhouchet founded the French-language daily El Watan (The Nation) in 1990, following the disestablishment of the one-party system that Algeria had known since its independence from France. Promising freedom of expression, the relatively liberal 1989 constitution inspired a media boom unprecedented in the Arab world. Peace, however, was short-lived: growing support for the Islamic Salvation Front in December 1991 swayed the army to cancel the first multiparty elections. Terror erupted as Muslim fundamentalists, furious about the intervention, brought unthinkable atrocities against Algeria’s civilians for the following six years. With restrictive government-dictated press laws and the walls of censorship closing in, Algerian journalists operated under horrendous conditions and constant threat in the brutal guerrilla war. Seventy were killed during the course of the struggle, and many more fled the country. Political advances in 1997 had no effect on the terrorists: stories of disembowelled pregnant mothers, massacred foetuses, chainsaw be- headings and gang-rapes became regular, abhorrent headlines. Unlike state-run media, El Watan is not directly censored, so Belhouchet’s dissident voice against the authorities has often resulted in the independent paper being suspended using a state of emergency decree which silences “activities [that] endanger public order and security.” Between 1993 and 1997, Belhouchet estimated 30 prosecutions against him for publishing security-related information or articles implicating government officials in alleged corruption. His current count stands at over 150 suits, 10 of which have led to his receiving prison sentences. His first suspended six-month sentence in January 1993 was for ‘prematurely’ reporting the murder of five policemen at a police station by Islamic fundamentalists. During his struggle to promote democracy and defend a free press, Belhouchet and several of his journalists have been jailed, prompting significant international outcry. “I have received many letters of solidarity on the part of colleagues, and newspapers have published many articles on [our plight],” Belhouchet said. “It is true that we do not today have the same response as before, but when it comes to the imprisonment of journalists, we act as if we belonged to the same family.” Although internationally a civil issue, defamation and insulting government officials and state institutions is a criminal offence in Algeria. His crusade has not gone completely unrewarded: he found justice handed to him on a crumpled piece of paper on 19 October 1997. Following weeks of headline-allegations claiming that Justice Minister Muhammad Adami was responsible for the suffocation death of 32 prisoners in June 1997, the minister resigned. After Belhouchet had filed an appeal against a three-month sentence for a report about drug trafficking in the western region of Algeria, which was considered defamatory, his prison term was over-turned and replaced by a £550 fine in July of 2008 in an unprecedented u-turn. In the same year, however, an appeals court upheld a decision against Belhouchet who, in addition to being incarcerated, was ordered to pay one million dinars in damages to the Prefect of Jijel for comments made in a column published in El Watan in June 2006. On 29 December 2008, Belhouchet was jailed for three months along with one of his journalists, Salima Tlemcani. They were found guilty in a libel suit dating back to 2004, when El Watan published an article claiming that a faith healer was an imposter. Born on 9 February 1954 in Sétif, Algeria, Omar Belhouchet studied economics at the University of Algiers. In 1987, he co-founded the Journalist Movement of Algeria and later the Journalist Union of Algeria. As the 1994 laureate of the WAN Golden Pen of Freedom and one of the International Press Institute’s press freedom heroes, he is a well-known and respected member of the international media community, and El Watan, with its 300 staff and 100 journalists, is a participant in the Arab Newspaper Development Programme, designed to strengthen independent newspapers in the Arab world. With so many newspapers, one could be forgiven for believing that Algeria is a country with a vibrant press; but many are state-owned, bent on flooding the market with censored stories. It is, in fact, down to a few to resiliently bring undiluted, untainted news to the nation’s readers. Belhouchet is one of those remarkable few. 21 ON OF TH IAL THAT LD.¶INAC S,BYWHI OURNALI RTICLE I ¶ VIEWS.¶•THEACHIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEP OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND N.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDE ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGU EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTAN RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶W DONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPT FTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORGANISATIONTOWORKTOWA HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPER ONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NA GBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEY TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS RTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEW VEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFR FJOURNALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESA AMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGT OWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOF F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJ ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF V MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEM AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFOR UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS E SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSM NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHA NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOU TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF T F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJ ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF V MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEM AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFOR UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS E SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSM NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHA NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOU TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF T F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJ ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF V MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEM AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFOR UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS E SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSM NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHA NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOU TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF T F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJ ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF V MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEM AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFOR Editor and founder of The Daily Observer newspapers in Liberia and The Gambia, Kenneth Best, pictured here, says: “Press freedom is like the law. It is the cement that holds together the social and political fabric in a democracy.” Kenneth a Best LIBERIA 1938– s founder of both The Daily Observer of Monrovia, Liberia, and its sister paper of the same name in Banjul, The Gambia, Kenneth Y. Best is a member of an exclusive group of international journalists – those who have been harassed, threatened and persecuted by the military governments of two different countries. Best was born on 28 October 1938 in Harrisburg, Liberia. He had been working in Kenya as the information director of the All Africa Conference of Churches when he decided to move back to Monrovia with his family to found The Daily Observer, Liberia’s first independent daily newspaper, in 1981. He did so despite the concerns of family and friends that the paper would make him a target of the ruthless military regime of Master Sergeant Samuel Doe, who had assumed power months earlier after a bloody coup. But Best was determined to provide the people of Liberia a courageously independent press, one that would resist all government efforts to silence its voice. “Press freedom is like the law. It is the cement that holds together the social and political fabric in a democracy,” Best said in an interview. “Only the free and independent press has the power to examine the conduct of the government … Only the free press can do so and inspire the changes that are needed if the nation and the society are to make progress in the right direction.” From the outset, the Observer launched an aggressive campaign to rout out public corruption by exposing the illicit activities of top-ranking government and military officials. One of the paper’s first stories was about corruption at the Ministry of Justice, which prompted Minister Chea Cheapoo to make death threats against Best and his staff – threats that were carried live on national television. Several weeks later, the paper published an open letter to Doe that asked for the reinstatement of student activist Commany B. Wesseh. Wesseh had been ousted from the Constitution Commission and fired from his job for publicly disagreeing with Doe on development issues. As a result of the letter, Doe’s security forces arrested and jailed the Observer’s entire staff and held them in prison for several days before releasing them. All told, the Observer was shut down four times for reporting that offended the Doe government. This included a six-month ban imposed in January 1984 by the vice Head of State J. Nicholas Podier for burying a story on the paper’s back page about a visit by Israeli President Chaim Herzog – placement the government considered an insult to Herzog and an embarrassment to Doe. The government moved to revoke the paper’s articles of incorporation in court but was unsuccessful. During this tumultuous time, Best himself was arrested twice and the Observer was the subject of two arson attacks. Throughout it all, Best pressed on. During a recent interview, Best spoke of the government’s unrelenting campaign of media repression. “There were numerous such incidents in which we and other media institutions suffered from the military regime throughout the 1980s and from the warlords during the civil war in the 1990s and beyond,” he said. This civil war erupted in December 1989, as Charles Taylor’s rebel forces toppled Doe’s government and fought various ethnic factions for control of the country. Taylor’s forces captured and killed Doe in clashes that destroyed much of the capital city. The Observer’s offices burned to the ground in 1990, and Best went into exile to The Gambia with his family. In 1991, Best launched that country’s first daily paper, also called The Daily Observer. The Gambia’s Observer quickly became the most popular and widely-read paper in the country. In 1994, then 29-year-old lieutenant Yahya Jammeh assumed power in a bloodless coup. The Observer repeatedly pressed the new government to set a deadline for democratic elections, a campaign that led to Best’s arrest and deportation to his war-torn homeland Liberia in October 1994. A week later, Best emigrated to the United States where he and his family were granted political asylum. While living in the U.S., Best worked as a media consultant and also launched the website of Liberia’s The Daily Observer. In April 2005, with stability restored in Liberia, Best and his family returned to their country to rebuild the Observer as a newspaper that, according to its website, “seeks to keep the Liberian people informed, the government accountable, and to be the watchdog for the repetition of historical mistakes.” Best, at age 71, serves as the paper’s publisher and managing director. 23 hUBert Beuve-méry FRANCE 1902–1989 t here is a firmly held legend in French journalism that Hubert Beuve-Méry, the founding editor of Le Monde, famously instructed his staff: “Gentlemen, if you want to be taken seriously, be boring.” Even if he actually did say that, it was hardly a piece of advice that he applied to himself – even if he did ban photographs in a newspaper whose makeup embodied the cliché ‘good grey.’ Under the pen name ‘Sirius,’ the brightest star in the firmament, Beuve-Méry, followed up virtually every major statement made by President Charles de Gaulle with a front-page editorial expectantly awaited by the French political class for its trenchant comments on the ruler’s deliberately provocative positions. Beuve-Méry’s strong criticisms of De Gaulle were all the more striking in that the founding editor had been given the newspaper thanks to the president soon after Paris was freed from German occupation. Their love-hate relationship came to symbolise Le Monde’s independence. As France’s quality newspaper of record, Le Monde was the direct successor of the discredited Le Temps, which had been the paid, unofficial organ both of the French Foreign Ministry and of France’s heavy industry federation. Barring that morally compromised paper from reopening, De Gaulle wanted a clean start for French journalism. Beuve-Méry was a highly logical choice to lead a French journalistic renaissance. Before the war, he had been the correspondent of Le Temps in the Czechoslovakian capital of Prague. When, in 1938, the paper backed Hitler’s view that Czechoslovakia was the illegitimate oppressor of its German minority, Beuve protested strongly and resigned. During his 12 years in Czechoslovakia, BeuveMéry resigned three times as Prague correspondent of a Paris paper. Born in Paris into a modest family, BeuveMéry worked at a number of odd jobs to put himself through a doctor of laws degree. BeuveMéry started out contributing to small Catholic 24 intellectual weeklies and monthlies. And that was where he found his vocation, entering journalism as others entered the priesthood. Back in Paris after Munich, he published a widely-read pamphlet against the accord. During the immobile, so-called Phoney War of 1939-40, he served first as a lieutenant behind the Maginot Line and then as a liaison officer for two regiments of Czechoslovak volunteers, whose escape he helped organise after the fall of France in June 1940. Thanks to his close ties to Emmanuel Mounier, a leading Catholic social philosopher, Beuve-Méry became director of the École des Cadres, founded at Uriage under the auspices of the Vichy government’s Youth Ministry. Mounier’s idea was to train future leaders for a French comeback after the country’s defeat. Vichy Prime Minister Pierre Laval correctly suspected that the school was instilling a spirit of resistance to the Hitlerite New Order. Laval had the school dissolved in December 1942, after it had trained some 2,000 young cadres. Beuve-Méry then joined the Resistance, becoming a lieutenant in the French Forces of the Interior. The first edition of Le Monde, housed in the offices of Le Temps and printed on its presses, appeared in mid December 1944, with the help of a government loan. By April 1945, Beuve-Méry had repaid the loan. Having observed Le Temps’ pre-war compromises, Beuve-Méry insisted that financial independence, however difficult, was the condition of editorial independence. As he once said: “What probably lost Le Temps was that it had too much money; one of the great strengths of Le Monde was not to have it.” Beuve-Méry shunned the Paris whirl of journalists socialising with political leaders. His Le Monde had no compunction about taking sides in the great debates that shook post-war France. Often at the cost of circulation, the paper advocated anti-colonialism and, in the 1950s, Cold War neutralism. Beuve-Méry presided over a daily ritual in which some 15 editorial department chiefs gathered in his office every morning at 7 a.m. to decide how to report and comment on the day’s news, to be printed by 2 p.m. Creating a sense of urgency, the editorial conference was conducted standing up. When Le Monde started in 1945, it had 50 journalists. By 1975 it had 175 – generally seen as the country’s best at their respective beats. When General de Gaulle returned to power in 1958 under dubious legal circumstances, purportedly to avert civil war led by generals determined to keep Algeria French, Beuve-Méry broke with the Leftist opposition to endorse the Gaullist takeover as the lesser of evils. BeuveMéry’s apartment was dynamited in January 1962 by last-ditch partisans of French Algeria. Once Algeria gained its independence, Le Monde resumed its warnings against the dangers of Gaullist authoritarianism. De Gaulle resigned in April 1969 after losing a national referendum vote. In a typically nuanced Beuvianisme, the editor wrote: “His faithful followers feel a sadness shared by many of his adversaries, more or less.” The publisher-editor followed De Gaulle into retirement that December, after 25 years as chief of a newspaper that had worked to restore the honour of French journalism. In retirement, Beuve-Méry continued to go to his office and produce daily critiques of the paper; to supervise training of young journalists by heading Journalistes en Europe, a fellowship program focused on the emerging European institutions; and to be active with the IPI, of which he was one of the founders. He died in April 1989 at age 87. Written by Ronald Koven, European Representative, World Press Freedom Committee (WPFC) and longserving Paris-based correspondent for newspapers including The International Herald Tribune and The Boston Globe MONG PEOPLES IS TO B TIVES:¶•THEFURTHERA HEACHIEVEMENTOFU ACTICES OF JOURNALI RE,AFUNDAMENTALS ANISATION TO WORK T PUBLICATION OF NEW BALANCED NEWS AMO THER,ITISESSENTIALT LD.¶INACCORDANCE NT: FREE ACCESS TO TH ES.¶ • THE PROMOTION IAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAM LD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANO S,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREEACCESSTOTHENEWS,FREETRANSMISS OURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES. ¶ · THE PROMOTION OF THE F RTICLE I ¶ GENERAL ¶ 1. THE ORGANISATION DEFENDS EVERYONE’S RTICLEXIXINTHEUNUNIVERSALDECLARATIONOFHUMANRIGHTS, TITUTINTERNATIONALDELAPRESSE,INFRENCH;INSTITUTOINTERN ¶ 3. THE OFFICIAL LANGUAGES OF THE INSTITUTE SHALL BE ENGLISH RPORATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 60 ET SEQ. OF THE SWISS CIVIL C D RADIO AND TV SYSTEMS FOUNDATIONS, OTHER INSTITUTIONS AN THENETEARNINGS,IFANY,OFTHEINSTITUTESHALLENURETOTHEBE UBLICATIONS, SEMINARS, CONFERENCES, EXCHANGE PROGRAMM EOS AND ELECTRONIC MATERIAL ON THE INTERNET, THE SENDING O NG OUT THESE PURPOSES, THE INSTITUTE SHALL PROMOTE A FAIR NATIONAL COMMITTEE ASSUMES ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL OR OTHERW ALCOMMITTEE.¶ARTICLEII¶MEMBERSHIP¶1.FULLMEMBERSHIPOF OURNALS,NEWSAGENCIESORTVANDRADIOBROADCASTINGSYSTE TESOBJECTIVESANDWHO,INSEEKINGMEMBERSHIP,DECLAREFOR MBLEABOVE.¶2.FULLMEMBERSHIPCANBEACQUIREDASFOLLOW NESHALLHAVETHEPOWERTOINITIALLYDETERMINEWHETHERORN BEMADETOTHEINSTITUTE’SDIRECTOR,WHOALONESHALLHAVETH MATE AUTHORITY OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶ 3. MEMBERSHIP SHA NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NEWS AGENCY, TV OR RADIO BROADCASTI RNET SERVICE MAY BE REPRESENTED BY MORE THAN ONE FULL MEM OFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESSANDDESIROUSOFCO-OPERATINGINTHE MBERSOFJOURNALISMFACULTIES,LAWYERSANDADVISORS.¶·AS EPARTMENTS/SECTIONS OF NEWSPAPERS, MAGAZINES, BROADCA NTAFFAIRSPROGRAMMEEDITORSORPRESENTERS,PERSONSHOLDI TS GROUP) FROM ANY ONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, RADIO, TV ORG ROVIDING THE APPLICANTS PROCURE WRITTEN APPROVAL FROM T NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BE MADE TO THE NA NCOUNTRIESWHERETHEREARENONATIONALCOMMITTEES,APPLIC WHETHERORNOTTOENROLTHEAPPLICANTS.INALLCASES,ENROL E IN ALL THE ACTIVITIES OF THE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY SHALL HAVE N EMBERSHIPSHALLBEHALFTHEDUESFORASSOCIATEMEMBERSHIP ND 2, TO COMMUNICATIONS DEPARTMENTS OF UNIVERSITIES AND C CASTINGFIELDS.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSMAYPARTICIPATEINAL HORITYOFTHEEXECUTIVEBOARD.THENUMBEROFTHEIRDELEGAT XECUTIVEBOARD.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSSHALLHAVENOVOTIN E EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL BE FIXED BY THE DIRECTOR WITH THE AG OSHALLACTCONTRARYTOTHEPRINCIPLESSETOUTINTHEPRESEN ARD, BUT EXPULSION SHALL NOT BE ORDERED EXCEPT ON THE APP GETHER WITH THE STATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED CAUSES, SHALL BE G RDSHALLBEGRANTEDTOSUCHMEMBER,IFTHATMEMBERSHALLSO T GENERAL ASSEMBLY IN WHICH CASE A MAJORITY VOTE OF MEMBE Above: Hubert BeuveMéry, second from left, listening at the discussion “The Written and the Spoken Word,” 1967. Below: BeuveMéry in portrait. J. Jesús BlanCornelas MEXICO 1936–2006 o n the morning of 27 November 1997, J. Jesús Blancornelas, editor of the weekly newspaper Zeta, set out on the six-block trip from his home to the paper’s offices in Tijuana. Lying in wait for him was a gang of 10 assassins led by David Barron Corona, a.k.a. C.H., a notorious member of the Tijuana drug cartel whom Zeta had tied to the killing of two Mexican soldiers the week before. The red Ford Explorer driven by Blancornelas’ bodyguard Luis Valero was quickly ambushed. The car was attacked on both sides in a barrage of nearly 200 bullets. Valero, hit 38 times, died at the scene, as did Corona who was accidentally struck in the eye by a ricochet. Blancornelas was hit four times but survived. He was badly injured, a bullet fragment lodged near his spine. The attack was retaliation for Zeta’s groundbreaking investigative journalism that tackled public corruption and drug trafficking, topics the Mexican media had traditionally shied away from. While it was commonplace for government officials and cartel members to bribe reporters to publish their propaganda, Zeta forged a new path of independent, unflinching reporting that was fearless in its quest for truth. The paper never hesitated to take on the highest ranking cartel members and government officials. As such, many suspected that government officials were complicit in the attack on Blancornelas. Just weeks before, the government had withdrawn bodyguards assigned to him by a state governor due to the numerous death threats the editor had received. 26 But in Blancornelas’ view, reporting on the exploits of the Tijuana drug cartel and government corruption was all in a day’s work. “I maintain that I am not here to wage war against the mafia,” Blancornelas wrote in a May 1999 essay. “But that news is news and I am a journalist.” Born Juan Jesús Blanco Ornelas in San Luis Potosi on 14 November 1936, Blancornelas began his journalism career in the sport section of the El Sol de San Luis newspaper in 1956. From there, he went on to work as a reporter, city editor and news editor for El Mexicano, a daily newspaper based in Tijuana. He later joined the Mexicali daily La Voz de la Frontera as a sub-editor before rising to the rank of editor in chief. In 1977, Blancornelas, along with his longtime colleague Hector ‘El Gato’ Felix Miranda, founded the ABC newspaper in Tijuana, their first foray into hard-hitting investigative journalism that exposed government corruption. The paper was taken over by the government in 1979 in a trumped-up labour dispute that was retaliation for Blancornelas’ refusal of a demand by State Governor Roberto de la Madrid to fire Miranda for his columns that were highly critical of local politicians. In 1980, Blancornelas, accused of fraud in connection with the government seizure, fled to San Diego to launch Zeta, where he operated outside of the reach of Mexican officials for two years, editing and publishing the paper and exporting it to Tijuana. He returned to Mexico in 1982 when the charges against him were dropped. The trouble for Blancornelas did not stop there, however. In 1987, Zeta’s plant was sprayed with machine-gun fire. The following year, Miranda was assassinated while driving to work. After his murder, Blancornelas continued to print Miranda’s name on the masthead as copublisher. A month after the attempt on his life, Blancornelas returned to Zeta. He was surrounded by armed soldiers around the clock. To quit would have sent the message to the cartel that journalists could be intimidated, Blancornelas said in a 2003 interview with the Poynter Institute. “If I had retired, I would have put my colleagues at risk,” he said in the interview. Blancornelas’ courageously pioneering work ushered in a new era of Mexican journalism, one in which more media outlets operated independently of authorities and in which the government was held more accountable for its misdeeds. His work also earned him the acclaim of the international press freedom community. In 1997, Blancornelas and other leading journalists created the Sociedad de Periodistas, or Society of Journalists, a press freedom organization that was formed in response to the growing violence against Mexican journalists. The group demanded investigations of attacks on journalists as well as security for those receiving death threats. In 1999, Blancornelas received the UNESCO/Guillermo Cano World Press Freedom Award. Blancornelas continued to edit Zeta until his death on 23 November 2006 after a long battle with stomach cancer. He was 70. Ut UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNA TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRIN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE OF FOLLOWING OBJECT DAN SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM THE PRESS, TRANSMISSIONOFNEWS,FREEPUBLICATIONOFNEWSPAPERS,FR OTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NE NDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AM BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN LD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BE NDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMO ARDSTHE FOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:AMONG ¶•THEFURTHERANCE AND SA ARDS UNDERSTANDING PEOPLES IS T CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACH ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ •FURTH THE IMPR THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL TH BOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF ACHIEVE THE WORLD. FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE •THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRE SSION OF•VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMO ONS.¶ THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTIC NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNA YNG HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A ER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREF OF THE WORLD.IS ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE SALISTS BELIEF THERE ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISA OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO NT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS ANDPUBLICA SO AMONG FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE T OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS O HAVEGOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, AFUNDAMENTAL STEPTOW FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANC DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATI ES ARE TO UNDERSTAND IT IS WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THEONE NEWS,ANOTHER, FREE TRANSMISSION OURNALISTS AND SO AMONGOF PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF TH GM.¶WORLD THE JOURNALISTS THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACC PEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOP ,AFUNDAMENTAL STEPTOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONGFRE PEOP DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: TABLISHEDANORGANISATIONTOWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWIN S, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPA URNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ •THE THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BAL DING BETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES. IFPEOPLES ARETOUNDERS N UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND NDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMO G AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDE ARDS THEFOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶•THEFURTHERANCE ANDSA CATION OF¶ NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSIONAND OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACH CTIVES: • THE FURTHERANCE SAFEGUA ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPR PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL TH WS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDIN BOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. •OF THETHE FURTHERANCE ANDSAFEGUARDING OFFREEDOMOFTHEPRE TSSION PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORL OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMO N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWA NG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNA ER, IT ISAN ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVETO GOOD INFORMATION. THEREF HED ORGANISATION WORK TOWARDS ALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICHOF IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION NEWSPAPERS, F NT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG T OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS O URATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATI HAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOW DANCEONE WITH ANOTHER, THIS BELIEF THERE ANTHAT ORGANISATI AND ITISISESTABLISHED ESSENTIAL TH “I maintain that I am not here to wage war against the mafia. But news is news and I am a journalist.” J. Jesús Blancornelas holds the UNESCO/ Guillermo Cano World Press Freedom Prize won for his reporting of drug-related corruption on the Mexican border around Tijuana. NACCORDANCEWI grémah WHICHISMEANT:FR BouKar Koura NALISTS AND SO AMO LE I ¶ GENERAL ¶ 1. TH EXIXINTHEUNUNIV INTERNATIONALDE HE OFFICIAL LANGUA RATION PURSUANT T DIO AND TV SYSTEMS ETEARNINGS,IFANY CATIONS, SEMINARS AND ELECTRONIC MA UT THESE PURPOSE ¶ tHEACHIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶ THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHANGEOFACCURATEANDBALANCEDNEWSAMONGNAT PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY EFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALISTSOFTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHIS RGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS REE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF TH ND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PE NOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGA ORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORGANISATIONTOWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFRE MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST J OPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DE EENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTA G ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWIN NCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESS OFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHANGEOFACCURATEANDBALANCEDNEWSAMONGNATIONS.¶•THEIMPROVE NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMA ALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALISTSOFTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABL KTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREEACCESSTOTHENEWS,FREETRANSMISSIONOF SPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC NG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN HAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS O WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY W HE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A N OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTAN OPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PE TANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: UARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT O ¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T P TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISH OWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF SPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC NG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN HAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS O WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY W HE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A N OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTAN OPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PE Grémah Boukar AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: TANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED Koura pictured in UARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. theseOF portraits in ANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT O ¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTAND his office and theONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. T P TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISH radio studio of his OWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, station RadioBY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF SPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC Anfani, Niger. NG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN HAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS O WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY W HE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A N OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTAN OPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PE TANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: UARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT O ¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T P TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISH OWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF SPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC NG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN HAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS O WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY W HE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A N OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTAN OPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PE TANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: UARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT O ¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T P TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISH OWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF SPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC NG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN HAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS O WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY W HE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A N OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTAN OPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PE TANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: UARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT O ¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T P TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISH OWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF SPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC NG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN HAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS O WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY W HE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A N OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTAN OPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PE TANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: UARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT O ¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T P TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISH OWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF SPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC NG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN HAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS O WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY W HE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A N OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTAN OPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PE TANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: UARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT O ¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T P TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISH OWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NIGER 1959– a s director of Niger’s Radio Anfani, Grémah Boukar Koura had an open door policy. Anyone who wanted to sound off on the news of the day – from the price of commodities to the military rule of Colonel Ibrahim Bare Mainassara – could access the airwaves. Boukar preferred walk-ins to call-ins. People with telephones were the affluent. He wanted to give voice to the afflicted. “We don’t take telephone callers and put them on the air. It shouldn’t be such a small circle,” Boukar said in a 1998 New York Times interview. “The only way to really be free is to accept criticism.” Boukar’s philosophy, however, was not shared by Mainassara, who repeatedly tried in vain to permanently force Radio Anfani off the air for its unflinching examination of the atrocities committed by his regime. Born on 2 February 1959 in Maine-Soroa, Niger, Boukar founded Radio Anfani in 1994 as an offshoot of the Anfani newspaper and magazine, of which he was publisher. The station was launched during the administration of Mahamane Ousmane, Niger’s first democraticallyelected president. But a 1996 coup led by Mainassara upended Ousmane’s government and put Radio Anfani, the country’s leading source for domestic and international news, in the crosshairs. That same year, soldiers stormed the Radio Anfani offices in the capital of Niamey after the station gave opposition parties, non-governmental organisations and trade unions airtime during the presidential elections. The station was barred from broadcasting for nearly a month. After Mainassara assumed the presidency through a fraudulent election, the attacks on Radio Anfani intensified. In March1997, armed men vandalised the radio station, destroying $80,000 (USD) in new equipment and temporarily forcing the station off the air. Weeks later, Boukar, three Radio Anfani journalists and two security guards were arrested on unnamed charges following a libel complaint the military had lodged against the Anfani newspaper for a story that reported that the army was behind the attack. Boukar and one of the guards were subsequently charged with orchestrating the destruction of the station’s equipment to gain sympathy and financial assistance from the international community. They were later released. The most harrowing episode in the clash between Radio Anfani and the Mainassara regime came in April 1998. The opposition to Mainassara was gathering steam. Supporters took to the streets in protest. In an effort to quell the uprising, the government banned private radio stations from broadcasting news it felt added fuel to the fire. In an attempt to silence the government’s fiercest critic, security agents abducted Boukar from his home. He sat bound in a sack as his captors described how they were going to kill him and dispose of his body. However, the murderous plot was foiled by the captors’ realisation that they had been spotted by Boukar’s neighbours and were certain to be identified if he was killed. Boukar was eventually released. Despite the arrests, vandalism and botched assassination attempt and with the threat of being shut down dangling constantly overhead, Boukar persevered. As other dissenting voices were quashed, Radio Anfani remained the lone radio outlet offering critical coverage of the Mainassara government until the president’s assassination in April 1999. With the subsequent fair election of the retired colonel Tandja Mamadu, the immediate threat to Radio Anfani and Boukar lifted. Still, it remained a struggle in Niger as it did in much of West Africa to practise journalism free of government influence or intimidation. Yet Boukar continued to fight for press freedom, driven by a sense of duty to make the government accountable to the governed. “It seems to me that journalism goes with democracy,” Boukar said in The New York Times interview. The unwavering pursuit of journalism, he added, is “my moral obligation.” “It seems to me that journalism goes with democracy.” 29 José Burgos, Jr. PHILIPPINES 1941–2003 t he Philippines boasted a vibrant, vital, free press before President Ferdinand Marcos declared martial law in September 1972. He destroyed Congress and civil liberties, and kept the press to heel. While most independent newspapers sold up, rather than face closure or manipulation, José Burgos stood strong: defying tyranny and fearlessly reporting on the moral bankruptcy of Marcos’s military regime. Born the son of a journalist on 4 January 1941, the future tyrant-toppler, José G. Burgos Jr., started out as a police reporter with the Manila Times at the tender age of 20. Within nine years, he earned his first accolade as one of Ten Outstanding Young Men, thanks to his reports of election-related violence in Ilocos Sur. The paper he wrote for was banned early in Marcos’s reign, so from deep inside martial law the maverick Burgos decided to launch a battery of independent newspapers: Malaya (Free) and Masa (Masses) and the English-language weekly WE Forum, from a small office in Manila in May 1977. Supported by “his ragtag band of journalists” WE Forum was the widest-read dissident voice available to the oppressed citizens, who “had to whisper its name, like buying pornography,” Burgos recalled. “The vendor would reach under the counter and fold it so small you could put it in your pocket.” The beginnings of the ‘mosquito press’ made a nuisance of itself in its rebellion against Marcos’s attempts at propaganda. Soldiers closed the entire operation on 7 December 1982 when they stormed the newsroom and arrested Burgos and nine of his staff. “I was accused of being a subversive,” Burgos joked. “I was a super-subversive because the military accused me of having been an officer of all the ille- 30 gal organisations in the Philippines and even the U.S.” While perhaps something of an exaggeration, Burgos was truly unrelenting in his pursuit of truth, fairness and objectivity. Although an international outcry for his release bought his liberty quickly, the court case lumbered through two years – leaving WE Forum out in the cold and its voice silenced. With WE Forum out of action, and stuck under house arrest, Burgos turned to his vernacular outlets; he developed Malaya into WE Forum’s persistent little sister, shouting his crusade and giving hope to his ever-increasing readership. Committed to verity, Malaya published the only full account of opposition leader Benigno ‘Ninoy’ Aquino’s murder at Manila Airport as he returned from three years in exile in August 1983. Millions of people mourned “the greatest president we never had,” yet there was no official recognition or coverage of either the assassination or the funeral. While a media blackout darkened the Philippine press, everyone at Malaya, from the trafficweaving newsboys to Burgos himself, lived under constant threat: brutal murder, or ‘savaging,’ was the ultimate price paid by anyone who dared to challenge the official line. Burgos, with the humour needed to survive such obscurity, said, “I am the best-dressed man in the Philippines because I have so many [law] suits!” Aquino’s widow, Corazon, led the charge of the People Power opposition movement, with Malaya and Burgos inspiring others in the ‘alternative press’ to join the rally against Marcos. When Marcos fraudulently claimed victory, his regime came to an end as even his ministers crossed the floor in support of Corazon, who was sworn in as president while Marcos fled to the United States. Burgos’ part in felling Marcos was acknowledged by Ninoy’s sister years later: “Without Joe and his publications at the frontline, the revolution would not have happened. Nobody could argue the fact that the brave fight for freedom and democracy would have been a much tougher battle without Joe.” Having almost single-handedly re-established a free press in the Philippines, Burgos was named International Journalist of the Year in 1986 and recognised by the International Press Institute as one of 50 World Press Freedom Heroes of the Century in 2000. On 10 May 2000, the Philippine senate honoured him for “his heroic deeds and steadfast struggle as a journalist.” With his country returned to political order, Burgos merged his two passions when he turned his hand, and pen, to organic farming in 1988. Drawing on his 1973 education in ecology, gained as a Jefferson fellow at the East-West Center, University of Hawaii, he established a 12hectare organic farm in San Miguel, Bulacan. Immersing himself in the world of agriculture, Burgos shared his experiences with his rapt readers. Again his profound commitment to writing about what he loved earned him high praise as Agricultural Journalist of the Year in 1994, as did his radio programme and active involvement in agricultural and ecological concerns which ranged from practical farming methods to relevant, affordable and environmentally-friendly technologies. When he died aged 62 on 16 November 2003 he was laid to rest on the beloved organic farm he had worked so hard to create, in his beloved country, which he had fought so hard to free. ON OF THE INTERNATIONA IAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD LD.¶INACCORDANCEWIT S,BYWHICHISMEANT:FRE OURNALISTS AND SO AMO RTICLE I ¶ GENERAL ¶ 1. TH RTICLEXIXINTHEUNUNIV TITUTINTERNATIONALDEL ¶ 3. THE OFFICIAL LANGUAG RPORATION PURSUANT TO D RADIO AND TV SYSTEMS THENETEARNINGS,IFANY, UBLICATIONS, SEMINARS EOS AND ELECTRONIC MAT NG OUT THESE PURPOSES NATIONAL COMMITTEE AS ALCOMMITTEE.¶ARTICLEI OURNALS,NEWSAGENCIES MONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELI TIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREEACCESSTOTHENEWS,FREETR HEACHIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHAN ACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UND RE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURN ANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PR PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS A BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UND THER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMO LD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORGANISATIONTOWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVE NT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • T ES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF T PEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THER BOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN E AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS UNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHANGEOFACCURATEAND SM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTH TEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALISTSOFTHEWORLD WARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT: PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEO THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING AB H THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE A NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF U F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOU ES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAM NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICAT DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANC ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITIS WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN A ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: F PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEO THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING AB H THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE A NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF U F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOU ES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAM NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICAT DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANC ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITIS WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN A ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: F PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ NATIONS.¶Above: • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEO a memorial honTHEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING AB ouring José Burgos, Jr. H THIS BELIEF THERE that includes some ofIS his ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE A favorite things. Right: NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF U accepting the IPI F THE FREEBurgos EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOU World Press Freedom Hero ES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAM award at the IPI World NDING AMONG JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION Congress inTHE Boston, 2000. DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICAT DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANC ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITIS WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN A ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: F PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEO THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING AB H THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE A NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF U F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOU ES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAM NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICAT DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANC ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITIS WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN A ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: F PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEO THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING AB H THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE A LydIa CaCho MEXICO 1963– 32 s he is known as Mexico’s most wanted journalist; and yet she won’t be quiet. Not even to save her life. Born on 12 April 1963 in Mexico City to a French mother, journalist and human rights activist, Lydia Cacho Ribeiro began her career in the mid 1980s as a reporter for the social section of Novedades de Cancun. In her early twenties, she wrote about social news but soon turned her attention to racism, poverty and other issues impacting people in her city. At age 24, she began writing about violence against women and the men who perpetrated it. Between 1994 and 1999, she took the issue of violence against women to the airwaves, hosting the show “Estas Mujeres” (These Women). From 2000 to 2005, she anchored the television program “Esta Boca es mia!” (This Mouth is Mine). At the tender age of 23, Cacho moved to Cancún because she wanted to be a poet – a dream deferred when a literature teacher, after reading one of her poems, told her: “You will never be a good poet because you are too worried with reality,” and suggested journalism. Cacho moved to Cancún for yet another reason: the beauty and the scuba diving. “I just moved there because it was beautiful and I wanted to have a peaceful life,” she said in an interview with ABC 1, the national public television channel in Australia. But she soon discovered that she was “really curious” and “good at listening and building trust with people.” After a few years as a journalist, Cacho’s life was anything but peaceful. By the mid 1990s, Cacho had advanced to writing about the prostitution of young girls from Cuba and Argentina in Cancún. Her concern for the rights of women and children, and the encouragement of her activist mother, led her to establish a shelter for battered and sexually-exploited women and children in Cancún, where she lives. By 2009, the Centro Integral de Atención a las Mujeres in Cancún (CIAM) had handled 33,000 cases within its first 10 years. Although her newspaper writings did not go unnoticed, it wasn’t until she started naming names that things became difficult. In 2003, Cacho wrote a series of articles for Por Esto newspaper accusing a prominent local hotel owner of involvement in a child pornography ring. She followed the newspaper reports with a 2005 book, “Los Demonios del Edén” (“Demons of Eden”), which accused a hotel owner of being involved in the pornography and child prostitution ring. The book also named high-profile politicians and other prominent businessmen. One of those businessmen, whom Cacho accused of protecting the hotel owner, sued her for defamation. Cacho was arrested in Puebla by a group of po- ON OF THE INTER AL THAT THEY H D.¶INACCORD ,BYWHICHISM URNALISTS AN TICLE I ¶ GENER TICLEXIXINTH TUTINTERNAT 3. THE OFFICIAL PORATION PUR licemen who drove her to a jail nearly 20 miles from her home and tortured her for 20 hours. At one point, the officers took a blindfolded Cacho out of the car and threatened to throw her into the ocean below. “In the moments that I thought I was going to die, I was truly scared. So scared that I stopped feeling my body,” she told ABC 1, adding this about the defamation suit that followed: “It will sound strange, but after you go through all this, you are absolutely sure you will die … because that’s what torturers do. Torturers don’t torture you to get the truth out of you. They torture you to make you understand that your life doesn’t belong to you. That you are absolutely vulnerable and that you are at the mercy of the bad guys. So after that, everything is easier, I guess.” Eventually, Cacho paid a fine and was freed; she later sued – successfully charging the Puebla government over violation of her human rights. The charges were dropped against Cacho and her investigations have so far led to the arrest and conviction of the man involved in the pornography ring who filmed the young girls in sex acts. In early 2006, only months after Cacho was released from jail, tapes were leaked to the daily La Jornada in Mexico City containing telephone conversations between the businessman who had sued Cacho and the governor of Puebla, discussing putting Cacho in jail as a “favour’” and having her beaten while in custody to silence her. But when it comes to fighting for the rights of women and for freedom of expression, the word ‘silence’ is not in Cacho’s vocabulary. “It’s the way I was educated in my family,” Cacho told Mother Jones in an interview in 2007. “My mom was French; she was born in France, but she grew up in Mexico. And she has always told us that she was shocked by how willing Mexicans were to negotiate their dignity in exchange for apparent freedom. When I was a teenager, I asked her what she meant by ‘apparent freedom’ and she said, ‘You are always under somebody if you sell your dignity to them.’ When all this happened, I realized what she meant. I won’t negotiate my dignity because it has to do with my real freedom – my freedom of speech, my freedom of being a woman, protecting others. I have met hundreds of people that are really amazed at what I’ve done, and they keep telling me – mainly men, which is pretty strange – ‘Aren’t you afraid of getting killed?’ People are so, so afraid.” Recipient of the Premio Francisco Ojeda al Valor Periodístico (Francisco Ojeda Award for Journalistic Courage), Cacho, a columnist for El Universal, continues to fight for the rights of women, releasing a book in 2010 entitled: “Slaves of Power: A World Map of Sex Traffickers.” MONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JO TIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHE HEACHIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSAND ACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTAND RE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOP ANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE A BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PR THER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFO LD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORG NT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE P ES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND B PEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHE BOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ E AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEAN UNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES. ISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPL TEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUT WARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAF PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERST NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶ THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP H THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOW NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPA F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG ES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL TH NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PRO ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESAND WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UND ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEG PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERST NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶ THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP H THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOW NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPA F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG ES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL TH NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE Above Left: Lydia Cacho, shown in jail, charged with libel and slander for her book “Demons of Eden”, which accused a prominent businessman of pedophilia. Above center: Cacho is released from jail on a US $ 10,000 bail. Above right: Cacho at a news conference for her book “Demons of Eden.” Above: Cacho stands in front of supporters outside of the courthouse after her trial, 2005. ON OF THE INT IAL THAT THE LD.¶INACCO S,BYWHICHI OURNALISTS RTICLE I ¶ GEN RTICLEXIXIN TITUTINTERN ¶ 3. THE OFFIC VIEWS.¶•THEACHIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJ OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS N.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTAND ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OB EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION O RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROV DONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFOR FTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISEST HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION ONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF GBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERST TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS RTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B VEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSO FJOURNALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDING AMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESIS OWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTH F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FU DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISAT ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICA MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANC AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEA NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEO NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWE TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO B WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHE F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FU DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISAT ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICA MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANC Guillermo Cano, pictured in these portraits, chose to fight the war on drugs with words as editor of El Espectador in Columbia. gUILLermo Cano COLOMBIA 1925–1986 u nlike the United States’ mighty ‘War on Drugs,’ Guillermo Cano Isaza’s campaign against drug trafficking in Colombia was fought humbly with words. As editor, Cano used the pages of El Espectador to spotlight the burgeoning international drug trade taking root in Columbia in the 1980s, uncovering the government’s complicity in the activities of the Medellin Cartel and drawing the ire of its infamous leader Pablo Escobar. Cano’s work put him on Escobar’s bad side, a precarious position he was all too aware of. “The problem about our business is you never know if we will return home at night,” Cano said in an interview with the Association of Journalists of Bogotá on 16 December 1986. The next day, Cano was leaving the El Espectador offices shortly after 7 p.m. in his car when two gunmen on motorcycles shot him in the chest eight times with a machine gun. Trying to escape the hail of bullets, Cano sped up but got only a short distance before crashing into a light pole. He died on the scene. He was 61. Born 12 August 1925 in Bogotá, Cano began his journalism career at age 17, writing about bullfighting for El Espectador, which was founded and run by his father Fidel Cano Gutiérrez. He also worked for a short time as a copy editor before launching the paper’s Sunday magazine and going on to serve as its Europe correspondent. In 1952, at age 27, Cano was named editor of El Espectador. “He had a wonderful sense of what news is,” one colleague recalled. When cocaine trafficking took a hold of Colombia in the early-1980s, Cano shifted the focus of his journalism to helping rout out what he saw as a scourge eroding the very foundation of society. “He felt that if not stopped, the drug gangs would like to run the government, which is what we are experiencing now,” his older brother Luis Gabriel Cano Isaza, president of the Inter American Press Association from 19961997, once said. One of Guillermo Cano Isaza’s first salvos against Escobar was a 1983 article about the drug kingpin’s early arrest for hiding cocaine in the tires of a stolen car. Shortly after that story ran, Cano ran into Escobar again at the opening ceremony of the Congress in 1983. Escobar had aspired to run for Congress but his plans were derailed by a front-page story Cano ran the next day detailing Escobar’s drug connections. From there, El Espectador set out to investigate the on-going crimes of the Medellin Cartel and its growing influence on Colombian society. Cano often used his column, ‘Notebook,’ to launch regular attacks against Escobar. He also advocated for the extradition of drug traffickers to the United States for prosecution, deeming Colombia’s judicial system too corrupt and too inept to properly mete out justice. By this time, Escobar had developed a practice of brazenly murdering his adversaries, ordering hits on dozens of law enforcement authorities, including the country’s justice minister, the justice of the Supreme Court and the head of the narcotics police. Cano and his fellow investigative journalists were also on that hit list. In 1986, Cano earned the National Journalism Award for his courage in fighting for press freedom. Shortly thereafter, he was murdered by contract killers hired by Escobar. The assassination established Colombia as one of the most dangerous countries for journalists. Since then, more than 100 journalists have been killed in Colombia. Cano’s murder touched off a groundswell of outrage. The funeral procession the next day was led by then-president Virgilio Barco and attended by thousands of mourners. The Circle of Bogotá Journalists called for a media blackout in Cano’s honour and no media outlet published or broadcast that day. Columbian journalist Javier Dario Restrepo was there that solemn day. “We left the park … and proceeded along the Avenida Jimenez in an unusual manifestation of journalists. We were silent, (wearing) dark suits and white handkerchiefs ... I fail to specify our dominant feelings (about) the protest. Is (it) the rage, or (is it) the pride of being journalists like Guillermo Cano?” Cano’s murder was just the beginning of the attacks waged on El Espectador as the paper continued its crusade against the cartel. Cano’s sons, Juan Guillermo and Fernando, who took over for their father, received numerous death threats and were forced into exile several times in the years following his death. Four other journalists at the paper were forced to flee as well. As for the paper itself, distribution was sabotaged when the director of distribution and general manager were killed. Between 1989 and 1990, the paper could only be delivered in Medellin with military protection. The battle between the cartel and the paper came to a head in 1989 when Hector Giraldo Galvez, the Cano family lawyer who was helping oversee the murder investigation, was killed. That same year, the newspaper’s offices were destroyed by a 300-pound bomb and the Cano family summer house was burned down. The investigation into Cano’s murder took nine years, an inquiry frustrated by the cartel’s bribery, threats and murder of judges, court officials and jurors. The two hit men suspected to have killed Cano were themselves murdered by the cartel to tie up loose ends. In 1995, four people were convicted for conspiracy in connection with Cano’s murder, but three of those convictions were later overturned. Luis Carlos Molina Yepes, whose conviction was upheld, served six years before being released in 2004. Members of the international journalism community continue to push for a re-opening of the case and a full account of the circumstances surrounding Cano’s murder. 35 Juan PaBlo Cárdenas CHILE 1949– B y day, Juan Pablo Cárdenas, editor-in-chief of the weekly newspaper magazine Análisis, published stories detailing the government corruption and human rights’ abuses committed under General Augusto Pinochet’s military regime. By night, he served an 18-month, nighttime prison sentence imposed in retaliation for those stories. The year was 1987. Cárdenas, who had written a series of editorials that landed him on the Chilean dictator’s bad side, was sentenced to 541 nights in prison. He would report to the prison at 10 p.m. and leave at 7 a.m., returning to Análisis’ offices to continue his crusade against the corrupt regime. The nightly ritual drew international attention and established Cárdenas as an ardent defender of press freedom. Born on 1 December 1949 in Santiago, Cárdenas, known as Juanpa by friends, studied journalism at the Universidad Católica de Chile and was editor of the weekly magazine Debate Universitario until 1973. In 1977, Cárdenas sent a letter to hundreds of his contacts letting them in on the idea that he had to start a new independent magazine. His appeal for pre-subscriptions resulted in cheques from 400 people, which provided the seed money he needed to launch Análisis. From those first hundred subscribers, the magazine grew to a circulation of nearly 70,000. Análisis dared to take on government corruption and the human rights abuses of the Pinochet dictatorship, subjects few publications in Chile would touch. 36 “Thirty years ago, few believed that the magazine could be created under the rule of a dictatorship and with so many restrictions on freedom of expression and human rights,” Cárdenas said in a 2007 interview with Chile’s Citizen Newspaper Network marking the magazine’s 30th anniversary special edition. “However our publication is and will be recognized as one of the more notable efforts of imagination and boldness in the Chilean struggle against oppression.” Cárdenas and his colleagues at Análisis paid a steep price for their fearlessness. In 1986, Jose Carrasco Tapia, the magazine’s foreign news editor, was kidnapped; his body found hours later riddled with bullets. Cárdenas was arrested more than half-a-dozen times and Análisis was shut down numerous times, including on three occasions in 1986. The staff faced constant threats, harassment and lawsuits. Análisis was denied state advertising, and news vendors were told not to stock the magazine. The simple act of owning too many issues would put readers at risk of government persecution for possessing subversive materials. Upon Cárdenas’ release from his nightly prison sentence in 1989, he continued to be targeted by the government. That same year, his home was badly burned in a case of arson. Cárdenas was undeterred and continued his crusading work until Análisis closed in 1992. The demise of the magazine was widely reported to be the result of a loss of readership and revenue as well as the shifting political landscape brought about by the 1990 presidential election of Patricio Aylwin, which restored democracy and press freedom to Chile. Cárdenas, on the other hand, blamed Aylwin for the closure of several publications, accusing the government of working behind the scenes to undermine Análisis and other media that were critical of Pinochet. Shortly after Análisis’ end, Cárdenas founded the magazine The Times and the online journal First Line. Unfortunately, both publications were short-lived, a fate he also blamed on Aylwin. Cárdenas went on to serve as press attaché at the Chilean embassy in Mexico from 1994 to 2000 before joining the faculty at the University of Chile’s School of Journalism. He is currently director of Radio Universidad de Chile, the station which he has transformed into one of the most popular in the country, and has helped train the next generation of Chilean journalists to follow in his trailblazing footsteps. In addition, Cárdenas continues to write newspaper and magazine columns providing political analysis. In 2009, Cárdenas published his autobiography, “A Danger to Society,” which won a Book Council Award the same year. “Adhering to the journalistic vocation is not to appease or please the authority but to lash out and to ensure that through our work, which is often unpleasant and painful, situations change,” Cárdenas said in his acceptance speech. IAL THAT GOODOFINFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP T MONG PEOPLES ISTHEY TO BRINGHAVE ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS EST TIVES:¶ ¶•THE FURTHERANCE ANDSAFEGUARDING FREEDOM OFTHEPRESS, BYWHICHIS ISMEANT: FREEACCESSTOTHE NEWS, FREETRANSMISSIONO LD. IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATIO HEACHIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHANGEOFACCURA S, BY WHICH ISTOWARDS MEANT: TOTHE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OFNEWS ACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACEFREE DEPENDSACCESS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE RE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OFTHE OURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES. ¶ · THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHAN ANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH RTICLE ¶NEWSPAPERS, GENERAL 1. THE ORGANISATION DEFENDS EVERYONE’S PERSONAL FR PUBLICATIONIOF FREE¶ EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMON BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING B RTICLE XIXINTHAT THE DECLARATION OFSTEP HUMAN (DEC. 10, 1948 THER,ITISESSENTIAL THEYUN HAVEUNIVERSAL GOODINFORMATION. THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTAL TOWARDSRIGHTS, UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS LD.¶INACCORDANCE WITHTHISBELIEFTHERE ISESTABLISHED ANORGANISATION TOWORK TOWARDSTHEFOLLOWING OBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTH TITUT INTERNATIONAL DELA PRESSE, IN FRENCH; INSTITUTO INTERNACIONAL DE NT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM ¶ES.¶ 3. THE OFFICIAL LANGUAGES OF THE INSTITUTE SHALL BE ENGLISH, FRENCH, GER • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES PEOPLESANDPEOPLES. IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTAND ONEANOTHER, ITISSEQ. ESSENTIAL THAT THEYSWISS HAVEGOODCIVIL INFORMATION. THEREFORE, FUND RPORATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 60¶ INET OF THE CODE. THEARES BOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATIO D RADIO AND SYSTEMS FOUNDATIONS, INSTITUTIONS AND BUSINESSE E AND SAFEGUARDING OFTV FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREEOTHER ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICA UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE ANDBALANCED N THE NET EARNINGS, IF ANY, OF THE INSTITUTE SHALL ENURE TO THE BENEFIT OF ISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER, ITISANY ESSEN UBLICATIONS, SEMINARS, CONFERENCES, EXCHANGE PROGRAMMES, TRAINING TEP TOWARDSUNDERSTANDING AMONGPEOPLES ISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDING AMONGTHE JOURNALISTSOFTHEWORLD. ¶INACCORDA WARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESST EOSFREE AND ELECTRONIC ON THE INTERNET, THE SENDING OF DELEGATIO PERS, EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THEMATERIAL ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOT NATIONS.¶ • THETHESE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES ANDOF PEO NGHAVE OUT PURPOSES, THE INSTITUTE SHALL PROMOTE A FAIR BALANCE THEY GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERS NATIONAL ASSUMES ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL OR¶OTHERWISE, FOR THE H THIS BELIEF THERECOMMITTEE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUAR Left: Juan Pablo Cárdenas NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION¶OFARTICLE NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDIN AL COMMITTEE. II¶MEMBERSHIP ¶1.EXPRESSION FULL MEMBERSHIP OFTHE INSTITU leaving jail after serving F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WO an 18-month nighttime OURNALS, AGENCIES OR TV AND RADIO BROADCASTING SYSTEMS ORTOON THE ES. IF PEOPLES ARENEWS TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THEYin HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TO prisonTHAT sentence imposed NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION WORK TOW TES OBJECTIVES AND WHO, IN SEEKING MEMBERSHIP, DECLARE FORMALLY AND B retaliation for his stories DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWS detailing Chilean government MBLE ABOVE. ¶UNDERSTANDING 2.AND FULL MEMBERSHIP CAN AS INITISCOUNTR DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THEcorruption PROMOTION OFACQUIRED THE FREE EXCHANGE OFFOLLOWS: ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMO and humanBE rights’ ORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, ESSENTIAL TH abuses. Right: Cárdenas in NE SHALL HAVEAMONG THEPOWER INITIALLY DETERMINE ORWORLD. NOT¶TO ENROL with his lawyer, WARDS UNDERSTANDING PEOPLES IS TOTO BRING ABOUTcourt UNDERSTANDING AMONG THEWHETHER JOURNALISTS OF THE IN ACCORDANCE Mera. WHO BE TOTHE INSTITUTE’S DIRECTOR, ALONE SHALL HAVE THE POWER TOTO ARDSMADE THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE ANDJorge SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOT MATE AUTHORITY THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶ DEPENDS 3. MEMBERSHIP SHALL ONAND AN I NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENTOF OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEENBE PEOPLES PEO THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERS NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NEWS AGENCY, TVTHE OR RADIOOBJECTIVES: BROADCASTING SYSTEM O H THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS FOLLOWING ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUAR RNET SERVICE MAY BEFREE REPRESENTED BY MORE THANOFONE MEMBER UP TO A NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION VIEWS. ¶FULL • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDIN F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WO OFIFPEOPLES FREEDOM OFTHEONE PRESS AND DESIROUS OF CO-OPERATING INTHE INSTITUTE’S ES. ARE TO UNDERSTAND ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEPME TO MBERS OF JOURNALISM LAWYERS AND ADVISORS. ¶ · AS AFFILIATE NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE FACULTIES, WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOW DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICHOF IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW NEWS EPARTMENTS/SECTIONS NEWSPAPERS, MAGAZINES, DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGEBROADCASTING OF ACCURATE AND BALANCEDOR NEWS AMO NT AFFAIRS PROGRAMME EDITORS OR PRESENTERS, E ORLD PEACEDEPENDS ONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES.IFPEOPLESAREPERSONS TOUNDERSTANDHOLDING ONEANOTHER,ITSIMILAR ISESSENTIALTH WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE TS FROM ANY ONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, TV ORGANISATION ARDSGROUP) THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OFRADIO, THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO ROVIDING THE PROCURE WRITTEN APPROVAL THEIR PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OFAPPLICANTS VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS ANDFROM SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶EDITOR• THE PROMOT NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEO Clockwise from left: Cárdenas NATIONAL APPLICATIONS SHALL BE MADE TO THE NATIONAL COMM THEY HAVE GOODCOMMITTEES, INFORMATION. with Arthur Miller, who THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERS THIS BELIEF THERE ISvisited ESTABLISHED ORGANISATION WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUAR Cárdenas in jail, 1988;AN NHNEWS, COUNTRIES WHERE THERE ARETOOF NO NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS FOR FREE TRANSMISSION NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDIN several issuesOF of Cárdenas’ WHETHER OR NOT TOONE ENROL THE APPLICANTS. IN ALL CASES, ENROLMENTS ARE S weekly newspaper magazine F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WO Análisis; Cárdenas at a ES.IN IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TO E ALL THE ACTIVITIES OF THE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY SHALL HAVE NO VOTING RIG protest; the Análisis building NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD.THE ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITHASSOCIATE THIS BELIEF THERE ISMEMBERSHIP. ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOW shut downPRESS, and turned BE EMBERSHIP SHALL HALF DUES FOR ¶ IPI CONSTI DING OF FREEDOM OFisinto THE BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWS a toy bazaar during the DING2, AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THEUNIVERSITIES FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWSSC AMO ND TO COMMUNICATIONS DEPARTMENTS OF AND COLLEGES, state of siege. ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTH CASTING FIELDS. INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS MAY PARTICIPATE THE INSTITU WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OFIN THEALL WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS HORITY OFTHE BOARD. THENUMBER OF THEIRAND DELEGATES ISNOT LIMITO PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF EXECUTIVE VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOT NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDSHAVE ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND¶ PEO XECUTIVE BOARD.OFINSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS SHALL NOVOTING RIGHTS. 9 THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDINGWITH AMONG PEOPLES ISAGREEMENT TO BRING ABOUT UNDERS E EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL BE FIXED BY THE DIRECTOR THE OF H THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUAR NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREESET EXPRESSION OFIN VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENTCONSTITUT OF UNDERSTANDIN O SHALL ACTCONTRARY TOTHE PRINCIPLES OUT THE PRESENT F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WO ARD, BUT NOT BE ORDERED EXCEPT ON THE APPROVAL OF TW ES. IF PEOPLES AREEXPULSION TO UNDERSTAND ONESHALL ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TO NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOW GETHER WITH THE STATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED CAUSES, SHALL BE GIVEN TO THE DING OF FREEDOM OFGRANTED THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSIONSHALL OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OFANY NEWS RD TO SUCH MEMBER, IF THAT MEMBER DESIRE. DINGSHALL AMONGST BE JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATESO AND BALANCED NEWS AMO ORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL TH TWARDS GENERAL ASSEMBLY IN WHICH CASE A MAJORITY VOTE OF MEMBERS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶PRESENT IN ACCORDANCES ROFTHETHE INSTITUTE; OFSUCH ACTION SHALL GIVEN TOTHE NATI ARDS FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: NOTICE ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOMBE OF THE PRESS, BYEITHER WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO PERS, FREE EXPRESSIONTO OF VIEWS. ¶ •INSTITUTE, THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOT OBLIGATIONS THE UP TO THE TIME THAT MEMBER’S RESIGNATION OR NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEO THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. A FUNDAMENTAL STEPCHANGE TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TOUNDER BRING ABOUT UNDERS SIDERS THAT THERETHEREFORE, IS FUNDAMENTAL INTHE CONDITIONS WHIC H THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUAR INEWS, OFTHE PRESENT ARTICLE IIIEXPRESSION ¶NATIONAL ¶1A)SUB FREE TRANSMISSION OFCONSTITUTION. NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF¶ NEWSPAPERS, FREE OF VIEWS. ¶ COMMITTEES • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDIN F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WO AES.NATIONAL COMMITTEE MAYITBE FORMED PROVISIONALLY IN ACOUNTRY WHERE IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TO )DING SUCH RECOGNITION BY THE SHALL NOT NECESSARILY IMPLY NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ INEXECUTIVE ACCORDANCE WITHBOARD THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOW OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWS JOYS FULLJOURNALISTS FREEDOM OFAMONG THEPEOPLES.¶ PRESS. ¶PROMOTION 2.NATIONAL SHALL ACTIVELY DING AMONGST AND SO • THE OF THE FREECOMMITTEES EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMO EVELOPMENTS AFFECTING THE PRESS, PARTICULARLY ON THREATS TO ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITFREEDOM ISESSENTIALTH WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONGCOMMITTEES THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD.BE ¶ INENTRUS ACCORDANCE WAIVE THEEIGHT YEAR LIMIT. ¶3.NATIONAL MAY ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE TERM FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO TEP TOWARDS RGANISATION SMISSIONOF N OF THE FREE EEN PEOPLES AMONG PEOP THEFOLLOWIN N OF NEWSPA URATE AND BA VIEWS.¶•THEACHIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHANGEO OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDER N.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALI ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERS DONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONG FTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORGANISATIONTOWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶ HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE GBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFO TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN OR RTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FR VEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHANGEOFACCURATEANDBA FJOURNALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER AMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALISTSOFTHEWORLD.¶IN OWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:FRE F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • T WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPL NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOU DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UND MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURN AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATIO NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESS TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACC WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • T WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPL NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOU DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UND MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURN AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATIO NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESS TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACC WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • T WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES Below left: Pedro OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPL Joaquín Chamorro NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOU poses at his headDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND quarters near Santo ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UND Domingo, 1959. Above MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURN and below right: AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENT later in life. UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THEpictured WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATIO NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESS TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACC WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • T WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPL NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOU DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UND MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURN AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATIO NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESS TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACC WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • T WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPL NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOU DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UND MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURN AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATIO NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESS TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACC WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • T WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPL Pedro Joaquín Chamorro NICARAGUA 1924–1978 a fter 30 years of doing battle against the corrupt Somoza family that ruled Nicaragua with an iron fist, Pedro Joaquín Chamorro Cardenal, editor of La Prensa, wrote a letter to President Anastasio Somoza Debayle informing the leader that he was prepared to accept his fate. “I am waiting, with a clear conscience, and a soul at peace, for the blow you are to deliver,” Chamorro wrote in 1975. Three years later, that blow would come as a barrage of bullets: Chamorro was gunned down in his car on his way to La Prensa’s offices in Managua. And he saw it coming. After all, Chamorro had dared to wage war against Somoza’s tyranny in the pages of La Prensa, his family’s newspaper serving as the front line of the opposition. And the price often paid for opposing Somoza was death. But Chamorro would not be scared into silence and instead led the resistance that worked to oust Somoza, his pioneering activist journalism laying the groundwork for the eventual upending of Somoza’s presidency. Born 23 September 1924 in Granada, Chamorro’s opposition work began in law school, where he took part in demonstrations against dictator General Anastasio Somoza García. In 1944, Chamorro was jailed briefly for making an anti-Somoza speech at a university rally. That same year, the family was forced into exile to Mexico, the newspaper temporarily shut down by the regime. In Mexico, Chamorro studied journalism and returned to Nicaragua in 1948 to work at La Prensa. In 1952, Chamorro assumed the editorship of the paper after his father’s death. At the helm of La Prensa, Chamorro was the most visible and outspoken opponent of the Somoza regime, using the paper to spotlight the acts of corruption and human rights abuses committed by the president. He was also active in the Democratic Union of Liberation (UDEL), which fought for human rights and the restoration of democracy in Nicaragua. Chamorro’s political activism riled Somoza, who used threats, intimidation and, in many cases, brute force to try to stop his work. In 1954, Chamorro was jailed, tortured and imprisoned on charges of rebellion. A year later, the sentence was commuted to house arrest. The following year, Chamorro was arrested again during a brutal and bloody government crackdown following Somoza’s assassination, an act in which Chamorro was suspected of being complicit. In 1957, he was subsequently charged again with rebellion and banished to San Carlos, a remote town in northern Nicaragua. Chamorro, instead, fled to Costa Rica with his wife, Violeta Barrios de Chamorro, to regroup and organise a mission to overthrow the government of Somoza’s eldest son, Luis Somoza Debayle. Unfortunately, the group’s members were captured before their plan was executed. Chamorro was convicted of treason in a military trial and sentenced to nine years in prison. He was released in 1969, when he regained his editor post at La Prensa and continued his crusade against the Somoza regime – now led by Anastasio Somoza Debayle, the son of the former dictator. In 1975, the government imposed a 32-month suspension of constitutional rights in reaction to an attack from Cuban-backed rebels. The Somoza regime also imposed censorship measures on Chamorro and La Prensa. The paper was required to submit its pages for review by a board of censors composed of officers of the National Guard. Chamorro fought against the censorship and continued to press for Somoza’s removal from office, drawing the world’s attention to Nicaragua’s plight. “I am very optimistic. I see the end of the Somoza dynasty,” Chamorro said in a 1978 interview with Atlas World Press Review. “The majority of the people are against Somoza, except for the government workers. Somoza’s regime is near the end because he lost support of the U.S. administration and public opinion in America and Europe. The newspaper now gives the truth about Somoza. He is a thief. He doesn’t distinguish between his own interests and the inter- ests of the state. When the dynasty disappears it will happen in Nicaragua as it happened in Spain when Franco died.” Chamorro would not live to see his prophecy come true. The day he was murdered, 10 January 1978, was like any other. As was his habit, Chamorro made a quick trip that morning to his neighbourhood Catholic church before heading to work. His car was rammed from behind, trapping him as three men approached with machine guns and riddled the car with bullets. Chamorro died at the scene. He was 53. Chamorro’s wife, Violeta, who took over La Prensa after his death, said in a 1981 interview with the paper that she and her husband often spoke of his demise as the inevitable conclusion of his work. “During his last years we spoke of death as if it were a natural thing,” she said. “I, understandably, didn’t want to speak about it, but one has to be a realist and see that we are all going to die one day, perhaps earlier than we think.” Chamorro’s murder set off civil war in Nicaragua and ignited a groundswell of citizens to demand Somoza’s resignation. Tens of thousands of people rioted in the streets of Managua and in other parts of the country, setting buildings and cars ablaze, particularly those belonging to the Somoza family. Workers went on strike. The government retaliated with escalating violence, including seven machine-gun attacks and attempted bombings of La Prensa in 1978. The paper and Violeta continued Pedro’s crusade to end the Somoza regime. In 1990, Violeta Chamorro was elected president of Nicaragua. Chamorro’s courageous work as publisher and editor of La Prensa is summed up in a short inscription on his mausoleum in a Managua cemetery: “El nunca claudico – He never wavered.” 39 may ChIdIaC LEBANON 1964– 40 I n her more than 25 years in Lebanese journalism, May Chidiac has broken the barriers of tradition and gender. She managed to distinguish herself as a serious journalist from a very young age even when the odds were perfectly stacked against her. She was a woman in a war-torn country, without a father in a patriarchal society, but being who she was, she always managed to come out on top. Her professional success is only overshadowed by her success as a caring aunt and loyal sister. Around her huge family, which she affectionately calls her ‘tribe,’ she is known to be the aunt who gets you out of trouble. In Lebanon they call her the living martyr; in the United States they call her the living hero. Not only is May Chidiac a personal hero of many, but she is also a woman who makes you want to push yourself to achieve what others might think is impossible in the same manner that she did. Chidiac started her career as a radio news broadcaster at the Voice of Lebanon radio station, and managed to use her success in radio to jumpstart her television career as a war correspondent at the newly-formed LBC (Lebanese Broadcasting Corporation). She worked as a reporter in critical areas of Lebanon during the civil war. Death never seemed to faze her, and Chidiac’s strong will and personality helped cement her as one of Lebanese journalism’s elite. She soon became a star as an editor, news anchor and host of political talk shows, and she became known for being among the few to publicly challenge the Syrian hegemony over Lebanon. From 1998 to 2005, she fought for freedom through her television show Nharkom Saiid (Good Morning Lebanon) by bringing in guests who spoke openly and defiantly against Syria’s interference. She was harassed by threatening messages that were meant to scare her, but which had the exact opposite effect. She finally saw the fruition of her long struggle with the Lebanese resistance on 14 March 2005 when over a million Lebanese gathered in Martyr’s Square to protest against the assassination of former Prime Minister Rafik Hariri and demand the withdrawal of the Syrian military from Lebanon. October 2004 marked the beginning of a series of assassinations targeting prominent public figures. On 25 August 2005, Chidiac was a victim of an improvised explosive device placed under her car. The bomb caused her to lose her left arm, and her left leg was amputated above the knee. Chidiac has undergone 33 surgeries in Beirut and Paris along with a difficult recovery in a French rehabilitation centre. However, the would-be-as- sassins who planned her execution never really got what they wanted. In July 2006, 10 months after the assassination attempt, Chidiac was back on-air in an evening prime-time talk-show called “Bikol Joraa” (With Audacity) that soon became a top-rated hit centering on national, regional and international news. On 3 February 2009, as a protest against political interference in her work and the oppression of journalists, Chidiac decided to cease broadcasting her acclaimed programme. She believes her decision has successfully restored respect to both the profession of journalism and Lebanon’s living martyrs. Chidiac has received numerous global honours and acknowledgments, including the Prix de la Francophonie pour la Liberté d’Expression in 2005, the UNESCO/Guillermo Cano World Press Freedom Prize in 2006 and the International Women’s Media Foundation (IWMF) Courage in Journalism Award. In May 2007, Chidiac was decorated by the then-French President Jacques Chirac with the Chevalier de l’Ordre de la Légion d’Honneur medal at the Elysée Palace. The same year, she published her autobiography “Le Ciel M’attendra” (Heaven Will Wait for Me). Aside from her media career, Chidiac taught journalism at Notre Dame University (NDU) in Lebanon and, in 2006, launched the May Chidiac Foundation, which is dedicated to education, social welfare and human rights with an emphasis on women’s rights. She also set up the MCF Media Institute, a non-partisan, non-profit organisation dedicated to research and training on issues regarding the media and democracy. In 2008, Chidiac finally gained her PhD, which she had intended to submit in 2005 until the assassination attempt forced her to place her studies on hold. Re-written following the events of that fateful day, her thesis – entitled “The Influence of Politics on the Evolution of the Television Landscape in Lebanon, 1958-2008” – was awarded high distinction by the assessment jury at the Pantheon-Assas Paris II University. They say that it is easy to kill a person, but impossible to kill an idea, and that is what Chidiac is – an idea that exemplifies resistance and persistence. A persistence in resisting the oppression of her people and her profession; that is precisely what placed her on the hit list of those who could not bear the words that she spoke. One can only hope that the acts and words of May Chidiac have inspired a new generation of journalists willing to carry the flame of true journalistic values without hesitation and fear. Written by May Chidiac’s nephew, Fadi Baaklini. AVE GOOD INFORMATION. T LES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG TH FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF NCE THIS BELIEF THE MENT OFWITH UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS A JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST ANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE AMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGP TO WORK TOWARDS THEPEOPLES. FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶• SO AMONG ¶ · TH N OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • T AL ¶ 1. THE ORGANISATION NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF TH SSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THE UN UNIVERSAL DECLARAT ORDANCE WITHTHISBELIEFTHERE ISESTABLISHEDAN CESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, F ONAL DE LA PRESSE, IN FREN ROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE A ND PEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARE TOUNDERSTAND ONEANO ANGUAGES OF THE INSTIT RSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WOR UANT SECTION 60 ET SE GUARDING OFTO FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS M NDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOP YSTEMS DPEACEDEPENDSFOUNDATIONS, ONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENO P DSUNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISTOBRINGAB S, IF ANY, OF THE INSTITUTE EFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEAN XPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UND MINARS, CONFERENCES, E THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNAL ONIC MATERIAL ON THE INT GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL F THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WOR URPOSES, THE INSTITUTE S TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW EXCHANGEASSUMES OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AM ITTEE ANY LIAB S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIA NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDA ARTICLE II ¶ MEMBERSHIP ¶ EEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE AC GENCIES TV AND RADIO GST JOURNALISTSOR AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE EDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESA Clockwise from left: Police inspect May Chidiac’s car after a bomb explosion that resulted in the loss of part of her left arm and leg, 2005; Chidiac among demonstrators during a rally where journalists walked toward the Hariri’s Future TV station that was forced to close by Hezbollah guerrillas in Beirut, 2008; Chidiac sits with Siham Tueni and her daughters during the WAN Gebran Tueni Award ceremony in Beirut, 2007. Chidiac, a 2006 UNESCO/Guillermo Cano World Press Freedom Prize Laureate, speaks in Paris at a forum in her honour, 2009. HAT THEY HAVE GOOsUK-Chae NACCORDANCEW ChoI WHICHISMEANT:FR ALISTS AND SO AM E I ¶ GENERAL ¶ 1. T EXIXINTHEUNUNIV NTERNATIONALDE E OFFICIAL LANGUA ATION PURSUANT T DIO AND TV SYSTEM ETEARNINGS,IFANY CATIONS, SEMINAR VIEWS.¶•THEACHIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSO OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDIN N.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLE ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE F EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE AC RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRA DONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFO FTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORGA HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PU ONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BA GBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN RTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT VEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶• FJOURNALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLE AMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTU OWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFE F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTA WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶W NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP T DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOW ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAP MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THA UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE W SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS T NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROM NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPE TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDE WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGU F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTA WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶W NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP T DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOW ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAP MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THA UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE W SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS T NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROM NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPE TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDE WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGU F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTA WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶W NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP T DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOW SOUTH KOREA 1917–1991 I n 1964, General Park Chung-hee’s military regime moved to clamp down on the media in South Korea. The idea was to pass a press code of ethics, an odious set of rules and regulations to muffle independent reporting. But Suk-Chae Choi, a long-time journalist and vice chairman of the Korean Newspaper Editors’ Association fought back. As he had done three years earlier when he refused a request from Chung-hee to make a radio statement and write articles supporting his regime, Choi balked at the ethics code and challenged it at every turn. Choi’s relentless opposition to the bill and defense of press freedom in Korea wore down the regime, which eventually gave up on the idea. The episode is legendary in Korean journalism but was not unique for Choi. Throughout his nearly 50 years in journalism, Choi courageously opposed communism and official wrongdoing, defending press freedom and serving as an inspiration for journalists during South Korean’s transition to democracy in the late 1980s. Choi believed it was his duty to fight for a free press. “Journalists should keep their pride high in spite of any oppression or difficulty,” Choi said shortly before his death. Born on 21 November 1917 in Boeun, North Chung-Chong Province, Choi began his journalism career in 1942 as a magazine reporter. He later worked for the daily Maeil in Tae-gu, first as a managing editor and then as an editorial writer before becoming editor in chief. Choi was a frequent critic of the government. In 1955, he wrote an article for Maeil entitled “Don’t Capitalize on Students for Political Gains” in which he blasted corrupt Democratic Party officials for forcing students to applaud them during public speeches. In retaliation for the piece, Choi was forcibly removed from Maeli’s offices and detained by police for 30 days. He was later acquitted of any wrongdoing by the Supreme Court. In 1960, Choi went to work for Chosun Ilbo, a national daily. He continued his crusade against communism, writing his columns and articles unsigned to avoid government reprisal. His 1960 article “Let’s Stand Up Against the Government” criticised government fraud and led to a series of student protests in April of that year. His work drew widespread attention once again in 1963 when he wrote “Rebuke Officers with No Common Sense” in response to a demonstration against a civilian government by hundreds of officers and soldiers supportive of General Chung-hee’s regime. Still, Choi considered his defeat of the press code of ethics bill his greatest career triumph. He was later offered several positions within the government, including ministerial posts, but refused them all in favour of his beloved journalism. Choi was appointed editor-in-chief of Chosun Ilbo in 1965. He was also chairman of Munhwa Broadcasting Company, honorary chairman of Maeil and chairman of the Korean IPI National Committee. Choi died on 15 April 1991. He was 74. Suk-Chae Choi, pictured here, spent nearly 50 years in journalism, much of that time as editorin-chief of South Korea’s Chosun Ilbo newspaper. 43 JúlIo de mesquIta neto BRAZIL 1922–1966 I n 1968, the Fifth Institutional Act went into effect in Brazil, granting the government wide latitude in censoring the printed media. Every newspaper and magazine was required to submit to government censorship. The board of censors, acting as ‘guardians of the state,’ edited all offending stories and images from the publications and, in some instances, banned them from publishing at all. The censorship dealt a devastating blow to the publications, many of which folded. Others resorted to self-censorship to stay alive. And then there was O Estado de S. Paulo (The State of São Paulo), whose courageous publisher Júlio De Mesquita Neta protested the censorship with poetry, replacing the edited articles with excerpts from famed 16th-century poet Luís Vaz de Camões’ opus, “Os Lusiadas.” The tale about Portuguese adventures in the Orient became a symbol of O Estado’s adventures in government repression, alerting readers that their paper had been altered and putting Mesquita Neta’s battle against censorship on public display. Born on 11 December 1922 in São Paulo, Mesquita Neto joined O Estado as a reporter in 1947 after graduation from the University of São Paulo. Passion for free expression and freedom of the press was in his blood. His grandfather, Julio Mesquita, began the fight at the turn of the century as O Estado’s publisher, his clashes with the government landing him in prison on more than one occasion. Mesquita Neto’s father, Júlio de Mesquita Filho, carried the torch on the paper’s 44 editorial pages, where government threats twice forced him into exile. After working as a reporter and an editor, Mesquita Neto succeeded his father as publisher in 1969. Under Mesquita Neto, O Estado grew to a staff of more than 400 journalists, providing the most comprehensive coverage of any newspaper in the region. The paper became required reading for people of influence in Brazil. It also became a target when Mesquita Neto refused to censor his pages as decreed by the government. Over Mesquita Neto’s objections, the government’s censors staged a takeover of the paper, planting themselves in the editorial department for five years. In place of the hundreds of articles the censors cut during that time, Mesquita Neto ran snippets of Camões’ poem. All told, the poem appeared in the paper 665 times. “O Estado did not passively accept the censorship that was submitted,” Mesquita Neto said in October 1973 at a general meeting of the Inter American Press Association. The government’s oppression didn’t stop at censorship, however. O Estado journalists were also pressured, persecuted and threatened because of their work. In March 1974, the paper’s Recife bureau chief, Carlos Garcia, was arrested and tortured. In October 1975, Luiz Costa, the Sao Jose dos Campos correspondent was arrested and tortured. That same year, the government’s censorship campaign began to ease a little with the adminis- AVE GOOD NCEWITH ANT:FREE SO AMON AL ¶ 1. THE UNUNIVE tration of President Ernesto Geisel. It was a ‘compromise’ that Mesquita Neto did not fully trust, viewing the new-found freedom of information as a posture of the government that could be reversed on a whim. Mesquita Neto vowed that the paper would continue to resist any efforts by the establishment to restrict its journalism. “Estado will not change its opinions. Under a totalitarian regime, we will be oppressed and continue to fight for freedom. Under a free regime, we will worry about the dangers and excesses of democracy,” he said in a 1975 Time magazine interview. “It’s really easier for Brazil to change than it is for Estado to change.” O Estado’s pioneering journalism established Mesquita Neto as one of the most ardent opponents of the military regimes that ruled Brazil between 1964 and 1985. And through his work with the Inter American Press Association, including a stint as president, Mesquita Neto was a champion of press freedom throughout Latin America. He was awarded the World Association of Newspapers’ Golden Pen of Freedom in 1974 for his “brave and lonely fight against censorship in Brazil.” On 5 June 1996, Mesquita Neto died of cancer. He was 73. His funeral was attended by hundreds, including Brazil’s freely-elected president, Fernando Henrique Cardoso, whose position was made possible in part because of Mesquita Neto’s calls for democracy in the pages of O Estado. LES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED A FURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREEACCESSTOTHENEWS,FREETRANSMISSIONOFNEWS,FRE MENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHANGEOFACCURATEANDBALA JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, AMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALISTSOFTHEWORLD.¶IN TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: F N OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PE SSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGA ORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORGANISATIONTOWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEAN CESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UND ROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURN NDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALS RSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK GUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NE NDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHANGEOFACCURATEANDBALANCEDNEWSAMONG DPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATT DSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALISTSOFTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHT EFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREEACCESSTOTHENEW XPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEO GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AM F THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FR TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGS EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UN NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE EEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FRE GST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATION EDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAV DERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS OLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS XPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEO GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AM F THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FR TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGS EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UN NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE EEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FRE GST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATION EDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAV DERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS OLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS XPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEO GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AM F THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FR TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGS EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UN NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE EEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FRE GST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATION EDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAV DERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS OLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS XPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEO GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AM F THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FR TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGS EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UN NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE EEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH MEANT: Júlio IS de Mesquita Neto, FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FRE GST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATION publisher of O Estado de S. Paulo, courageously PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAV EDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDING BETWEEN protested censorship DERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS on print OLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE imposed FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS media by the Brazilian XPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE government. THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEO GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AM F THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FR TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGS EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UN NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE EEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FRE GST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATION EDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAV DERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS OLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS JIří o dIenstBIer CZECH REPUBLIC 1937– 46 n August 21 1968, enduringly his proudest moment, Jiří Dienstbier and his colleagues at Radio Prague locked the Warsaw Pact representatives in a cupboard and continued to broadcast until Czech politician Alexander Dubček returned a week later and dragged Czechoslovakia into “the time of darkness.” This slightly mischievous, exceedingly daring character trait rings true throughout Dienstbier’s life, coupled with an unwavering optimism and ability to see the best in even the worst of situations. When the Iron Curtain was drawn across Czechoslovakia with the Soviet invasion of August 1968, Dienstbier’s legitimate livelihood also suffered. In 1969 he was branded a dissident and expelled from the Journalists’ Union, along with 1,500 other members; in 1970 he was dismissed from broadcasting. No longer permitted to publish legally, he went underground publishing Čtverec (The Square), bringing hope to his compatriots. “I believed then, as always, that life may be decent, and the only problem is that it sometimes takes decades before you get to it,” he said in an interview. Until the fall of communism in 1989, his “decent” future was making a living as an archivist, night-watchman and stoker. Born 20 April 1937 in Kladno, Czechoslovakia, Dienstbier had a burning passion to learn from an early age: “I was interested in foreign policy; I bought my first history of diplomacy, three books, at the age of 10, so I studied it all my life,” he once said. He graduated from Charles University, Prague, in 1960 with a master of arts degree from the faculty of philosophy, so, when he was jettisoned from “the lazy job of a boiler-man to become foreign minister of Czechoslovakia,” he was able to take it in his stride. From the day the Soviet Union occupied his homeland Dienstbier started fighting. While he continued to publish hundreds of samizdat essays and articles as well as books both at home and abroad, he was also a part of the group of prominent Czech intellectuals involved in preparing democratic changes. In 1977, he was among one of the first signatories of Charter 77, a human rights movement based on International Covenants on Human Rights. His arrest and incarceration in 1979 for his opposition to the regime did not interfere with his crusade. “I said many times, even to my mates in prison, that life is everywhere, and I always tried to use every experience as something positive.Say, ‘I am here for three years and I must profit from it as much as possible.’ ” Aside from joining the International Press Institute in 1988, over the following decade, Dien- stbier was instrumental in preparing the ground for the Civic Forum, which aimed at unifying all anti-authoritarian forces to overthrow the communist regime. Using peaceful protest, the Velvet Revolution succeeded when, on 28 November 1989 the Communist government relinquished power, and left the new Czech Republic to make its own ‘decent life.’ Dienstbier laughs about forming the new government: “Because Mr. Čalfa understood that we were not some hippies and we understood that he was no Biľak or Jakes, in two hours the government was formed and it was necessary to work.” The new republic prepared to move forward as an independent state. As part of the fairly ad hoc government, Dienstbier was appointed Deputy Prime Minister and Minister of Foreign Affairs of the Czech and Slovak Federal Republic on 10 December 1989, and remained as such until 1992. Dienstbier was the proud co-founder and chairman of the editorial board of the paper that symbolised the Velvet Revolution, the samizdat monthly Lidové Noviny (People's News), which began publishing openly in January 1988 – initially twice a week and after April 1990 as a daily. In 1990, speaking at the 39th IPI General Assembly in Bordeaux, Dienstbier commended the international media for its role in bringing freedom to his country: “The influence of samizdat newspapers in Czechoslovakia was strengthened by cooperation with the world media and international press organisations. Without this understanding from members of the international community we could never have succeeded”. After receiving an honorary doctorate in 1993 from the University of Burgundy, France, Dienstbier has been an active lecturer throughout Europe and in the United States, as well as “working as ambassador at large, as former foreign minister for specific negotiations, because some things are better negotiated in unofficial discussions.” He continues to add to his library of published works both about his experiences as minister and about the Balkan events of the Nineties. From 1998 till 2001 he worked as a United Nations special rapporteur on human rights for former Yugoslavia; in 2005, he became a trustee and director at Reuters Founders Share Company, where he works to preserve media independence, integrity and freedom. “If someone asks me the basic question whether I am satisfied, I say, ‘Of course,’ because I have lived for so many decades after my activities. The greatest honour for me was the end of the former regime. It would be enough for one life. “Now the important issue: What next?” s.NCE ¶ • tHEWITH ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATIO OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACEFREE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOP FREEAFUNDAMENTAL ACCESS TOSTEP THE NEWS, TRANSMISSION NEWS N.ANT: THEREFORE, TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISOF TO BRING ABO ED ANAMONG ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AN SO PEOPLES. ¶ · THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANG EWS, PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS,DEFENDS FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THEPERSONAL ACHIEVEMENT OFFR UN AL ¶FREE 1. THE ORGANISATION EVERYONE’S RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOUR UN UNIVERSAL DECLARATION OF HUMAN RIGHTS, (DEC. 1948 ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A10, FUNDAMEN S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO ONAL DE LA PRESSE, IN FRENCH; INSTITUTO INTERNACIONAL DE L S,ANGUAGES BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATIO OF THE BE ENGLISH, FRENCH, GER ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THEINSTITUTE PROMOTION OFSHALL THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCE UANT TO SECTION 60 ET SEQ. OF THE SWISS CIVIL CODE. THE RES RSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IFPEOPLES ARE TOUNDERSTAND ONEANOTHER, ITISE NG PEOPLES ISFOUNDATIONS, TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN AC YSTEMS OTHER INSTITUTIONS AND BUSINESSES ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH ISOF MEANT: FR S, IF ANY, OF THE INSTITUTE SHALL ENURE TO THE BENEFIT ANY S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDINGTRAINING BETWEEN PEOP MINARS, CONFERENCES, EXCHANGE PROGRAMMES, N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEPINTERNET, TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABO ONIC MATERIAL ON THE THE SENDING OF DELEGATION ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AN URPOSES, THE INSTITUTE SHALL PROMOTE A FAIR BALANCE EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OFOF UNW RATE ANDASSUMES BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ •LEGAL THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OFTHE JOUR ITTEE ANY LIABILITY, OR OTHERWISE, FOR ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMEN ARTICLE II¶MEMBERSHIP ¶1.THIS FULL MEMBERSHIP OFAN THE INSTITUT S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED ORGANISATION TO GENCIES TV AND RADIO BROADCASTING SYSTEMS THE S, BY WHICH ISOR MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS,OR FREEON PUBLICATIO ND SOWHO, AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREEDECLARE EXCHANGE OFFORMALLY ACCURATE AND BALANCE AND IN SEEKING MEMBERSHIP, AND BE RSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS FULL MEMBERSHIP CAN BEACQUIRED ASJOURNALISTS FOLLOWS: NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE OF IN THECOUNTRI WORLD. ¶ IN AC E¶POWER TOINITIALLY DETERMINE WHETHER ORBY NOT TOISPEOPLES.¶ ENROL ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, WHICH MEANT: FRT S.STITUTE’S • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG • DIRECTOR, WHO ALONE SHALL HAVE THE POWER TO IN OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOP OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶ 3. MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE ON AN IN N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABO ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AN RNAL, NEWS AGENCY, TV OR RADIO BROADCASTING SYSTEM OR EWS, PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION VIEWS. ¶MEMBER • THE ACHIEVEMENT YRATE BEFREE REPRESENTED BY MORE THAN ONEOFFULL UP OF TOOF AUNL AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES JOUR HE PRESS AND CO-OPERATING INTHE INSTITUTE’S O ND ONE ANOTHER, IT ISDESIROUS ESSENTIAL THATOF THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMEN S OF THEFACULTIES, WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO ALISM LAWYERS AND ADVISORS. ¶ · AS AFFILIATE ME S, BY WHICHOF IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TOMAGAZINES, THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREEOR PUBLICATIO CTIONS NEWSPAPERS, BROADCASTING NEW ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCE RAMME ORPRESENTERS, PERSONS HOLDING RSTANDINGEDITORS BETWEENPEOPLES ANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLES ARETOUNDERSTAND ONESIMILAR ANOTHER,ITISED E NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN AC ANY ONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, RADIO, TV ORGANISATION O ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FR PLICANTS PROCURE WRITTENAMONGST APPROVAL FROM EDITOR-I S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING JOURNALISTS ANDTHEIR SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • TTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BE MADE TO THE NATIONAL COMM OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOP N.RE THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABO THERE ARE NO NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS FOR M ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AN TEWS, TOENROL THEAPPLICANTS. INEXPRESSION ALLCASES, ENROLMENTS ARE SU FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UN VITIES THE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY SHALL HAVE NO VOTING RIG RATE ANDOF BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOUR ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMEN LS OF BETHE HALF THE DUES FORWITH ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP. ¶ORGANISATION IPICONSTIT WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN TO ICATIONS DEPARTMENTS OF UNIVERSITIES AND COLLEGES, SCH S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATIO ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶MEMBERS • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCE NSTITUTIONAL MAY PARTICIPATE IN ALL THE INSTITU RSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES.IFPEOPLES ARETODELEGATES UNDERSTANDONE ITISE ECUTIVE BOARD. THE NUMBER OF THEIR ISANOTHER, NOT LIMIT NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN9 AC D.ES:INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS SHALL HAVE NO VOTING RIGHTS. ¶ ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FR S.RD ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS ANDAGREEMENT SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ SHALL BEOFFIXED BY THE DIRECTOR WITH THE OF• OF THE PRACTICES JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOP TRARY TOATHE PRINCIPLES SETUNDERSTANDING OUTINTHEPRESENT CONSTITUT N. THEREFORE, FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABO ION NOTTOBE ORDERED EXCEPT ON THE APPROVAL OF TW ED ANSHALL ORGANISATION WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AN EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREECAUSES, EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶BE • THEGIVEN ACHIEVEMENT OF UNM STATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED SHALL TO THE Above: Former German Foreign Minister Hans Dietrich Genscher and Jiří Dienstbier look through a gap in the wall covered by barbed wire in Nove Domky where the two cut the wire as a symbol of liberty on 23 December 1989. Below: Dienstbier accepts the IPI World Press Freedom Hero Award at the IPI World Congress in Boston, 2000. hrant dInK TURKEY 1954–2007 48 C hampion of human and minority rights in Turkey and advocate for Turkish-Armenian reconciliation, Hrant Dink was the founder and editor in chief, journalist and columnist of the bilingual weekly Agos that was first printed on 5 April 1996. The paper was established to give Armenian minorities a voice and the chance to communicate with Turkish society by publishing in both Turkish and Armenian. In February 2006 Dink said, “I want to write and ask how we can change this historical conflict into peace.” However Dink did not live to see peace. Murdered on 19 January 2007 after many death threats, he was shot twice in the head and once in the neck by a 17-year-old ultra-nationalist, Ogün Samast. At his funeral, held on 23 January, banners read: “We are all Armenians” and “We are all Hrant Dink,” while Armenian songs filled the air as over 100,000 mourners filled the streets to silently protest his assassination. In the week before his death, Hrant Dink’s lawyer said that his client was “nervous and afraid” for his life because of mounting hate mail about an article Dink had written in 2004 about the Armenian genocide, for which he was being prosecuted. In his last column on 10 January 2007, Dink wrote: “It is obvious that those wishing to alienate me and make me weak and defenceless have reached their goal. Right now they have brought about a significant circle of people who are not low in number and who regard me as someone ‘insulting Turkish identity’ due to dirty and false information.” While Turkish nationalists considered his reports to be treacherous, Dink also faced three legal prosecutions accusing him of denigrating ‘Turkishness’ under the country’s restrictive Article 301, which the Turkish government is under increasing pressure to repeal since his murder. Although often critical of both Turkey’s denial of the World War I Armenian genocide, and of the diaspora’s campaign for its international recognition, Dink made it his career’s purpose to harmonise the discordant nations. Despite having no formal training in journalism, Dink appealed to his Agos audience through his editorials and to a broader Turkish audience in columns in two of Turkey’s dailies. Said novelist Elif Shafak at his funeral: “As a true supporter of freedom of expression, Hrant believed that it should be up to people – Turks and Armenians together – to develop the means to reconcile, and not for politicians to dictate knowledge of history.” It was not long before Dink was considered a leader within the Armenian community and a well-known public figure in Turkey. Dink was born the eldest of three sons on 15 September 1954 in Malatya. After his family was destroyed by Dink’s father’s gambling addiction, Hrant’s grandfather enrolled the penniless boys at the Gedikpaşa Armenian Orphanage, but continued to support them and offer them a positive, educated role model. Schooled at the orphanage, every summer the brothers stayed at the Tuzla Armenian Children’s Camp, where Dink met his future wife, Rakel Yağbasan, and where he became aware of the Armenian community’s struggle for acceptance in Turkey. After receiving his degree in zoology from Istanbul University, where he became a Communist sympathiser, Dink entered military service. Hrant was denied promotion to sergeant, which he believed was because of his nationality. Although he had been subject to discrimination, Hrant “was free of anger and resentment,” said Shafak in her eulogy. When the owner of the Tuzla camp was imprisoned for anti-Turkish propaganda, the Dinks took over the camp’s management; it was later closed down. A 1974 ruling stated minority foundations were forbidden to buy new land after 1936. Having spent so much of his life at the camp, Dink was deeply affected by its closure: “I went to Tuzla when I was 8. I poured my labour in there for 20 years. I met my wife Rakel there. We grew up together. We were married in the camp. Our children were born there ...” Despite the new owner’s offer to return the camp, legislation decrees that the land remain empty, a shell of the life it used to contain. Dink married his childhood sweetheart on 19 April 1976. They had three children: Arat, who adopted his murdered father’s job and crusade, Delal, and Sera. At his funeral, Rakel remembered her husband as “half of my soul, my beloved, the father of my children and your brother.” She urged mourners to conduct a slogan-free, peaceful march that would “generate immense sound through our silence” proclaiming that “what made [Hrant Dink] great was his living spirit, his deeds, his style, and the love in his eyes and his heart. It was what he did, the style he chose, the love in his heart that made him great.” s.NCE ¶ • tHEWITH ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATIO OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACEFREE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOP FREEAFUNDAMENTAL ACCESS TOSTEP THE NEWS, TRANSMISSION NEWS N.ANT: THEREFORE, TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISOF TO BRING ABO ED ANAMONG ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AN SO PEOPLES. ¶ · THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANG EWS, PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS,DEFENDS FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THEPERSONAL ACHIEVEMENT OFFR UN AL ¶FREE 1. THE ORGANISATION EVERYONE’S RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOUR UN UNIVERSAL DECLARATION OF HUMAN RIGHTS, (DEC. 1948 ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A10, FUNDAMEN S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO ONAL DE LA PRESSE, IN FRENCH; INSTITUTO INTERNACIONAL DE L S,ANGUAGES BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATIO OF THE BE ENGLISH, FRENCH, GER ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THEINSTITUTE PROMOTION OFSHALL THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCE UANT TO SECTION 60 ET SEQ. OF THE SWISS CIVIL CODE. THE RES RSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IFPEOPLES ARE TOUNDERSTAND ONEANOTHER, ITISE NG PEOPLES ISFOUNDATIONS, TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN AC YSTEMS OTHER INSTITUTIONS AND BUSINESSES ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH ISOF MEANT: FR S, IF ANY, OF THE INSTITUTE SHALL ENURE TO THE BENEFIT ANY S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDINGTRAINING BETWEEN PEOP MINARS, CONFERENCES, EXCHANGE PROGRAMMES, N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEPINTERNET, TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABO ONIC MATERIAL ON THE THE SENDING OF DELEGATION ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AN URPOSES, THE INSTITUTE SHALL PROMOTE A FAIR BALANCE EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OFOF UNW RATE ANDASSUMES BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ •LEGAL THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OFTHE JOUR ITTEE ANY LIABILITY, OR OTHERWISE, FOR ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMEN ARTICLE II¶MEMBERSHIP ¶1.THIS FULL MEMBERSHIP OFAN THE INSTITUT S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED ORGANISATION TO GENCIES TV AND RADIO BROADCASTING SYSTEMS THE S, BY WHICH ISOR MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS,OR FREEON PUBLICATIO ND SOWHO, AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREEDECLARE EXCHANGE OFFORMALLY ACCURATE AND BALANCE AND IN SEEKING MEMBERSHIP, AND BE RSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS FULL MEMBERSHIP CAN BEACQUIRED ASJOURNALISTS FOLLOWS: NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE OF IN THECOUNTRI WORLD. ¶ IN AC E¶POWER TOINITIALLY DETERMINE WHETHER ORBY NOT TOISPEOPLES.¶ ENROL ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, WHICH MEANT: FRT S.STITUTE’S • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG • DIRECTOR, WHO ALONE SHALL HAVE THE POWER TO IN OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOP OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶ 3. MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE ON AN IN N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABO ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AN RNAL, NEWS AGENCY, TV OR RADIO BROADCASTING SYSTEM OR EWS, PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION VIEWS. ¶MEMBER • THE ACHIEVEMENT YRATE BEFREE REPRESENTED BY MORE THAN ONEOFFULL UP OF TOOF AUNL AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES JOUR HE PRESS AND CO-OPERATING INTHE INSTITUTE’S O ND ONE ANOTHER, IT ISDESIROUS ESSENTIAL THATOF THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMEN S OF THEFACULTIES, WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO ALISM LAWYERS AND ADVISORS. ¶ · AS AFFILIATE ME S, BY WHICHOF IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TOMAGAZINES, THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREEOR PUBLICATIO CTIONS NEWSPAPERS, BROADCASTING NEW ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCE RAMME ORPRESENTERS, PERSONS HOLDING RSTANDINGEDITORS BETWEENPEOPLES ANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLES ARETOUNDERSTAND ONESIMILAR ANOTHER,ITISED E NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN AC ANY ONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, RADIO, TV ORGANISATION O ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FR PLICANTS PROCURE WRITTENAMONGST APPROVAL FROM EDITOR-I S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING JOURNALISTS ANDTHEIR SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • TTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BE MADE TO THE NATIONAL COMM OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOP N.RE THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABO THERE ARE NO NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS FOR M ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AN TEWS, TOENROL THEAPPLICANTS. INEXPRESSION ALLCASES, ENROLMENTS ARE SU FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UN VITIES THE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY SHALL HAVE NO VOTING RIG RATE ANDOF BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOUR ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMEN LS OF BETHE HALF THE DUES FORWITH ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP. ¶ORGANISATION IPICONSTIT WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN TO ICATIONS DEPARTMENTS OF UNIVERSITIES AND COLLEGES, SCH S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATIO ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶MEMBERS • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCE NSTITUTIONAL MAY PARTICIPATE IN ALL THE INSTITU RSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES.IFPEOPLES ARETODELEGATES UNDERSTANDONE ITISE ECUTIVE BOARD. THE NUMBER OF THEIR ISANOTHER, NOT LIMIT NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN9 AC D.ES:INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS SHALL HAVE NO VOTING RIGHTS. ¶ ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FR S.RD ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS ANDAGREEMENT SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ SHALL BEOFFIXED BY THE DIRECTOR WITH THE OF• OF THE PRACTICES JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOP TRARY TOATHE PRINCIPLES SETUNDERSTANDING OUTINTHEPRESENT CONSTITUT N. THEREFORE, FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABO ION NOTTOBE ORDERED EXCEPT ON THE APPROVAL OF TW ED ANSHALL ORGANISATION WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AN EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREECAUSES, EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶BE • THEGIVEN ACHIEVEMENT OF UNM STATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED SHALL TO THE Above: A protester leaves a banner reading “For Hrant, for justic” next to a portrait of Hrant Dink, pictured below, in front of the Agos newspaper office during a demonstration in Istanbul on 19 January 2010 to mark the third anniversary of his killing. harold evans UNITED KINGDOM 1928– d ubbed for his services to journalism, Sir Harold Evans was the knight in shining armour for hundreds of thalidomide-inflicted children suffering devastating birth defects. One of the most memorable days in his life was 26 April 1976 when, having battled both the drug companies and the British government, he won a famous victory in the European Court of Human Rights against the House of Lords’ suppression of thalidomide articles, securing compensation and a life for the families, and instituting a change in the law which had inhibited the reporting of civil cases. It was not the first time, nor would it be the last, that Evans risked his livelihood and reputation championing a cause in which he passionately believed. As a young editor at The Northern Echo, he campaigned successfully for a national cervical cancer detection programme, and for a posthumous pardon for a man wrongly accused of murder. No doubt Harold Evans’ parents believed in their first son, but they could not have imagined the frail little boy born on 28 June 1928 in Manchester, England, would vault from his working class origins to become one of Britain’s most respected, award-winning journalists and the head of many leading publications both in the UK and the United States. Failing to win a place in high school, he got a job as a reporter and caught up. Or, as he wryly put it: “I left school at 15, but raced along at university later on – well, someone has to blow one’s trumpet!” As a member of the International Press Institute for nearly 50 years, he has long been actively committed to international press freedom. In the 1960s he conducted seminars in Southeast Asia, freely offering his time, skills and knowledge to empower news editors and reporters in developing countries, so that they could make more direct and effective contact with their populations. A vital end product of the seminars was The Active Newsroom, the first IPI manual, edited by Evans, for news editors in the developing world. 50 Having survived the German bombing of his hometown in World War II, Evans was called to national service in the Royal Air Force in 1946. In 1949, he achieved an honours degree in politics and economics at the University of Durham, became an assistant editor of the Manchester Evening News and subsequently earned a master’s degree for a thesis evaluating how the Suez crisis of 1956 was reported in the American press. The award of a Harkness Fellowship (195657) enabled him to travel throughout the United States and study at both the University of Chicago and Stanford University. On his return to the UK, he successfully won editorship of The Northern Echo, which led him to be invited to join The Sunday Times of London. During his 14 years as its prize-winning editor, he changed forever the landscape of investigative reporting. Under his guidance, The Sunday Times challenged stories and scandals which were officially denied or ignored, presenting them for public scrutiny. In 1981, he became editor of The Times, the only person ever to edit both these prestigious newspapers. Evans believes passionately in the importance of journalism: “All the argument about print versus the web misses the point,” he writes in his new autobiography. “In the end it’s not the delivery vehicle that counts. It’s what it delivers. We’ll always need a vigilant press, a vibrant press, that reports faithfully but also explores and brings to light the hidden stories and mischiefs – and that is best assured by a diverse, free and competitive press.” He jokes, “You know I may even have missed a few stories myself.” In editing The Sunday Times, his frustration with suppressive laws led him to dub the British press the ‘half-free press.’ The famous Insight team Evans established at the start of his editorship fought hard to publish the Kim Philby Soviet spy scandal and stories of financial wrongdoing. He was threatened with jail for challenging the Official Secrets Act by publishing the revealing diaries of former Labour minister Richard Crossman. Dispirited by labour stoppages, the papers’ unflinchingly supportive owners put The Sunday Times and Times up for sale. Evans led a management attempt to buy out and run The Sunday Times, but management preferred to sell to Rupert Murdoch. “They thought Murdoch would be able to handle the unions,” he says. “They were,” he conceded with good humour, “proved quite right in this judgement.” Certainly, Murdoch freed the British press of the print union obstructions, and that led the way to the modern computer typesetting and display the unions had resisted, thus at one blow making all British newspapers viable. Evans went on to edit The Times for one colourful year, but found the cherished political independence of the paper under siege, and sensationally resigned. He accepted an invitation to America to teach about the press and law at Duke University, eventually becoming editorial director of the Washington-based news magazine US News and World Report. Tina Brown, his new wife, was by this time editing (and saving) Vanity Fair magazine and then The New Yorker. “Bifurcated between D.C. and New York,” as he put it, “we could not easily start a family, so after two years I joined her in New York.” In all these years, he had been researching and writing a monumental, illustrated history of American politics from 1889-1989. “The American Century” was an acclaimed bestseller in 1998, and in 2004, he followed it with another, the first and only history of American innovation over 200 years, called “They Made America: From the Steam Engine to the Search Engine, Two Centuries of Innovators.” In 2009, he released his autobiography “My Paper Chase,” receiving plaudits for its writing. He was prompted to look back, he says, by his children’s wonderment about whether he had spent his life well or badly. Asked what his best times have been, he chuckled. “I am an incurable optimist. The best is yet to come.” NCEWITHTHISBELIEF THERE ISESTABLISHED ANORGANISATION TOWORKISTOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJEC FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTAN ANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EX ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDIN SO AMONG PEOPLES. ¶ · THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMON CATION NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION VIEWS. ¶FREEDOM, • THE ACHIEVEMENT OFOF UNDERSTANDING AL ¶ 1. THEOF ORGANISATION DEFENDS EVERYONE’SOF PERSONAL THE FREEDOM EXPRESSION AND,AIN NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD UNUNIVERSALDECLARATIONOFHUMANRIGHTS,(DEC.10,1948).¶2.THENAMEOFTHEORGANISATIONSHALL ONAL LAPRESSE,IN FRENCH; INSTITUTO INTERNACIONAL DELA PRENSA,INA SPANISH; INTERNATIONALES PR ER, ITDE IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEYSHALL HAVEBE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWA ANGUAGES OF THE INSTITUTE ENGLISH, FRENCH, GERMAN AND SPANISH; THE WORKING LANGUAG D.UANT ¶ IN TO ACCORDANCE WITH THIS THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWAR SECTION 60 ET SEQ. OF THEBELIEF SWISS CIVIL CODE. THE RESOURCES OF THE INSTITUTE ARE DERIVED FROM EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAP YSTEMS FOUNDATIONS, OTHER INSTITUTIONS AND BUSINESSES, WHICH SUPPORT THE PRINCIPLES OF FREED S, IFANY,OF• THE SHALL TOTHE BENEFITOFOF ANY MEMBERORAND INDIVIDUAL. ¶5.THE GOALS OFTH EOPLES.¶ THEINSTITUTE PROMOTION OFENURE THE FREE EXCHANGE ACCURATE BALANCED NEWS AMONG MINARS, CONFERENCES, EXCHANGE PROGRAMMES, TRAINING COURSES, ACADEMICIT LECTURES TV AND RADT WEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IS ESSENTIAL THAT ONIC MATERIAL ON THE INTERNET, THE SENDING OF DELEGATIONS AND MISSIONS TO COUNTRIES AND GOVERN O BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THEBALANCE JOURNALISTS OF THE ¶ INSTRUCTURES ACCORDANCE URPOSES, THE INSTITUTE SHALL PROMOTE A FAIR OF WOMEN ANDWORLD. MEN IN ITS ANDWIT IN HERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TONO TH ITTEE ASSUMES ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL OR OTHERWISE, FOR THE INSTITUTE, AND THE INSTITUTE ASSUMES L ARTICLE IIOF ¶MEMBERSHIP ¶1.FULL MEMBERSHIP OFTHEINSTITUTE ISOPEN TOPERSONS WITH RESPONSIBILITIE EMENT UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION GENCIES ORTVANDRADIOBROADCASTING SYSTEMS ONTHEINTERNET,WHO SUPPORT THEPRINCIPLE OFFR ES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ONOR UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLE AND WHO, IN SEEKING MEMBERSHIP, DECLARE FORMALLY AND BY WRITTEN STATEMENT THEIR WILLINGNESS T FUNDAMENTAL STEP UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTAN FULLMEMBERSHIP CANTOWARDS BEACQUIRED ASFOLLOWS:INCOUNTRIES WHERETHERE ARENATIONAL COMMITTEES ATION TOTO WORK TOWARDS THESHALL FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDIN EPOWER INITIALLY DETERMINE WHETHER ORNOT TOENROLTHE APPLICANTS. INCOUNTRIES WHERETHER STITUTE’S DIRECTOR, WHOALONE HAVETHE POWER TO INITIALLY DETERMINEOF WHETHER ORNOTTOENR CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT UNDERSTANDING AC OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶ 3. MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE ON AN INDIVIDUAL BASIS. HOWEVER, IF A NATIONAL NCED NEWSAGENCY, AMONGTVNATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD RNAL, NEWS OR RADIO BROADCASTING SYSTEM OR AN INTERNET SERVICE. ¶ 4. A NEWSPAPER, J ER, ITREPRESENTED IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE INFORMATION. THEREFORE, TOWA Y BE BY MORE THAN ONEGOOD FULL MEMBER UP TO A LIMIT OF TEN. ¶A5.FUNDAMENTAL THERE SHALL BESTEP ELIGIBLE AS HE ANDDESIROUS OFCO-OPERATING INTHEINSTITUTE’S OBJECTIVES, FOREXAMPLE, MAY INCLU D. ¶PRESS INFACULTIES, ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN(LEADING ORGANISATION TOTHESE WORK TOWAR ALISM LAWYERS AND ADVISORS. ¶ · AS AFFILIATE MEMBERS JOURNALISTS GROUP): PER EANT: OF FREE ACCESS TOMAGAZINES, THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OFAGENCIES, NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAP CTIONS NEWSPAPERS, BROADCASTING OR NEWS EDITORIAL WRITERS, COPY EDIT EOPLES.¶ • THEOR PROMOTION OFPERSONS THE FREE EXCHANGE OFEDITORIAL ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG¶ RAMME EDITORS PRESENTERS, HOLDING SIMILAR POSITIONS ONINTERNET SERVICES. WEEN PEOPLES ANDPEOPLES. IFPEOPLES ARE TOUNDERSTAND ONEAGENCY ANOTHER, ITISLIMITED. ESSENTIAL THATT ANY ONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, RADIO, TV ORGANISATION OR NEWS IS NOT AFFILIATE PLICANTS PROCURE WRITTEN APPROVAL FROM THEIR EDITOR-IN-CHIEF. ¶ 6. ASSOCIATE AND AFFILIATE MEM OTTEES, BRINGAPPLICATIONS ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OFWHICH THE WORLD. ¶SHALL IN ACCORDANCE WIT SHALL BE MADE TO THE NATIONAL COMMITTEE, ALONE HAVE THE POWE HERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO TH RE THERE ARE NO NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS FOR MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE MADE TO THE INSTITUTE EMENT OFTHE UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶AUTHORITY • THE PROMOTION TOENROL APPLICANTS.INALL CASES,ENROLMENTS ARE SUBJECT TOTHEULTIMATE OFTHEEX ES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLE VITIES OF THE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY SHALL HAVE NO VOTING RIGHTS. THE DUES FOR ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP L BE HALF THE DUES FOR ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP. ¶ IPI CONSTITUTION PAGE 3 ¶ 8. INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERSH FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISCENTRES TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTAN ICATIONS DEPARTMENTS OF UNIVERSITIES AND COLLEGES, SCHOOLS AND OF JOURNALISM, PRESS ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDIN NSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS MAY PARTICIPATE IN ALL THE INSTITUTE’S ACTIVITIES. THE DIRECTOR SHALL HAVE CATION NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AP ECUTIVEOF BOARD. THENUMBER OFTHEIR DELEGATES ISNOTLIMITED. DUESFORINSTITUTIONAL MEMBERSSHAL D. INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS SHALLHAVE NO VOTINGRIGHTS.OF ¶9.THE INSOPRACTICES FARASASSOCIATE MEMBERSARECONC NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD RDIT SHALL BE FIXED BY THETHEY DIRECTOR WITH THEINFORMATION. AGREEMENT OFTHEREFORE, THE BOARD. ¶A10. THE EXECUTIVESTEP BOARD SHAL ER, IS ESSENTIAL THAT HAVE GOOD FUNDAMENTAL TOWA TRARY TO THE PRINCIPLES SET OUT IN THE PRESENT CONSTITUTION. SUSPENSION OF A MEMBER MAY BE ORDE D. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITHEXCEPT THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TOPRESENT WORK TOWAR ION SHALL NOT BE ORDERED ON THE APPROVAL OF TWO-THIRDS OF THE MEMBERS OF THE B EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OFDAYS NEWSPAP STATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED CAUSES, SHALL BE GIVEN TO THE MEMBER CONCERNED SIXTY (60) PREVIO NTED TOSUCH MEMBER, IFTHATMEMBER SHALL SODESIRE.ANY MEMBERSOAND ORDERED SUSPENDED ORAMONG EXPELL EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE BALANCED NEWS MBLY INPEOPLES WHICH CASE APEOPLES. MAJORITYIFVOTE OF MEMBERS PRESENT SHALLONE BE RECOGNISED ASISTHE FINAL DECISION WEEN AND PEOPLES ARETOTOUNDERSTAND ANOTHER, IT ESSENTIAL THAT T E; NOTICE OF SUCH ACTION SHALL BE GIVEN EITHER THE NATIONAL COMMITTEE OR TO THE DIRECTOR. ¶13. AN OHEBRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WIT INSTITUTE,UPTOTHETIMETHATMEMBER’SRESIGNATIONOREXPULSIONBECOMESEFFECTIVE.¶14.MEMBE HERANCE AND¶SAFEGUARDING OFCONDITIONS FREEDOM OF THE PRESS,MEMBERSHIP BY WHICH ISHAS MEANT: ACCESS TH REISFUNDAMENTAL CHANGEINTHE UNDER WHICH BEENFREE GRANTED ANDTO WHER CONSTITUTION. ARTICLEIII¶NATIONAL COMMITTEES ¶1A)SUBJECT TO RECOGNITION BYTHE EXECUTIVE BOA EMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION MITTEE MAYBEFORMEDPROVISIONALLY INACOUNTRY WHERETHEREAREAT LEASTFIVE FULLMEMBERS FORM ES OFBYJOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACENOT DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLE TION THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL NECESSARILY IMPLY THAT THE EXECUTIVE BOARD ALSO RECOGNIS FUNDAMENTAL TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONGPURSUE PEOPLES TO BRING UNDERSTAN OM OFTHEPRESS.STEP ¶2.NATIONAL COMMITTEES SHALLACTIVELY THEISAIMS OFTHEABOUT INSTITUTE INTHEIRC FFECTING THE PRESS, PARTICULARLY ONTHREATS TOFREEDOM¶OF THEPRESS ORTOTHEFREE FLOW OFNEWS. ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDIN YEAR TERM LIMIT. ¶ 3. NATIONAL COMMITTEES MAY BE ENTRUSTED WITH ADMINISTRATIVE TASKS SUCH ASTH CATION OFINSTITUTE, NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING A OSES OF THE WITH THE APPROVAL OF THE SECRETARIAT. FUND-RAISING ACTIVITIES SHOULD BE CO NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD IRECTOR. ¶IPICONSTITUTION PAGE 4¶4.THEEXECUTIVE BOARDTHEREFORE, SHALLHAVEPOWER TODECLAREANATIONAL C ER, IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE INFORMATION. A FUNDAMENTAL TOWA THEIT EXECUTIVE BOARD CONSIDERS THEGOOD OBJECTIVES OFPARAGRAPH 2OR3ABOVE HAVENOTBEENSTEP FULFILLED O TION ANATIONALCOMMITTEE HAS BEENGRANTED. ¶DECLARATION OFORGANISATION ANATIONALCOMMITTEE’S INACTIVIT D.RS¶OF INOFTHE ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERENOTICE IS ESTABLISHED AN TO WORKBY TOWAR EXECUTIVE BOARD PRESENT. WRITTEN THAT SUCH ACTION WILL BE CONSIDERED THEEXE EANT: TO FREE ACCESS TOCOMMITTEE THE NEWS,CONCERNED FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF EXECUTIVE NEWSPAP GIVEN THE NATIONAL SIXTY (60) DAYS BEFORE THE MEETING OF THE EOPLES.¶ • THEBOARD, PROMOTION OFWRITING THE FREE OF ACCURATE ANDOFBALANCED NEWS AMONG THE EXECUTIVE EITHERIN OREXCHANGE BYTHEPERSONAL APPEARANCE AMEMBEROR MEMBERS OF WEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES TO UNDERSTAND ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL T HALLCONSIDER SUCH REPRESENTATIONS. ¶ARE ANATIONAL COMMITTEEONE FROM WHICHRECOGNITION HASTHAT BEENO VE BOARD TO BE INACTIVE SHALL HAVE THE RIGHT TO APPEAL TO THE NEXT GENERAL ASSEMBLY, IN WHICH CASE OEBRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONGBOARD THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WIT INSTITUTE, PROVIDED THAT THE EXECUTIVE MAYPRESS, AT ANYBY TIME RESTORE RECOGNITION TO A NATION HERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO TH ONS OF A NATIONAL COMMITTEE OR THE DECISION OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD TO CONSIDER A NATIONAL COM EMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION UTIONAL MEMBERS IN THAT COUNTRY TO CONTINUE AS MEMBERS OF THE INSTITUTE AND TO PARTICIPATE FUL COMMITTEE OR DECLARES A NATIONAL COMMITTEE INACTIVE, THE TASKS FORMERLY EXECUTED BY THIS COMM ES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLE O HOLD THEIR OWN "MEDIA EVENTS" IN THE FORM OF CONFERENCES, SEMINARS, WORKSHOPS, ETC, TO DISCU FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISENCOURAGED TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTAN ED ISSUE WHICH HAS A BEARING ON EDITORIAL ACTIVITY. THEY ARE ALSO TO COLLABORATE W TO WORKAND/OR TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶¶•IPI THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDIN MATION OF EXPRESSION FREEDOM OF THE MEDIA. ¶ ARTICLE IV COMMITTEES OF EXPERTS ¶ 1. IPI COMMIT CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT UNDERSTANDING A 2. THEIR TASK SHALL BE TO: ¶FREE · ADVISE THE EXECUTIVE BOARD ON POLICY ISSUES; ¶ ·OF ASSIST THE DIRECTOR IN MADEUP OFACHAIRPERSON, PLUSTWO DEPUTIES, APPOINTED THE BOARD,REPRESENTING DIFFERENTGEO NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OFBY THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD ANCE WITH THECOMMITTEE’S CHAIRPERSON OR ONEOFHERORTHEREFORE, HISDEPUTIES.AINFUNDAMENTAL GENERAL,COMMITTEE MEMB ER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. STEPIPITOWA S. ¶ 4. A PERMANENT WORKING COMMITTEE SHALL BE ESTABLISHED TO OVERSEE THE ACTIVITIES OF THE PRESS D.TO ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITHFOR THIS BELIEF MEDIA THEREEXECUTIVES IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TOOFWORK TOWAR D ENABLE IPIMEMBERSHIP EDITORS, ANDACADEMICS INTHEFIELD COMMUNICAT Above, pictured from left are William Rees-Mogg, editor of The Times; Harold Evans, editor of The Sunday Times; and Denis Hamilton, editor-in-chief of The Times and The Sunday Times, after being appointed by The Times new owner, Lord Thomson, 1967. Below: Evans delivers the K.C. Mammen Mappilai memorial lecture in New Delhi, India, 2007. Bottom: Evans pictured with American broadcast journalist Barbara Walters. ELIEFTHEREISESTABL antonIo SSTOTHENEWS,FREET fontán PLES. ¶ · THE PROMOTIO NISATION DEFENDS EVE ECLARATIONOFHUMA SE,INFRENCH;INSTITU HE INSTITUTE SHALL BE N 60 ET SEQ. OF THE SW ATIONS, OTHER INSTITU NSTITUTESHALLENURE RENCES, EXCHANGE PR ON THE INTERNET, THE S STITUTE SHALL PROMO ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL O BERSHIP¶1.FULLMEMB VIEWS.¶•THEACHIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHANGEOFACCURATEAND OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOT N.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALISTSOFTHEWORLD ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEA EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOP RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEE DONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRI FTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORGANISATIONTOWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERAN HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF ONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JO GBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMEN TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO W RTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION O VEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHANGEOFACCURATEANDBALANCEDNEWSAM FJOURNALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTH AMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALISTSOFTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEW OWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREEACCESSTOTHE F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION O WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. I NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDIN DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING O ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMO MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PE AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARD UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS NDERSTANDINGAbove AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NA and below: NALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHE AntonioUNDERSTANDING Fontán giving TAL STEP TOWARDS AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH T at WORK TOWARDSa presentation THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE N Madrid, 1967. F NEWSPAPERS,Diario FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION O Right: Speaking to anIMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. I WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE unidentified at NTIAL THAT THEY HAVEman GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDIN the Diario Madrid DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING O conference. ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMO MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PE AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARD UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NA NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHE TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH T WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE N F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION O WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. I NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDIN DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING O ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMO MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PE AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARD UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NA NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHE TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH T WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE N F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION O WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. I NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDIN DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING O ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMO MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PE AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARD UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NA NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHE TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH T WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE N F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION O WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. I NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDIN DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING O ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMO MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PE AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARD UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS Fontán pictured with NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NA Crown PrinceAND Felipe PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THE NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLES Rafael CalvoUNDERSTANDING Serer TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRINGatABOUT AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH T Award Ceremony at WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE N the Diario Madrid F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION O WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. I Foundation, 2007. NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDIN DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING O ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMO MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PE AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARD UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NA NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHE TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH T WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE N SPAIN 1923–2010 t he international importance of Antonio Fontán Pérez is curiously and largely due to the worldwide dissemination of a 1973 photograph. The photograph showed the demolition of a building in Madrid that had housed the headquarters of the newspaper Diario Madrid, of which Fontán was the editor. The picture of the explosive demolition of the building, located in the central Salamanca district in Madrid, was a simple real estate transaction, since the newspaper had been closed by the Franco regime two years earlier after numerous arrests, closures, sanctions and fines against it. But thanks to the skills of the newspaper’s former attorney, the Republican politician Antonio García Trevijano, the photograph of the demolition was picked up by newspapers all over the world, turning it into the metaphor for the destruction of an independent newspaper by a dictatorship. Antonio Fontán Pérez was born in Seville, Spain on 15 October 1923. Educated at the universities of Seville and Madrid, he received his doctorate in classical philology in 1948. A full member of the Opus Dei, Fontán had a very important professional career, not only as a journalist. He was a professor of classical philology and a great connoisseur of Latin, at the universities of Madrid (Complutense), Granada and Navarre. He was one of the professors of thenPrince Juan Carlos de Borbón, today’s King of Spain. As a politician, he founded liberal organisations as well as a liberal party together with the late Joaquín Garrigues Walker. Fontán was the democratic president of the Senate and later Minister of Territorial Administration in 1979 and 1980 under the government of Adolfo Suarez. Fontán’s journalistic career is of no less importance. He graduated in 1954 at the Official School of Journalism; for years he was the editor of the weekly La Actualidad Española, and eventually joined the newspaper Diario Madrid, of which he was the editor between 1967 and 1971 together with a small group of brilliant young journalists. Keeping within the numerous wellknown limitations imposed by the dictatorship during the Franco regime, the newspaper recognised and spread the desire for freedom. It was the first of a short-list of media outlets – including Diario 16, and El Pais – that were essential to Spain’s transition from the Franco dictatorship to democracy. Fontán was also the director of the University of Navarra. Finally, he was the editor in chief of the bimonthly publication, Nueva Revista. Diario Madrid was a newspaper that to survive used the loopholes offered by Franco’s 1966 press law that theoretically suppressed prior censorship. But Fontán, who had recently joined the paper as editor, soon realised the law was not enough to save the newspaper, which was closed for four months in 1968 for an article entitled “Withdrawal Time. No to General de Gaulle”, which covered the events of May 1968 in Paris. The regime believed that in calling for the removal of French President General Charles de Gaulle, the paper was surreptitiously calling for the removal of General Franco. Determined to defend not only the independence and dignity of the media, which was under constant attack by the Franco regime, but also Fontán’s position as editor of the newspaper – his resignation had been demanded by the thenMinister of Information, Sánchez Belle – staff at Diario Madrid formed Spain’s first journalists’ association. Eventually, after facing repeated harassment and judicial proceedings, Diario Madrid was ordered to close after publishing a heavily critical article on General Franco’s right-hand man, Admiral Luis Carrero Blanco. The move was widelycriticised in the Spanish press. In response to the Ministry of Information’s offer to take over the newspaper and run it with its own staff and editorial line, Diario Madrid’s management, Fontán and his staff all refused. “We are ready to sell the presses to pay the staff rather than agree that the paper should lose its independence,” the journalists said. Although democracy was restored in Spain in 1975 following the death of Franco and the reestablishment of the monarchy, and the order to close Diario Madrid was revoked, the paper, which had sold everything to pay its staff, could not be relaunched, due to financial difficulties. As a prominent promoter of press freedom in Spain, Fontán was an early member of the International Press Institute (IPI) in Spain and a member of IPI’s executive board, as well as an honorary life member of IPI in recognition of his staunch defence of the principles of free expression. Antonio Fontán passed away on 14 January 2010, after a long illness. He was 86. Written with contribution (originally in Spanish) from José Luis Gutiérrez, journalist, writer and publisher of LEER magazine. Gutiérrez is also a columnist for the newspaper El Mundo 53 LaurenCe gandar SOUTH AFRICA 1915–1998 t he features that impacted those confronted by Laurence Owen Vine Gander as he presided over the evening news conferences at the Rand Daily Mail were his ascetic profile and piercing hazel eyes, the air of reserve and economy of words as he ticked off items on the news diary. There was an aura of cool remoteness which appeared to defy attempts by his staff to get to know him better and which, on occasion, infuriated the authorities who were trying to intimidate the English-language press in general and the Rand Daily Mail in particular. This was the man who changed the face of South African journalism at a time when the National Party government was getting into stride with its programme of apartheid. As the Nationalists were legislating for separation of the races to the ultimate degree, Gandar, whose editorship of South Africa’s Rand Daily Mail began in 1957, stood out as a firm and loud solitary voice in the establishment opposition, denouncing apartheid, pleading for the political emancipation of blacks and urging economic integration. Gandar led the paper as editor until 1965; from 1966 to 1969, he was editor in chief. Indeed, Gander was on a crusade. He wrote articles under his byline exhorting white South Africans to make the inevitable, ineluctable choice. Whites could not have the best of both worlds, enjoying the fruits of economic integration and ignoring their political obligations. They had to make a choice – on the one hand, political separation which would require enormous economic sacrifices, and on the other, economic integration which would demand extensive political concessions. It was an argument which upset whites, especially those in government – but also members of the board of the owners. SA Associated Newspapers grew increasingly restive when circulation figures dropped and advertising revenues began shrinking. Rand Daily Mail readers as well as advertisers were also upset. 54 Some people complained that Gander was ahead of his time, but clearly he helped condition the mindset of white South Africans to accept that the only just and equitable solution for the country was majority rule. His liberal philosophy of non-discrimination, of freedom, tolerance and justice for all, forcefully infected the thinking of white South Africans at that time, which helped prevent the country from sliding into civil war, a circumstance not acknowledged by the Truth and Reconciliation Commission. Gander introduced to South Africa investigative journalism, or journalism which lifts the lid on issues and matters of public concern rather than merely reporting around them. He concentrated on exposing the government’s attempts at social engineering, which inevitably meant the removal of black people from homes they had occupied for generations to generally bleak and inhospitable areas of the country, the iniquities of the ‘pass laws’ and the abominable treatment of blacks in prison. This last subject resulted in a series of articles in 1965 about prison conditions that reverberated around the world and which resulted in Gandar and the reporter, Benjamin Pogrund, undergoing an eight-month trial after which they were convicted and fined (with Pogrund being given a suspended jail term as well). The authorities removed Gandar’s and Pogrund’s passports and on one occasion, thugs fired shots at the Rand Daily Mail offices. But the impact of the newspaper exposé – one of the most courageous and far reaching of its kind ever published in South Africa at the time – was international surveillance of South Africa’s prison system and the forced revamping of the conditions under which prisoners are held in jail. These events and the board’s growing unease resulted in Gandar’s dismissal as editor of the Rand Daily Mail and his eventual retirement, in some disillusionment, to the south coast of Natal. Laurence Gandar was born in Durban in 1915 and gained a Bachelor of Arts degree at Natal University after which he joined the Sunday Trib- une and later the Natal Daily News and the Pretoria News. During World War II, he served in North Africa and Italy in the Royal Durban Light Infantry, ending up as a Brigade Intelligence Officer in the 6th Armoured Division’s 12th Motor Brigade with the rank of captain. In 1953, he joined Anglo American Corporation’s public relations office from which he was plucked by SAAN General Manager Henri Kuiper to be editor of the Rand Daily Mail. The only directive he was given was that the Mail traditionally supported the United Party, but he insisted on and was given ‘complete editorial independence’ – which he interpreted as giving him the right to support the United Party offshoot, the Progressive Party (now after several mutations, the Democratic Alliance), in 1959. It was this support that helped Helen Suzman’s long tenure as the only liberal voice in parliament and the eventual rise of the party and finally the demise of the United Party. He won many international awards both for the paper and himself, the most prestigious being the American Newspaper Publishers’ World Press Achievement Award after the prison series in 1966. But the image of the remote Gandar in the newsroom was misleading. Behind the aloofness was a warm, friendly and generous spirit with a captivating and lively sense of humour, a most hospitable host and a man who loved the arts, good food, wine and good companionship. He died in Pietermaritzburg in November 1998, a few months after the sudden death of his son Mark. Written by Raymond Louw, editor and publisher of the weekly current affairs newsletter Southern Africa Report and editor of the Rand Daily Mail from 1966 to 1977 UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTA ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWIN CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSIO NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMP R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD D. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF TH EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE T EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE WEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESA BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDO MENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JO S OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTA ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWIN CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSIO NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMP R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD D. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF TH EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE T EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE WEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESA BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDO E’S PERSONAL FREEDOM, THE FREEDOM OF EXPRESSION AND, IN PARTICULA TS,(DEC.10,1948).¶2.THENAMEOFTHEORGANISATIONSHALLBETHEINTE ERNACIONALDELAPRENSA,INSPANISH;INTERNATIONALESPRESSEINSTIT SH, FRENCH, GERMAN AND SPANISH; THE WORKING LANGUAGE SHALL BE E VIL CODE. THE RESOURCES OF THE INSTITUTE ARE DERIVED FROM MEMBERSH AND BUSINESSES, WHICH SUPPORT THE PRINCIPLES OF FREEDOM OF THE P EBENEFITOFANYMEMBERORINDIVIDUAL.¶5.THEGOALSOFTHEINSTITUTE, MMES, TRAINING COURSES, ACADEMIC LECTURES TV AND RADIO BROADCA G OF DELEGATIONS AND MISSIONS TO COUNTRIES AND GOVERNMENTS, AND AIR BALANCE OF WOMEN AND MEN IN ITS STRUCTURES AND IN ITS ACTIVIT ERWISE, FOR THE INSTITUTE, AND THE INSTITUTE ASSUMES NO LIABILITY, LE POFTHEINSTITUTEISOPENTOPERSONSWITHRESPONSIBILITIESFOREDITO STEMSORONTHEINTERNET,WHOSUPPORTTHEPRINCIPLEOFFREEDOMOFT FORMALLYANDBYWRITTENSTATEMENTTHEIRWILLINGNESSTOWORKFOR OWS:INCOUNTRIESWHERETHEREARENATIONALCOMMITTEES,APPLICATI ORNOTTOENROLTHEAPPLICANTS.INCOUNTRIESWHERETHEREARENONA ETHEPOWERTOINITIALLYDETERMINEWHETHERORNOTTOENROLTHEAPP SHALL BE ON AN INDIVIDUAL BASIS. HOWEVER, IF A NATIONAL COMMITTEE S STING SYSTEM OR AN INTERNET SERVICE. ¶ 4. A NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NE MEMBER UP TO A LIMIT OF TEN. ¶ 5. THERE SHALL BE ELIGIBLE AS ASSOCIATE THEINSTITUTE’SOBJECTIVES,FOREXAMPLE,THESEMAYINCLUDE:¶·ASAS ·ASAFFILIATEMEMBERS(LEADINGJOURNALISTSGROUP):PERSONSOPERA CASTING OR NEWS AGENCIES, EDITORIAL WRITERS, COPY EDITORS, BUREA LDINGSIMILAREDITORIALPOSITIONSONINTERNETSERVICES.¶THENUMBE ORGANISATION OR NEWS AGENCY IS NOT LIMITED. AFFILIATE MEMBERSHI M THEIR EDITOR-IN-CHIEF. ¶ 6. ASSOCIATE AND AFFILIATE MEMBERSHIP CA NATIONAL COMMITTEE, WHICH ALONE SHALL HAVE THE POWER TO INITIAL PLICATIONSFORMEMBERSHIPSHALLBEMADETOTHEINSTITUTE’SDIRECTOR ROLMENTSARESUBJECTTOTHEULTIMATEAUTHORITYOFTHEEXECUTIVEBO VE NO VOTING RIGHTS. THE DUES FOR ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE HA HIP.¶IPICONSTITUTIONPAGE3¶8.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSHIPSHALLBE ND COLLEGES, SCHOOLS AND CENTRES OF JOURNALISM, PRESS INSTITUTES NALLTHEINSTITUTE’SACTIVITIES.THEDIRECTORSHALLHAVEPOWERTOEN ATESISNOTLIMITED.DUESFORINSTITUTIONALMEMBERSSHALLBEFIXEDB OTINGRIGHTS.¶9.INSOFARASASSOCIATEMEMBERSARECONCERNED,DUE E AGREEMENT OF THE BOARD. ¶ 10. THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL HAVE POW SENTCONSTITUTION.SUSPENSIONOFAMEMBERMAYBEORDEREDBYAMA APPROVAL OF TWO-THIRDS OF THE MEMBERS PRESENT OF THE BOARD. ¶ 11. BE GIVEN TO THE MEMBER CONCERNED SIXTY (60) DAYS PREVIOUS TO THE M LSODESIRE.ANYMEMBERSOORDEREDSUSPENDEDOREXPELLEDBYTHEEX MBERS PRESENT SHALL BE RECOGNISED AS THE FINAL DECISION OF THE INST HERTOTHENATIONALCOMMITTEEORTOTHEDIRECTOR.¶13.ANYMEMBERR RESIGNATIONOREXPULSIONBECOMESEFFECTIVE.¶14.MEMBERSHIPSHOU NSUNDERWHICHMEMBERSHIPHASBEENGRANTEDANDWHERETHESECHA MITTEES¶1A)SUBJECTTORECOGNITIONBYTHEEXECUTIVEBOARDANDCON OUNTRYWHERETHEREAREATLEASTFIVEFULLMEMBERSFORMALLYCOMM CESSARILY IMPLY THAT THE EXECUTIVE BOARD ALSO RECOGNISES THAT TH SHALLACTIVELYPURSUETHEAIMSOFTHEINSTITUTEINTHEIRCOUNTRIES,R ATSTOFREEDOMOFTHEPRESSORTOTHEFREEFLOWOFNEWS.ATTHEREQU MAYBEENTRUSTEDWITHADMINISTRATIVETASKSSUCHASTHECOLLECTIN Laurence Gandar presents a cheque to Derek Scorer, accompanied by Peter Whitwork at the South Africa Ocean Racing Trust. VIEWS.¶•THEACHIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALIST OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDE N.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMON ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF DONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T FTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHED HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS ONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE GBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEA TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE W RTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH VEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPE FJOURNALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEEN AMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRING OWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEA F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UN WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURN NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENT DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WO ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF N MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSEN UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCOR SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE A NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • TH NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPL TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOU WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AN F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UN WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURN NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENT DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WO ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF N MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSEN UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCOR SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE A NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • TH NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPL TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOU ELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDAN SSTOTHENEWS,FREETRANSMIS aKBar PLES. ¶ · THE PROMOTION OF THE ganJI NISATION DEFENDS EVERYONE’S ECLARATIONOFHUMANRIGHTS SE,INFRENCH;INSTITUTOINTERN HE INSTITUTE SHALL BE ENGLISH N 60 ET SEQ. OF THE SWISS CIVIL ATIONS, OTHER INSTITUTIONS AN NSTITUTESHALLENURETOTHEB RENCES, EXCHANGE PROGRAMM ON THE INTERNET, THE SENDING O STITUTE SHALL PROMOTE A FAIR ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL OR OTHER BERSHIP¶1.FULLMEMBERSHIPO NDRADIOBROADCASTINGSYST KINGMEMBERSHIP,DECLAREFO IPCANBEACQUIREDASFOLLOW IALLYDETERMINEWHETHEROR CTOR,WHOALONESHALLHAVET VE BOARD. ¶ 3. MEMBERSHIP SHA Above, right and left: Supporters rally for Akbar Ganji. Below: temporarily let out of jail for medical treatment, Ganji flashes a victory sign next to his wife Masumeh Shafiei after a press conference at his home in Tehran, 2005. IRAN 1960– m y political and social activities have always been inspired by the goal of equal rights to security, freedom, peace and a dignified life for all human beings.” – Akbar Ganji, 2010 Akbar Ganji has been called Iran’s most prominent political dissident. The son of a poor and very religious family in southern Tehran, he became involved with the Iranian revolution at an early age, even joining the Revolutionary Guard, a branch of Iran’s military constituted after the revolution of 1978. Ganji has written that he was drawn into the revolution on ideological grounds, believing that it was geared towards “overthrowing a despotic regime to create better conditions.” However, he quickly grew disillusioned as it became evident that these better conditions never came about. One despotic kingdom replaced another despotic kingdom. “What he discover[ed] is that the Shah’s regime was in a sense only repressive of one dimension, which was politics, but the Islamic Republic of Iran was repressive of almost every dimension,” Fareed Zakaria, editor of Newsweek International, said of Ganji in awarding him the Milton Friedman Award for the Cato Institute in the United States. Ganji increasingly came to believe that revolutions could not lead to democracies and that a secular democracy was the only way to secure Iranian’s freedoms. In 2006, he said that revolutions can only create cycles of fear, a phenomenon that has been repeated since the French Revolution, which according to Ganji established the pattern for all other revolutions. Only greater freedom, civil disobedience and liberty for all could lead to the end of despotism. “We started a revolution to create heaven, but we created a hell,” he said in 2006. In the mid 1990s armed with these convictions, Ganji broke from the ideology of the republic he had so fervently supported and turned to journalism. In 1998, a year after the then-obscure cleric and reformist Mohammad Khatami had been elected president in the 1997 elections, Ganji spoke out against the dangers of a fascist interpretation of religion. He was arrested and sentenced to a year in prison, but was released after three months. He has also written about his opposition to velayat-e-faqih (the clause in the Iranian constitution that calls for an Islamic jurist to serve as the Supreme Leader of the government). His most significant brush with the regime, however, came in 2000. In the fall of 1998, the systematic and serial murders of dissidents who were critical of the government came to light. For many years since the 1980s, the government had been eliminating criti- cal voices. In 1994, for example, 134 writers published an open letter entitled “We Are the Writers!” demanding that censorship be abolished and calling for the establishment of an autonomous writers association. The hardliners reacted by publishing an article entitled “We Are the Dead!” in their mouthpiece, the daily Kayhan. According to an article by Muhammad Sahimi for PBS, many of those who had signed the letter all died under mysterious circumstances. In 1998 alone, between late summer and autumn, according to PBS, six dissidents and intellectuals were murdered in what came to be known as the ‘Chain Murders’ (ghatl-haye zanjireh-i). Ganji, along with investigative journalist Emadeddin Baghi wrote a series of exposés in the daily Sobh Emrouz (This Morning) in 1999 on the chain murders, accusing several high-level political figures and clerics of having been involved in the assassinations and accusing then-president Akbar Hashemi Rafsanjani’s government of fostering “moral and financial corruption.” The exposés were collected into a book called “The Dungeon of Ghosts,” which quickly became a bestseller, and is credited with helping to defeat many conservative candidates in the 2000 elections. Retribution was swift. In March 2000, the editor of Sobh Emrouz, Saeed Hajjarian, was shot in the face by an unidentified gunman. He was not killed, but was left paralyzed for life. In December 2000, two months after the elections, Ganji was arrested and accused of endangering national security and spreading propaganda. He was eventually sentenced to six years in prison, much of which he spent in solitary confinement in Tehran’s notorious Evin prison. Notwithstanding the conditions in prison, and the repeated and continuous physical abuse, Ganji continued to write. His “Republican Manifesto” outlined the steps by which Iran could achieve a secular democracy and emphasized respect for human rights, an independent press and an independent judiciary. Ganji was released in 2006, and left Iran immediately. He has spent the years continuing to campaign for freedom and liberty for Iran and for all nations. He was ardently opposed to the U.S. invasions of Iraq and Afghanistan, stating that “you cannot bring democracy to a country by attacking it.” In the words of Newsweek editor Fareed Zakaria, “What you are searching for is the inner substance of democracy and liberty and I think all of us around the world who believe in liberty, who believe in human rights and who believe in freedom, owe you an enormous debt of gratitude. When you bear witness for the liberty of Iranians, you are bearing witness for the liberty of all of us.” 57 gao yu CHINA 1944– 58 l anguishing away in a Chinese prison in the mid 1990s, suffering from a myriad of medical problems including kidney ailments and Meniere’s disease – which causes hearing loss and heart problems – dissident journalist Gao Yu was offered a way out. All she had to do was sign a written confession admitting to leaking state secrets. The crime in question was related to a series of articles she’d written in the Mirror Monthly and Overseas Chinese Daily which detailed economic and structural changes proposed by the Chinese Communist Party, changes that had already been reported in the Hong Kong press. And yet Gao’s reports, written under a pseudonym, drew the wrath of the government. She was jailed both to silence her and deter other journalists from reporting on issues that the government wanted to keep quiet. Though in desperate need of medical attention, Gao refused to sign a confession that would render her pursuit of truth a crime. “This sentence can devastate my health but not my spirits,” Gao said at the time. “I am willing to sacrifice all that I have for my country’s modernisation and journalism.” And sacrifice she did. Gao spent more than five years in prison before she was released by the government in a political ploy to gain favour with the international community. Her release came just two weeks before U.S. Secretary of State Madeleine Albright was scheduled to visit China. Gao served out the remainder of her sentence under house arrest and was forbidden to speak to journalists. Upon the completion of her house arrest, she returned to journalism, freelancing for several publications, and becoming one of China’s most renowned and outspoken opponents of the government’s human rights abuses and free speech repression. In a 2008 presentation on China’s media practices at a Paris conference on press freedom, Gao spoke of the challenges she and other independent journalists face. “Journalists who tell the truth are punished, and the rewriting of articles by the official media has become a Chinese specialty,” she said. Born on 23 February 1944 in Chongqing, Gao attended the Renmin University of China, where she initially planned to major in news media but instead enrolled in the Chinese Language and Literature department because the news media programme had been suspended due to the Great Chinese Famine. She graduated with a degree in literature theory and went to work in a variety of reporting and editing jobs, establishing herself with her investigative reporting on eco- nomic issues and the reform movement. She worked as a reporter for the China News Service from 1979 until she left to take a job as deputy chief editor of the weekly Economics magazine in 1988. The magazine, run by some of the country’s most prominent dissident intellectuals, was shut down by the government after the 1989 Tiananmen Square demonstrations. Gao was arrested in the government crackdown, abducted by the Beijing Security Bureau on her way to work on 3 June 1989. Declared an “enemy of the people” for pro-democracy writings the government felt helped fuel the uprising, she was jailed without formal charges for 15 months until she was released for health reasons. After Economics was shut down, Gao worked as a correspondent for the Hong Kong newspaper Mirror. She worked there until she was arrested again in 1993. On 2 October 1993, Gao was arrested for leaking state secrets, days before she was scheduled to travel to New York for a one-year fellowship at Columbia University. Following a sham trial, on 10 November 1994 she was sentenced to six years in prison. During her stint in jail, Gao received a number of awards in absentia, including the 1995 International Women’s Media Foundation Courage in Journalism Award and the first UNESCO/Guillermo Cano World Press Freedom Prize in 1997. Gao received the Courage in Journalism Award again in 2006 in a ceremony she was able to attend. In her acceptance speech, she spoke of being a “hostage card” in the Chinese government’s political tug-of-war with the West. She also spoke of the efforts of authorities to rob the Chinese press of its independent spirit. “Chinese authorities require that the past be forgotten and the present be whitewashed. Reporters who dare to tell the truth are fired – or worse,” she said. Gao went on to recall a quote from Shi Liangcai, a Chinese newspaper reporter and pioneer of the independent media who was murdered by secret agents from the Kuomingtang government in 1934. “You have a gun. I have a pen,” Gao recalled Shi saying to authorities. Gao then added, “History has given me the choice of a pen.” REEDOM, THE FREEDOM OF EXP 8).¶2.THENAMEOFTHEORGA LAPRENSA,INSPANISH;INTER RMAN AND SPANISH; THE WOR SOURCES OF THE INSTITUTE AR ES, WHICH SUPPORT THE PRINC YMEMBERORINDIVIDUAL.¶5.T G COURSES, ACADEMIC LECTUR NS AND MISSIONS TO COUNTR F WOMEN AND MEN IN ITS STRU E INSTITUTE, AND THE INSTITUT TEISOPENTOPERSONSWITHR EINTERNET,WHOSUPPORTTHE BYWRITTENSTATEMENTTHEIR IESWHERETHEREARENATION LTHEAPPLICANTS.INCOUNTR INITIALLYDETERMINEWHETH INDIVIDUAL BASIS. HOWEVER, R AN INTERNET SERVICE. ¶ 4. A LIMIT OF TEN. ¶ 5. THERE SHAL SOBJECTIVES,FOREXAMPLE,T UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIST ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG D. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVE EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEW EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN WEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABL ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O MENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AC S OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTA UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIST ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG D. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVE EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEW EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN WEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABL ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O MENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AC S OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTA UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIST ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG D. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVE EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEW EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN WEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABL ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O MENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AC S OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTA UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIST ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG Above: A supporter is D. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVE overtaken by emotion EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSIONwhileOF NEWS, rallying for Gao Yu’sFREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEW freedom. Below left: Gao AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OFpictured ACCURATE with her husband WEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION Zhao Yuankang. Below BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABL right: Gao pictured with ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O her son Zhao Meng in MENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AC Beijing, 1990. S OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTA UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIST ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG D. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVE EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEW EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN WEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABL ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O MENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AC S OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTA UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIST ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG D. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVE EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEW EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN WEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABL ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O WARDS THE BLICATION F ACCURAT IF PEOPLES G ABOUT U S:¶•THEFU PRESSION O rDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTAND HE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING REE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING A NS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD P HAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARD BELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORGANISATIONTOWORKTOWARDSTHE REE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE E REE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ SARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGO THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF T OM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE T RNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCH NUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOU AMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOUR TIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPR . ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AN OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER . THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLIS S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERST NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNAL ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRES . ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AN OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER . THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLIS S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERST NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNAL ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRES . ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AN Below: Former President Richard M. Nixon talks with Katharine Graham, shown above and far right, at a newspaper industry meeting in San Francisco, 1986. Opposite page: Graham with Truman Capote. KatharIne graham UNITED STATES OF AMERICA 1917–2001 a s publisher of The Washington Post in the early 1970s, Katherine Graham made two courageous decisions in the name of press freedom that forever altered the course of U.S. history and her own. In 1971, with a federal injunction against competitor The New York Times and a similar prohibition from the U.S. Justice Department looming, Graham gave the green light for the paper to publish excerpts of the secret Pentagon Papers. The documents detailed government deceptions surrounding U.S. policy during the Vietnam War. She gave the go-ahead at the urging of the paper’s executive editor and over the advice of her lawyers, a decision that was later validated by a U.S. Supreme ruling in the Post’s favor, one that was widely considered a major victory for press freedom. The following year, Graham entrusted the paper’s reputation to a pair of rookie reporters, Bob Woodward and Carl Bernstein, with a tip that President Richard Nixon was behind a break-in at the Democratic National Committee offices in the Watergate complex, a group of office and residential buildings near downtown Washington, D.C. Graham backed the reporters and faced down threats from the Nixon administration – then-U.S. Attorney General John Mitchell infamously threatened, “Katie Graham’s gonna get her tit caught in a big fat wringer” – as the paper pursued an investigation of illegal activities of the White House. The effort led to the criminal convictions of several members of Nixon’s administration and the first ever resignation of an American president. Not bad for a self-described “doormat wife” who reluctantly took over the reins of the Post at the death of her husband and turned the paper into a giant of American journalism. Born 16 June 1917, Graham attended Vassar for two years before transferring and graduating from the University of Chicago in 1938. After graduation, she worked for a short time as a reporter for the San Francisco News before joining the staff of The Washington Post, a paper her father, Eugene Meyer, bought at a bankruptcy auction years earlier. Graham’s husband, Philip, took over the Post from her father in 1945, at which time she ended her journalism career to raise her four children and entertain in their Georgetown home. In 1963, Philip, who had long suffered from mental illness, committed suicide, leaving the paper to Graham. “I had very little idea of what I was supposed to be doing, so I set out to learn,” Graham wrote in her 1997 Pulitzer Prize-winning autobiography, “Personal History.” “What I essentially did was to put one foot in front of the other, shut my eyes, and step off the edge.” Graham stepped off the edge and into the fray. In “Personal History,” she wrote of the intense pressure she faced from the Nixon White House for the paper to back off from the Watergate story. Members of the administration, working to prop up Nixon’s re-election bid, launched a campaign to destroy the Post and Graham’s reputation, branding the paper as uncredible and Graham as being on a personal vendetta. The paper’s reporters were frozen out and the government launched challenges to the broadcast licenses of television stations owned by The Post Company. “The investigation of such a tangled web of crime, money, and mischief was made much harder given the unveiled threats and harassment by a president and his administration,” she wrote. “Bearing the full brunt of presidential wrath is always disturbing. Sometimes I won- dered if we could survive four more years of this kind of strain.” She would not have to find out. Two years after the Post broke the Watergate story, Nixon resigned. With that, the Post had successfully weathered the biggest threat to its editorial independence in its history. “Immediately after watching Nixon’s departure speech, I returned to Martha’s Vineyard, where I had interrupted my August vacation,” Graham wrote. “I turned on the television and heard a voice referring to ‘President Ford.’ Then and only then did I experience pure relief. I actually felt a weight leave my shoulders. It was over.” The Watergate fight may have been over, but Graham’s impact on journalism had just begun. She presided over the company as it expanded to include Newsweek magazine, more television stations and cable TV systems. In 1979, she passed the publisher job on to her son, Donald, but remained active in journalism, serving as chair of the executive committee of The Post Company and co-chair of the International Herald Tribune, among other pursuits. She won several honours, including the 1973 Zenger Award for Freedom of the Press and the People’s Right to Know and the 1992 Burton Benjamin Memorial Award from the Committee to Project Journalists. During a 2001 trip to Sun Valley, Idaho, Graham hit her head in a fall. After being in a coma for days, she died on 17 July 2001. She was 84. Graham’s funeral at the Washington National Cathedral was attended by a who’s who of Washington. She is buried in the historic Oak Hill Cemetery across from her former Georgetown home, where she famously hosted the city’s elite. In 2002, Graham was posthumously presented the Presidential Medal of Freedom by President George W. Bush. 61 VeronICa guerIn IRELAND 1958–1996 62 v eronica Guerin’s two-year career as an investigative journalist for Ireland’s Sunday Independent was short – and far from sweet. She was executed by members of Dublin’s underworld on 26 June 1996, becoming the 24th journalist to die that year. Readers appreciated the brazenness found in Guerin’s undiluted exposés of the burgeoning drug world of Dublin, which had thousands of addicts living in the city. Following 12 unsolved gangland murders, Guerin was frustrated by the police’s inability to bring the crime bosses to justice. She famously stated: “The dogs in the street know who the drug barons are.” She felt it her duty to parade the criminals for all to see, using street names and pseudonyms to bypass what she called “ridiculous, restrictive libel laws.” Born into a Dublin family of five children on 5 July 1958, Guerin went to a Catholic school, where she excelled at sports. With a degree in accountancy from Trinity College and a successful public relations career, nothing in her history suggested ‘Ronnie’ would become a maverick crusader. In an interview Guerin admitted that, had she known at the beginning she would be shot, threatened and her family intimidated, she would never have started. But once in, for Guerin, there was no way out. Aileen O’Toole, editor at the Sunday Business Post, for whom Guerin had first worked as a business journalist, recalled: “She had no basic training [as a reporter]. She just had a simple philosophy that she wanted to get the truth.” She was both tenacious and bold, preferring not to use police sources, but to go after a story, persuading the gangland bosses to talk to her directly. Just a month after Guerin’s first report – about a drug kingpin – was published in October 1994, bullets shattered her cottage window as she played with her young son, Cathal. The first warning to stay away. Opening her front door on 30 January 1995, the day after she exposed the mastermind of a $4.4 million heist, she was met by a revolver pointing to her head before being shot in the thigh. Defiantly committed to continuing her campaign, she left hospital, proclaiming: “No hand can deter me from my battle for the truth,” and visiting local crime bosses, on her crutches, to show she was not intimidated. On 13 September 1995, she was attacked again, this time by convicted criminal John Gilligan, who viciously beat Guerin when she visited his home and questioned his lavish lifestyle when he had no apparent source of income. According to Guerin, Gilligan called her the next day, threatening: “If you write a word about me, I REEDOM, 8).¶2.TH LAPRENS RMAN AN SOURCES ES, WHIC will find your boy and kidnap him and rape him. I am going to kill you if you write a word about me.” Concerned for her family’s safety, the Irish police provided her with 24-hour protection, which Guerin soon dismissed, claiming it hampered her work. As a direct consequence of her work, Guerin was murdered on 26 June 1996, when the pillion rider on a motorcycle shot her at close range as she made a phone call at a traffic light in her car on the Naas Road just outside Dublin. Only 37 when she died, Guerin was assassinated two days before she was due to address a conference in London on “Dying to Tell a Story: Journalists at Risk.” Some have accused her employer, the Sunday Independent, of not telling her to tone down her reports, and of even putting pressure on her to produce the next dramatic revelation, but even Guerin admitted that she could not be stopped in her crusade for a decent society. Others have questioned her foolhardiness. Even after she was attacked, shot, and her young son threatened, she continued to go head-to-head with Dublin’s drug barons. But predominantly, Veronica Guerin is considered an icon of press freedom, a martyr, whose sacrifice spurred massive changes in Irish media and government legislation. In the weeks following her death, Irish parliament established the Criminal Assets Bureau using tax laws to deter and punish criminals, and started one of the biggest investigations into organised crime in Ireland’s history. Ireland’s introduction of its first ever witness protection programme facilitated the life-time imprisonment of four very dangerous men. While Gilligan, who had so violently threatened her just a year earlier, was acquitted of murder, he was sentenced to an unprecedented 25 years for cannabis trafficking. Gilligan fingers on-therun John Traynor, who was Guerin’s confidential source, as the architect of her murder. In 2003, Cate Blanchett immortalised Veronica’s fight in the movie Veronica Guerin. The film portrayed Guerin’s life and death, including the moment that touched the Irish soul: her husband, Graham Turley, lifting seven-year-old Cathal up to kiss his mother’s casket in a final farewell. Earlier Graham had used Lego pieces to re-enact his wife’s death for his son, who asked: “Is mom coming back?” Told no, he said: “I get it. she’s with God now, and she’ll be looking down on everything I do.” ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESS NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IM R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOO D. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF TH EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE WEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESA BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMON ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREED MENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST J S OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPE UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERST ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESS NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IM R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOO D. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF TH EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE WEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESA BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMON ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREED Above: Veronica Guerin gathers with recipients of the 1995 International Press Freedom Awards, from left, José Rubén Zamora, Fred M’membe and Yevgeny Kiselyov.Opposite page: Guerin pictured with her son Cathal. NEWS, FREE OF N VIEWS.¶•THEACHIEVEMENT OFPUBLICATION UNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTS A OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTA CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BA N. THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTAL STEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDING AMONG PE ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • T shIro EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREEFREEDOM EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶OF • TH NAL FREEDOM, THE RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE hara DONE ANOTHER,ITIS¶ ESSENTIAL THATTHEY HAVEGOODOF INFORMATION. THER 0, 1948). 2. THE NAME THE O FTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANO HICH ISDE MEANT:LA FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FRE AL PRENSA, IN SPANISH; I ONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AN GH, BETWEEN PEOPLESANDPEOPLES. IFPEOPLES ARETOUNDERSTANDONE ANOT GERMAN AND SPANISH; THE TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORL RTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS ME HE RESOURCES OF THE INSTITUT VEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPL FJOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACEDEPENDS ONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEEN PEO NESSES, WHICH SUPPORT THE P AMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABO OWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEAND OF ANY MEMBER OR F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ •INDIVIDUAL THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDE WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALIS NTIAL THAT THEYCOURSES, HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL S AINING ACADEMIC LE DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK T ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWS GATIONS AND MISSIONS TO COU MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMO AND PEOPLES. IFWOMEN PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER,IN IT IS ESSENTIAL CE OF AND MEN ITS UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDAN SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS,AND BY WHICH ISTHE MEANT: FREE ACC OR THE INSTITUTE, INST NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE P NALISM.¶WORLDPEACE DEPENDS ONUNDERSTANDING BETWEENPEOPLES A STITUTE IS OPEN TO PERSONS W TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT U WORKTHE TOWARDSINTERNET, THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SA ON WHO SUPPOR F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDE WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALIS AND BY WRITTEN NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION.STATEMENT THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTALT S DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK T ESS TO THE NEWS, FREEWHERE TRANSMISSION OFTHERE NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OFNA NEWS UNTRIES ARE MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMO AND PEOPLES. IFTHE PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT ISCOU ESSENTIAL ENROL APPLICANTS. IN UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDAN SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACC ER TO INITIALLY DETERMINE WH NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE P NALISM.¶WORLD PEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLESA N AN INDIVIDUAL BASIS. HOWE TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT U WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THESERVICE. FURTHERANCE AND SA TEM OR AN INTERNET F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDE JAPAN 1908-1989 Shiro Hara, pictured, was widely regarded as a skilled and thoughtful journalist who fought for social justice. a s city editor of Yomiuri Shimbun, Shiro Hara was a crimefighter, a Japanese Clark Kent without a cape, who crusaded against the gangs controlling Tokyo’s underworld and forced police officials to take notice to address the problem. Through the pages of the national daily, Hara tackled government corruption while keeping readers informed about the rapid, post-war changes in the country. He also assembled a formidable team of young journalists that he trained to produce must-read journalism, transforming Yomiuri into the country’s premier paper. Born in Gifu Prefecture on 15 February 1908, Hara graduated from Hosei University. He joined Yomiuri Shimbun in 1936 and quickly made his mark as a skilled and thoughtful journalist focused on righting social injustices. In 1937, Hara worked as the paper’s foreign correspondent in China, where some of the articles he wrote angered Japan’s Department of Army because they were critical of the occupation. He also led the paper’s coverage of the Japanese Peace Treaty that was brokered in San Francisco. Returning to Japan, Hara was named city editor and set his sights on Tokyo’s underworld. In the post-war chaos and ensuing economic transition, gangs flourished in Tokyo, working handin-hand with corrupt police officials. It was a situation Hara saw as a serious threat to the city’s stability and he launched a campaign to end the cosy relationship. In 1952, Hara wrote a series of articles condemning the taking over of Shinjuku, Tokyo’s amusement district, by foreign criminals. He wrote about the increasing influence of American gangsters and international gambling groups in the city and how they were trying to turn Tokyo into a gambling Mecca on par with Monaco and old Shanghai. He told of how rightwing government officials were complicit in the activities – very risky reporting at the time. Despite threats and harassment from government officials and criminals, Hara worked to expose links between local police and gang bosses. Through Yomiuri, he criticised the government and police for their inability to stop the activity in the city’s underworld and was successful in getting the police superintendent general to admit responsibility and take steps to clean up the area. Hara also used Yomiuri to warn of the dangers of nuclear testing. In 1954, Hara wrote a series of influential articles encouraging the peaceful use of nuclear power, buoyed by an international scoop on a story about a fishing vessel that was exposed to radioactivity during the United States’ testing of atomic weapons on Bikini Atoll. He drew a wider readership to the stories by running them on the heavily-read city pages. Of his many talents, Hara was heralded as a great moulder of young journalists. He had a knack for assessing a reporter’s strengths and playing to them, giving them assignments in which they could excel. The result was reporting that was both enlightening and engaging. Readers flocked to the paper’s city pages and Yomiuri quickly grew into the world’s largest circulated newspapers. Hara’s uncanny news judgement and voracious appetite for scoops earned the respect and concern of rivals fearful of being beaten by the paper. In addition to his work training future journalists, Hara was a founding member of the Japan National Press Club in 1969. It remains the only national press club in Japan. Hara also served as the club’s first chairman. Hara died on his birthday, 15 February 1989. He was 81. 65 amIra hass ISRAEL 1956– 66 a mira Hass chose to ‘Go to Gaza,’ which for many Israelis is tantamount to ‘Go to Hell!’ Since 1991, however, she has been the only Jewish-Israeli journalist living in the Palestinian Territories. Romanced by the humour, warmth and dignity she experienced in the Gaza Strip when she first visited, she stayed. She continues to live and breathe the Palestinians’ plight, sharing it with her Ha’aretz column readers, committed to harmonising Palestinian and Israeli relations. For such a sensational part of the world, where bloodshed and horrors are so frequently reported, Hass’s focus is the faithful representation of daily life and hardships. With an innate dread of being a bystander, the prominent left-wing journalist recalls a story told by her European-Jewish mother detailing the horrendous march from a cattle train to Bergen-Belsen concentration camp: “She and the other women had been 10 days in the train from Yugoslavia. They were sick and some were dying. Then my mother saw these German women looking at the prisoners, just looking.” Mortified that anyone should ‘just look’ and not want to help both confused and motivated the young Israeli. By her justification, the Jews know what it is to be fenced in, behind barbed-wire, and should never inflict such humiliation on any other people. Deeply upsetting for her are the borders and fences which so clearly separate the Palestinian Territories and Israel: “Villagers need to have a special identity card, additional to what they [already] have, which is the Israeli authorisation for them to live where they live – this is a very new issue – because they live in this area which was declared a closed area, but only to Palestinians.” Despite warnings to the media to stay away, Hass felt duty-bound to expose the continued injustice and severity of the Israeli occupier and share the dignity and resilience of the Palestinian occupied. Her open criticism of both Israel and Palestine often sees her under fire from both communities, leaving her in something of a no-man’s land. There are some Israelis who support and encourage her crusade, along with Palestinians who consider her the conscience of Israel, but over the years she has been branded a Nazi and a traitor in tirades of abuse from Israelis who she feels are unaware of the degradation of the Palestinians as a result of Israeli occupation. Her focus is to work for a better world, where equality is paramount. Since she joined the Ha’aretz news desk in 1989, having dropped out of her history degree at the Hebrew University of Jerusalem, Hass has tried to help her readers understand and respect the differences, and similarities, between two of the most fractious communities on earth. “I believe that what I’ve been describing is the truth. I don’t believe that it makes much change and much influence. It does not preach to the nonconverted. It does not reach the non-converted. It reaches the converted. But, still, I believe this is true, what I’ve been writing.” She was researching the history of the Nazis and the attitude of the European Left to the Holocaust for her master’s degree when the first intifada broke out. She was compelled to leave academia and to try to make a difference. “I volunteered in a group called Workers Hotline. We assisted Palestinian workers, mainly, whose rights were violated by Israeli employers. They were not represented properly by Israeli trade unions. So we started this advocacy group, and also offered active assistance in the sense of approaching the employers either through lawyers or directly in order to get for these people what they deserved.” Her humanist, caring words speak volumes in reports which laud the importance of family; explore the emotional, tenacious ties to homes the Palestinians are unlikely to see again; discuss the spiritual impact of displacement; consider the degrading descent into poverty; and marvel at the daily resilience of a people whose occupiers enforce a policy of ‘closure’ that besieges Palestinian towns and throttles their economy. Her actions speak as loudly as her words. In December 2008, she was arrested for being in Gaza without a permit when she returned to Israel on a protest vessel, after demonstrating her opposition of the Israeli blockade. And on 12 May 2009, she was arrested after living in the Gaza Strip for several months ‘for violating a law which forbids residence in an enemy state.’ Born in Jerusalem on 28 July 1956, Hass does not, however, believe she makes a difference: “I’ve been writing extensively in my paper, and then my books. People read me. But, somehow, it did not sink in. Most of the people, I would say, did not get the message, because it’s not for one writer to change things; you need a movement.” But there is a flurry of awards and accolades that confirm that she is in fact an extraordinary woman, determined to tell the truth and blow misconceptions out of the water. ATION TOWARDS THEOF FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B 8).¶TOOF 2.WORK THE NAME THEORGANISATION SHALL BE THEINTERNATIONAL PRE CATION NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO LAPRENSA, INSPANISH; INTERNATIONALES PRESSEINSTITUT, INGERMAN; NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG RMAN AND SPANISH; THE WORKING LANGUAGE SHALL BE ENGLISH. ¶ 4. TH D.SOURCES ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVE OFTOTHE INSTITUTE AREOF DERIVED FROM MEMBERSHIP CONTR EANT: FREE ACCESS THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREEDUES, EXPRESSION OF VIEW EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN ES, WHICH SUPPORT THE PRINCIPLES OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS AND FREE WEEN PEOPLESANDOR PEOPLES. IFPEOPLESARETO¶ UNDERSTAND ONEANOTHER, ITISESSENTIAL THATTHEYAS HAVEDESCRIBED GOODINFORMATION YBRING MEMBER INDIVIDUAL. 5.THEGOALS OFTHE INSTITUTE, ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLII ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O GMENT COURSES, ACADEMIC LECTURES TV AND RADIO BROADCAST MATERIAL W OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AC AND MISSIONS TODEPENDS COUNTRIES AND GOVERNMENTS, AND COLLABORATIO SNS OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTA UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISAND TO BRINGIN ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIST FATION WOMEN AND MEN IN ITS STRUCTURES ITS ACTIVITIES. ¶ IPI CONST TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B E INSTITUTE, AND THE INSTITUTE ASSUMES LIABILITY,AMONGST LEGALJOURNALISTS OR OTHERW CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENTNO OF UNDERSTANDING AND SO NCEDIS NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST UTE OPEN TO PERSONS WITH RESPONSIBILITIES FOR EDITORIAL OR NEWS P R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG WHO PRINCIPLE OFFREEDOM OFTHE PRESSAND D D.E¶INTERNET, IN ACCORDANCE WITH THISSUPPORT BELIEF THERE ISTHE ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVE EANT:WRITTEN FREE ACCESS TOSTATEMENT THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE OF VIEW BY THEIROFWILLINGNESS TONEWS WORK FOR THEEXPRESSION ACHIEVEM EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE ACCURATE AND BALANCED AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN RIES WHERE THERE AREARE NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BEM WEENPEOPLES ANDPEOPLES. IFPEOPLES TOUNDERSTAND ONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIAL THATTHEYHAVEGOOD INFORMATION BRING UNDERSTANDINGIN AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLI LERANCE THEABOUT APPLICANTS. COUNTRIES WHERE THERE ARE NO NATIONAL COMMIT AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O INITIALLY DETERMINE NOTPEOPLES.¶ TOENROL THEAPPLICANTS. INALL MENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGSTWHETHER JOURNALISTS ANDOR SO AMONG • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AC S OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACEHOWEVER, DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IFSO PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTA INDIVIDUAL BASIS. IF A NATIONAL COMMITTEE DECIDES MEM UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIST OR AN INTERNET SERVICE. ¶ 4. A NEWSPAPER, NEWS AGENCY, TVB ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCEJOURNAL, AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, CATION OFOF NEWSPAPERS, OF VIEWS. ¶ •BE THEELIGIBLE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTSINDIV AND SO LIMIT TEN. ¶FREE 5.EXPRESSION THERE SHALL AS ASSOCIATE MEMBERS NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST SR,OBJECTIVES, FOR EXAMPLE, THESE MAYAINCLUDE: ¶·AS ASSOCIATE MEMBE IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG D.EMBERS ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVE (LEADING JOURNALISTS GROUP): PERSONS OPERATING IN JOURNA EANT:AGENCIES, FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEW WS EDITORIAL WRITERS, COPY EDITORS, CHIEFS, CORR EOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWSBUREAU AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN WEEN PEOPLESANDPOSITIONS PEOPLES.IFPEOPLES AREINTERNET TOUNDERSTANDSERVICES. ONEANOTHER,ITIS¶ESSENTIAL THATTHEYHAVE GOOD INFORMATION EDITORIAL ON THENUMBER OF ASSOCIATE BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLI OR NEWS AGENCY IS NOTOFLIMITED. AFFILIATE MEMBERSHIP (LEADING JOU ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O MENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACA -IN-CHIEF. ¶ 6. ASSOCIATE AND AFFILIATE MEMBERSHIP CAN BE ACQUIRED S OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLDALONE PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTA MITTEE, SHALL HAVE THE POWER TO INITIALLY DETERMINE W UNDAMENTALWHICH STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIST ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS,SH B MEMBERSHIP SHALL BEMADE TO THE INSTITUTE’S DIRECTOR, WHO ALONE CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO SUBJECT TOTHE ULTIMATE AUTHORITY OFTHE EXECUTIVEBOARD. ¶7.ONASSOC NCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS UNDERST R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEYFOR HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG GHTS. THE DUES ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE HALF THE DUES FO D.ITUTION ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVE PAGE 3¶NEWS, 8.INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERSHIP SHALL BEOPEN UNDER TH EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEW EOPLES.¶ • THEAND PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN CHOOLS CENTRES OF JOURNALISM, PRESS INSTITUTES AND JOURNALI Right: Amira Hass WEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION as she accepts UTE’S ACTIVITIES. DIRECTOR SHALL HAVE POWER TO ENROL INSTITUTIO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDINGTHE AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶speaks IN2003 ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLI the UNESCO/ Guillermo CanoBE World ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O ITED. DUES FOR INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS SHALL FIXED BY THE DIRECTOR Press Freedom Prize PROMOTION in MENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AC 9. INJOURNALISM.¶WORLD SOFARASASSOCIATE MEMBERS ARE CONCERNED, DUES FOR CERTAIN C Kingston, Jamaica. S OF PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTA Left: Hass on the job. STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUTHAVE UNDERSTANDING AMONG JOURNALIST FUNDAMENTAL THE BOARD. ¶ 10. THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL POWER TOTHE SUSPEND ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B TION.OFSUSPENSION OFAMEMBER MAY BEORDERED BYAMAJORITY VOTE CATION NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS ANDOF SO NCED NEWS AMONGOF NATIONS.¶ •MEMBERS THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ONNOTIC UNDERST WO-THIRDS THE PRESENT OF THE BOARD. ¶ 11. WRITTEN R, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG ED.MEMBER CONCERNED SIXTY (60) DAYS PREVIOUS TOTOWARDS THE MEETING OF THE ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVE EANT: FREE ACCESS TOORDERED THE NEWS, FREE SUSPENDED TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, PUBLICATION OF FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEW YEOPLES.¶ MEMBER SO ORFREE EXPELLED BYNEWSPAPERS, THEEXECUTIVE BOARD • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN SHALL BE RECOGNISED ASTOTHE FINAL OF THE INSTITUTE. 12. ANY WEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARE UNDERSTAND ONEDECISION ANOTHER,ITISESSENTIAL THAT THEYHAVEGOOD¶ INFORMATION BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDINGOR AMONG JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE ISOR ESTABLI IONAL COMMITTEE TOTHE THE DIRECTOR. ¶MEANT: 13.¶ANY MEMBER RESIGNING EX ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O R EXPULSION BECOMES EFFECTIVE. 14.MEMBERSHIP SHOULD BEEXCHANGE CANCELL MENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO¶ AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE OF AC S OFMEMBERSHIP JOURNALISM.¶WORLDHAS PEACE DEPENDS UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLESTHESE AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTA CH BEENON GRANTED AND WHERE CHANGES ARE INCO UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIST BJECT TORECOGNITION BYOBJECTIVES: THEEXECUTIVE BOARD ANDCONSEQUENTLY TORB ATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, CATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OFFULL VIEWS. ¶MEMBERS • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS ANDPR SO ENCED THERE AREAT LEAST FIVE FORMALLY COMMITTED TOONTHE NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS UNDERST Y THE EXECUTIVE ALSO RECOGNISES THAT THEUNDERSTANDING COUNTRYAMONG IN W R, ITTHAT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOODBOARD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS YD.EANT: PURSUE THE AIMS OF THE THEIR COUNTRIES, MEMBE ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THEREINSTITUTE IS ESTABLISHED ANIN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDSRECRUIT THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVE FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEW MEOPLES.¶ OFTHE TOFREE THE FREEOF FLOW OFAND NEWS. AT THE REQUEST NAT • THEPRESS PROMOTIONOR OF THE EXCHANGE ACCURATE BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ •OF THETHE IMPROVEMEN STED WITH TASKSOF SUCH ASTHE COLLECTING OFGOOD MEMBERSH WEENPEOPLES ANDADMINISTRATIVE PEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTAND ONEANOTHER, ITISESSENTIAL THATTHEYHAVE INFORMATION BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE ESTABLI RIAT. FUND-RAISING ACTIVITIES SHOULD BE COORDINATED WITH THEISIPI DIO ERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION DMENT SHALL HAVEPOWER TO DECLARE ORSUS OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND A SONATIONAL AMONG PEOPLES.¶COMMITTEE • THE PROMOTION OFINACTIVE THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AC VIEWS.¶•THEACHIEVEMENT OFUND ATIONALES PRESSE IN OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM tara LANGUAGE SHAL N.ING THEREFORE, AFUNDAMENTAL STE sIngh hayer ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOW DERIVED FROM MEMB EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSP PLES OF FREEDOM OF RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMON DEONE ANOTHER, ITIS ESSENTIAL THA GOALS OF THE INSTI FSTHE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WI TV AND RADIO BRO HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION O SGONG AND GOVERNMENTS BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF TURES AND IN ITS AC TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING A o ASSUMES NO LIABILI RTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING O VEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMON SPONSIBILITIES FOR E FJOURNALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEP RINCIPLE OF FREEDOM AMENTALSTEPTOWARDS UNDERST O WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING WILLINGNESS TO WOR F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION O L COMMITTEES, WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THEAPPL IMPROV THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFOR SNTIAL WHERE THERE ARE N CANADA 1936–1998 Above right: Tara Singh Hayer at his 60th birthday party. Below right: Hayer, also pictured above left, with his wife Baldev Hayer. n 18 November 1998, Tara Singh Hayer, founder and publisher of the Indo-Canadian Times, got out of his car in the garage of his Surrey home in British Columbia and into the wheelchair he was confined to. A decade earlier, he had been sitting in his office at the paper when a gunman walked in and shot him twice at point-blank range. The attack was designed to stop him from speaking out against violence and religious extremism and his promoting of tolerance and peace within the Sikh community. Hayer survived this first assassination attempt and forged ahead undeterred, writing powerful, hard-hitting columns condemning such violence and building the Indo-Canadian Times into the largest Punjabi-language weekly in North America. But when an assassin set his sights on Hayer a second time, the journalist wasn’t as fortunate. Hayer died from his injuries at the age of 62, a death that sent ripples through Canada’s journalism community, as it was the first time a journalist had been killed in the country for his work. Born on 15 November 1936 in a tiny village in Punjab, India, Shaheed Tara Singh Hayer emigrated to Canada in 1970 and worked a series of odd jobs, including as a miner and truck driver before founding the Indo-Canadian Times in 1978. Once supportive of the cause of Sikh separatism and the military struggle to liberate Khalistan from India, he later changed his mind based on the corruption and terrorism he saw poison the movement during the 1980s. During the frequent acts of terrorism against non-Sikhs in Punjab and after the bombing of Air India Flight 182 in 1985, Hayer sided against the militants, condemning the violence and calling for greater understanding between ethnic and cultural groups. His stance made him a regular target of Sikh fundamentalists who were fighting for the hearts and minds of the tens of thousands of Sikhs in British Columbia. In 1986, a bomb was placed outside Hayer’s printing plant. Two years later, he was excommunicated by a Sikh high priest in Amritsar, India, who also forbade all Sikhs from buying or reading his paper. Hayer received numerous death threats, including calls for his assassination on Punjabi radio. A month before his murder, Hayer had agreed to be a witness in the trial of Babbar Khalsa leader, Ajaib Singh Bagri, who was accused in the Air India bombing. In 1985, Hayer visited Tarsem Singh Purewall at the offices of his friend’s newspaper, Des Pardes, in London, England. During the visit, Hayer said he overheard a conversation between Bagri and Purewall in which Bagri outlined his role in the bombing. Though Hayer’s murder remains unsolved, many speculate that the journalist was killed to prevent him from testifying at Bagri’s trial. Others believe his killing was designed to intimidate voters in advance of upcoming Sikh temple elections in Vancouver and Abbotsford. A 2009 Vancouver Sun article suggested that Hayer was the subject of at least three simultaneous murder plots related to his criticism of the tactics used by a handful of Sikh separatists in British Columbia. Many in Canada’s journalism community believe the authorities mishandled the repeated death threats against Hayer and that they should have provided him with police protection. For his part, Hayer was unconcerned about the threats. “If they get me, they get me,” Hayer said in an interview a week before his death. “There’s nothing I can do and I’m not going to stop my work.” Hayer received numerous honours for that work, including having the annual Canadian Journalists for Free Expression Award renamed for him in 1999. In 2000, he was inducted into the Canadian News Hall of Fame, making him the first non-English or non-French Canadian to receive the honour. 69 TEP TOWAR RGANISATI NSMISSION N OF THE FR EEN PEOPL G AMONG P VIEWS.¶•THEACHIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTION T OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. N.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDIN ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING O NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AM URATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEA DONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSU FTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORGANISATIONTOWORKTOWARDSTHEF HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXP ONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • T GBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOO TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF TH RTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TR VEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHA FJOURNALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUN AMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURN OWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRES OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • TH OMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF T AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. T UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISH SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AC NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTA TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIS WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • TH OMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF T AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. T UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISH SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AC NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTA TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIS WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • TH OMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF T AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. T UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISH SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AC NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTA TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIS WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERST NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • TH OMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF T AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. T UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISH SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION O NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF AC NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTA TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIS WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS Ðoán Viê´t Hoạt, reunited with his wife, Trần Thi. Thú’c, after 19 years in a Vietnesmese prison, speaks to supporters upon his arrival at Los Angeles International Airport. Đoàn vIÊ´t hoạt VIETNAM 1942– I f ever there was a case for the irrepressibility of the press freedom movement, it is in the life story of Đoàn Viˆ et Hoa∙t. The world-renowned Vietnamese political dissident was imprisoned for nearly 20 years to prevent him from conducting independent reporting and espousing his views on democracy. And yet his writings resonated around the world, unbound by the shackles of communism or the confines of his prison cell. Through his underground pro-democracy newsletter Dien Dan Tu Do (Freedom Forum) and his writings from prison, Hoa.t drew the world’s attention to the repression in Vietnam and became an international champion of free expression. Born in Vietnam on 24 December 1942, Hoa∙t protested the South Vietnamese government’s suppression of Buddhists while a student in the 1960s. Moving to the United States to study, he then earned a doctorate in education from Florida State University in 1971. After graduation, he returned to Vietnam to work as a professor and vice president at Saigon’s Van Hahn University, where he also edited the university magazine Tu Tuong (Thought). To think is to be free, Hoa∙t believes, and through his work with the magazine and in other writings, he called for economic reform in Vietnam. It was a position that incurred the wrath of the Vietnamese government, which denounced him as being anti-communist. In 1976, without the benefit of trial, Hoa∙t was imprisoned for 12 years, crammed into a cell with 40 inmates. Upon his release in 1989, he was urged to leave Vietnam and to join his sons and brother in the U.S. But Hoa∙t had a vision of a free Vietnam and wanted to work to make that vision a reality. Shortly after his release he published the first issue of Dien Dan Tu Do, which featured a variety of pro-democratic views and despatches from Vietnamese living overseas. Doan produced four copies of the must-read newsletter, issues that were passed from reader to reader before the government got wind of the rebellious publication. The newsletter was shut down in 1990 and Hoa∙t was arrested in a sweep of intellectuals and political dissidents. Charged with ‘conspiring to overthrow the government,’ Hoa∙t was sentenced to 20 years in prison in a trial in which he was forced to represent himself. After an appeal, his sentence was reduced to 15 years. While in prison the second time, Hoa∙t passed the time with yoga, Zen meditation and writing. From his cell, he offered criticism of the regime and spoke of the need for democracy – writings that were smuggled out of the prisons with the help of sympathetic inmates and guards. In an effort to muzzle Hoa∙t, the government transferred him to more remote prisons to break up his distribution network. “After I wrote the reports the officials increased their efforts to isolate me,” Hoa∙t said in a 1998 statement after his release. “Still, I felt that if I kept silent in jail, then the dictators had won. And I wanted to send a message to the people who wanted to fight for freedom that the dictators could not win by putting us in jail. I wanted to prove that you cannot, by force, silence someone who doesn’t agree with you.” Hoa∙t was eventually placed in solitary confinement without access to the outside world or to the medical treatment he needed for his deteriorating health, which included bouts with kidney stones and failing eyesight. Hoa∙t spent more than four years in solitary before international pressure led to his release in 1998. He was expelled from Vietnam and returned to the United States, reuniting with his family and becoming scholar-in-residence at the Catholic University of America in Washington, D.C. He continues to work for improvements in human rights and democracy in Vietnam. In an excerpt from an interview he gave for the 2000 book “Speak Truth To Power,” he explains what drives him to continue the fight: “My dream for the future is a dream of Vietnam. Our country has a long history of people who fought against aggression and injustice. Our highest calling is love of country, as has been demonstrated by many Vietnamese patriots in the past. I, too, have been moved by the love of my country and also by the greatness of my country’s future and the world’s future. I believe in a very bright future for Vietnam and for the whole region of Southeast Asia. Time has passed too slowly for my country and my people, and a long history of suffering left. These thoughts make me so unable to keep silent – my knowledge, vision and love of country urge me to speak. And I always believe that truth, justice and compassion will prevail, no matter how strong the dictators are, no matter how bad the situation might be.” 71 aBdI İPeKçI TURKEY 1929–1979 t hrough a fog of brutal political assassinations, Abdi İpekçi good-naturedly implored his Milliyet (Nation) readers to nurture acceptance and respect for each other and for Turkey’s Greek neighbours. As a political moderate, he was a calming advocate of democracy, harmony and reconciliation in a country torn by violence and an unstable government. With his gentle intellect and powerful commitment to human rights, İpekçi stood firm behind the notion that “the light of truth arises from a clash of ideas.” Considered the colossal name of the Turkish press, his innovative style of journalism incorporated many Western ideas. According to his old friend and Milliyet colleague, Sami Kohen, “Abdi’s understanding of journalism, according to that time was very different and modern. An advanced type of journalism was representative of the true Turkey.” Reading European and American newspapers, İpekçi developed a keen awareness of other cultures and openness to new ideas. Born in Istanbul on 9 August 1929, he developed a reputation as an honest, morally-upstanding man. When he graduated Galatasaray Lisesi High School in 1948, his uncle arranged two weeks’ work experience with family friend and well-known journalist Ahment Emin Yalman. The internship was a disaster. Yalman told Abdi to go to law school and lose his ‘creative writing’ style. Abdi dutifully complied, but could not turn his back on journalism; he wrote for the university paper before eventually leaving to kick off his journalism career as a sport reporter for the daily Yeni Sabah. Having joined the burgeoning Milliyet at age 25 as its publishing manager, thanks to his aptitude in innovative journalism he was promoted to editor-in-chief in 1959. Determinedly guiding and nurturing his newspaper, he elevated its status to one of Turkey’s most successful and influ- 72 ential dailies, while also raising the standards of the Turkish press by introducing his journalistic criteria, despite tight, often stifling legislation thwarting press freedom. Although Milliyet was his baby, he considered it to be just a small part of the puzzle when it came to reaching Turkey’s population. As a president of the Istanbul Journalists’ Union and a lecturer at Istanbul University’s Institute of Journalism from 1968, he shared his considerable skills and knowledge with new and seasoned journalists from across the country, pooling resources and bridging gaps, he worked towards a congenial media community. As well as being internationally active with the International Press Institute, he was an executive board member assisting with the organisation of the Istanbul General Assembly in 1964. İpekçi’s greatest triumph here came in 1971 when he was vice-chairman. With the support of the IPI, he organised the November 1978 conference in London for Turkish and Greek editors to dispel many of the bitter myths that divided both countries, and to enable the pundits to forge new links, thus helping them to portray their foes in a more positive light. In January 1979, the delegates continued their discourse in Rhodes. Well-respected in both communities, İpekçi orchestrated a “media swap” where leading Turkish editors visited the Greek prime minister, and the Turks hosted those from Greece. In a year in which 600 Turks were killed in terrorist violence, İpekçi was busy organising a conference on political extremism and the media in Turkey for the visiting Greek journalists. As he drove home from work on 1 February 1979, İpekçi was riddled with nine bullets. The one to his heart killed him. The exact circumstances surrounding his assassination remain foggy and rife with hearsay and rumour. In 1973, Turkey officially recognised the existence of Counter-Guerrilla as the Turkish branch of a United States’ initiative founded to organise a guerrilla force capable of countering a Soviet invasion. By the time it had found its way to Turkey, its goal was to subvert communism. Hearsay suggested that İpekçi was slain by order of the CIA station chief in Turkey in a move to silence İpekçi, who had learned of and attempted to stop the organisation’s move to recruit civilians into the Counter-Guerrilla. Über-nationalist, right-wing militants known as Bozkurtlar (Grey Wolves) were the most visible, yet unofficial force used by Counter-Guerrilla. The most dangerous members, Mehmet Ali Ağca (who later attempted to assassinate Pope John Paul II in May 1981) and Oral Çelik, were allegedly paid 100,000 Turkish lira for İpekçi’s assassination. The street on which he lived and lost his life was renamed Abdi İpekçi Street in the journalist’s memory, and on 1 February 2000 the municipality of Şişli erected an Erhan İşözen-designed bronze statue, which includes the universallyrecognised dove of peace atop a bust of Abdi. Turkey’s largest multi-purpose indoor sports and events arena opened in 1986 also proudly carries his name. Days after his death, Dr. Andreas Politakis, a Greek, instituted the biannual Abdi İpekçi Peace and Friendship Prize that honours individuals and organisations working tirelessly to promote peace and friendship between the two countries. On the day of Abdi İpekçi’s funeral the nation’s newspapers appeared with black borders, and news offices halted their presses as a mark of respect. Thousands of mourners paid their respects in one of Istanbul’s largest ever public gatherings: a fitting tribute to the man who stopped at nothing to stand up for democracy and civil freedom for his compatriots. ON NEWSPAPERS, FREEINTERNATIONALES EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE AC LAOF PRENSA, INSPANISH; PRESSE INSTIT NEWSAND AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THEBEP RMAN SPANISH; THE WORKING LANGUAGE SHALL SOURCES OFTHAT THE INSTITUTE ARE DERIVED FROM MEMBERS ISES, ESSENTIAL THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THERE WHICH SUPPORT THE PRINCIPLES OF FREEDOM OF THEAP ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED MEMBER ORINDIVIDUAL. ¶5.THE GOALS OFTHEINSTITUTE T:Y FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEW G COURSES, ACADEMIC LECTURES TV AND RADIO BROADCA ES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCUR NS AND MISSIONS TO COUNTRIES AND GOVERNMENTS, AN PEOPLES. IFSTRUCTURES PEOPLESARETO UNDERSTAND O FPEOPLES WOMEN ANDMEN IN ITS AND IN ITS ACTIVIT ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS EGINSTITUTE, AND THE INSTITUTE ASSUMES NO LIABILITY,OF LE TEISAND OPEN TOPERSONSWITH RESPONSIBILITIES FOREDITO NCE SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY W ETINTERNET, WHOSUPPORT THEPRINCIPLE OFFREEDOM OFTA OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO BY WRITTENSTATEMENT THEIRDEPENDS WILLINGNESS TOWORKFOR JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE ON UNDERSTAND IESWHERESTEP THERE ARENATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICAT AMENTAL TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOP L THE APPLICANTS. IN COUNTRIES WHERE THERE ARE NO NA NINITIALLY TO WORKDETERMINE TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING ¶ •APP THE WHETHER ORNOTOBJECTIVES: TOENROLTHE ON OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE AC INDIVIDUAL BASIS. HOWEVER, IF A NATIONAL COMMITTEE RNEWS AN INTERNET SERVICE. ¶ 4. A NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NE AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE P LIMIT OF TEN. ¶ 5. THERE SHALL BE ELIGIBLE AS ASSOCIATE IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THERE SACCORDANCE OBJECTIVES,FOR EXAMPLE, THESE MAYIS INCLUDE: ¶·ASAS WITH THIS BELIEF THERE ESTABLISHED A EMBERS (LEADING JOURNALISTS GROUP): PERSONS OPERA T:WS FREE ACCESSEDITORIAL TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEW AGENCIES, WRITERS, COPY EDITORS, BUREA ES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OFINTERNET THE FREESERVICES. EXCHANGE OFNUMBE ACCUR EDITORIAL POSITIONSON ¶THE PEOPLES PEOPLES. IFPEOPLES TOUNDERSTAND O OR NEWSAND AGENCY IS NOT LIMITED.ARE AFFILIATE MEMBERSH -IN-CHIEF. ¶ 6. ASSOCIATE AND AFFILIATE MEMBERSHIP CA G ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF MITTEE, WHICH ALONE SHALL HAVE THEOF POWER TO INITIAL NCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM THE PRESS, BY W MEMBERSHIP SHALLBEMADE TOTHE INSTITUTE’SAND DIRECTO T OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS SOBA SUBJECT TO THE ULTIMATE AUTHORITY OF THE EXECUTIVE JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTAND IGHTS. THE DUES FOR ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE H AMENTAL STEP3TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOP ITUTION PAGE ¶8.INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE NHOOLS TO WORK TOWARDS FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE AND CENTRESTHE OF JOURNALISM, PRESS INSTITUTES UTE’S ACTIVITIES.THE DIRECTOR SHALLOF HAVE POWER TOAC EN ON OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION VIEWS. ¶ • THE ITED. DUES FORINSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS SHALLBE FIXED B NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE P INSOFARAS ASSOCIATE MEMBERS ARE CONCERNED, DUE IS9. ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THERE FACCORDANCE THE BOARD. ¶ 10. THETHIS EXECUTIVE BOARDISSHALL HAVE POW WITH BELIEF THERE ESTABLISHED A TION. SUSPENSION OF A MEMBER MAY BE ORDERED BY A MA T:O-THIRDS FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS,PRESENT FREE TRANSMISSION OF¶NEW OF THE MEMBERS OF THE BOARD. 11 ES.¶ • THECONCERNED PROMOTIONSIXTY OF THE(60) FREE EXCHANGE OFTO ACCUR MEMBER DAYS PREVIOUS THE M YPEOPLES MEMBERAND SOORDERED OREXPELLED BYTHEEX PEOPLES.SUSPENDED IFPEOPLESARE TOUNDERSTAND O Clockwise from far left: Abdi İpekçi signing the Code of Press Ethics in 1960, put forth by newspaper owners and editors as a move towards a free and responsible press in Turkey; İpekçi showing off his newspaper; İpekçi, second row, third from left, during a 1958 visit of a group of Turkish journalists to the NATO Headquarters in Paris. WHICHISMEANT:FRE Kemal JOURNALISTS AND SOKursPahIć SM.¶WORLD PEACE D ORE, A FUNDAMENTA IS ESTABLISHED AN O ENEWS,FREETRANS S.¶ • THE PROMOTION TANDING BETWEEN P ERSTANDING AMONG K TOWARDS THE FOL , FREE PUBLICATION XCHANGE OF ACCURA D PEOPLES. IF PEOPLE TOBRINGABOUTUND VIEWS.¶•THEACHIEVEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPR T OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND N.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDE ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGU NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTAN URATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶W DONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPT FTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORGANISATIONTOWORKTOWA HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS ONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NAT GBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEY TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS RTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEW VEMENTOFUNDERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFR FJOURNALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESA AMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGT OWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOF OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJ ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF V OMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEM AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORM UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS E SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSM NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHA NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOU TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF T OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJ ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF V OMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEM AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORM UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS E SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSM NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHA NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOU TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF T OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJ ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF V OMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEM AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORM UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS E SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSM NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHA NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOU TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF T OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON NTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJ ESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF V OMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEM AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORM A policeman in Belgrade beats Kemal Kurspahić during the student demonstrations in Belgrade, June 1968. Kurspahić and then-U.S. Senator Joseph Biden in front of the Oslobođenje building during the war in Bosnia and Herzegovina. BOSNIA AND HERZEGOVINA 1946– t o be an editor in chief during a war is not easy. To be an editor-in-chief of a newspaper during a city siege lasting several years – when getting paper to print a newspaper is a struggle and snipers are shooting at city dwellers – is close to impossible. Nonetheless, Kemal Kurspahić managed. Editor-in-chief of the Sarajevo daily Oslobođenje, Kurspahić and this team managed to publish from an atomic bomb shelter throughout the Sarajevo Siege from 1992 to 1995. In one of the more legendary confrontations, a Serb commander called the newspaper asking whether it had ordered 32 mortar shells, promising to deliver them right away. Moments later, 32 mortar shells were fired at the newspaper’s building. Kurspahić understood the importance of all Sarajevians being able to read a newspaper – war or not; or maybe, especially because there was a war, that it was important to have a good paper. So, when the war in Bosnia and Herzegovina began in 1992, Kurspahić called together the editors, reporters and other staff members of the daily and made a grim offer to those willing to work under relentless artillery tank and sniper fire. He said: “I cannot promise that you will be alive when the siege is over, nor can I promise you that you will get any award or promotions. But I can promise you this: as long as Sarajevo exists, this newspaper will publish every day.” And this promise Kurspahić, fondly called ‘Kemo,’ kept. By printing during the war, he and his team kept the flame of press freedom alive. They were devoted to one goal: to produce a newspaper that upheld the highest standards of journalism and morality. In the process, they bore witness to the Siege of Sarajevo and the murder of more than 10,000 people. Kurspahić became the editor in chief of Oslobođenje in 1988, several years before the war started. Under his leadership, the paper broke from the League of Communists control to become Paper of the Year in the Socialist Federal Republic of Yugoslavia in 1989. For publishing under impossible conditions, Kurspahić and his team received numerous international awards. Born in 1946, Kurspahić became a smalltown correspondent for Oslobođenje in 1962 as a high school freshman. As a student at Belgrade University’s Law School, he was an editor of the weekly Student during the 1968 students’ unrest in Europe and Yugoslavia. Kurspahić’s book “Prime Time Crime: Balkan Media in War and Peace” speaks about this period with a photo showing Belgrade students protesting the media distortion of their demonstrations with the sign: “Don’t Trust the Press.” But one other photo from 1968 also speaks about Kurspahić: one that shows him on the ground after being beaten by a policeman while covering the student demonstrations for Student. Kurspahić later became a professional correspondent for Oslobođenje in Belgrade in 1969 and then a correspondent in Jajce (1971-1973). He was later editor of the newspaper’s sports, politics and newsroom departments from 1974 to 1981, the paper’s U.N. correspondent in New York (1981-1985) and Oslobođenje deputy editor in chief from 1985 to 1988. In December 1988, he became the first editor-in-chief elected by the editorial staff of Oslobođenje. After the war in Bosnia and Herzegovina, Kurspahić served as the managing editor of The Connection Newspapers in McLean, Virginia, U.S.A. from 1997 to 2001 and again in April 2007. In that capacity, he received the Virginia Press Association’s Best Editorial Pages Award in 1999. Kurspahić, recipient of the Dr. Erhard Busek South East Europe Media Organization Award for Better Understanding, has published several books in which he analyses the war and the role of media in the war in former Yugoslavia. Today he heads the Media in Democracy Institute in Washington, D.C. 75 daoud KuttaB PALESTINIAN TERRITORIES 1955– 76 t he power of the digital age has facilitated Daoud Kuttab’s transformation from the young U.S.-educated business administration graduate, who couldn’t resist the lure of the Palestinian newsroom, to one of the most respected and prolific news pundits in the Middle East. From the moment he saw his name printed in the weekly English supplement of Al Fajir, the by-line bug bit him. Kuttab’s career in journalism is underpinned by his belief that “our job as media professionals is to know and to let others know,” and every new, creative step he takes is on his path “to effect a genuine change [in] the role of media as an alternative source of public service.” Both the Israelis and the Palestinian Authority have imprisoned Kuttab during his fight for press freedom. The first time, he was imprisoned for six hours following a peaceful ‘mouths silenced by duct tape’ march initiated by the Arab Press Association against Israel’s censorship policy. He was then jailed for several hours following accusations of anti-Semitism in his column for the Jerusalem Post. This was followed by imprisonment for seven days by the Palestinian Authority following a legitimate broadcast of a particularly lively Palestinian Legislative Council session discussing corruption. What Kuttab considers his greatest victory started an hour short of midnight on 20 May 1997 when he was invited to the police station for a coffee and a chat. He was detained in an empty administration office at the police station where officers had been told to treat Kuttab kindly and with respect. For three days, he was ‘entertained’ on the premises until a TV crew followed his visiting children into the building, riling the chief of police. Angered by his children’s expulsion, Kuttab went on an impromptu hunger strike and was bundled off to a secure prison. While there, he heard the news drifting across the exercise yard that “the U.S. State Department had issued a statement calling on Arafat to release [him].” He knew nothing of the rallying and international support he was receiving from the outside world: the French foreign ministry’s statement, The Washington Post editorial, the White House spokesman – all calling for his immediate liberation. Upon his release, despite being warned to not talk to the waiting media, Kuttab stood in front of his peers, revealing: “I felt that I was the victim of an attempt to restrict my freedom of expression.” While he was honoured as a press freedom hero by the International Press Institute in 2000, he considers this role to be a natural extension to his job as a journalist. As a result of that accolade, he attended an IPI-sponsored conference in Amman, at which he met a Jordanian official who boasted that his country opposed any kind of Internet censorship. Showcasing his ability to creatively bypass government monopolies and media restrictions, Kuttab consequently founded AmmanNet, the Arab world’s first online community radio, and now one of the world’s largest podcasters. Based in Jordan, AmmanNet deals with everyday Jordanian ‘pocket-book’ issues, how to deal with ever-increasing fuel prices, salaries and the failing local transport, as well as continuing Kuttab’s crusade to expose miscarriages of justice. A series humanising the plight of the “30-something Jordanians still in jail after 20 years of peace treaty,” motivated the Red Cross to encourage the Jordanian government to permit family visits, inspiring talk of having the prisoners released. Chief of AmmanNet, Daoud is also a regular columnist for the Jordan Times and Jerusalem Post as well as continuing as founding director of the historic Institute of Modern Media at Al Quds University in Ramallah and its purely educational TV station, which he created during the exciting days following the Oslo Peace Process in 1991. Before the Israelis destroyed the station’s premises on 8 April 2002, Al Quds TV “dealt with subjects ranging from the physical and sexual abuse of children to the problems of early marriage among young Palestinian women to the lack of respect for people with disabilities.” Kuttab tried to sue the Israeli army for unprovoked destruction of property, amounting to over $200,000 (USD), but the Israeli courts threw it out as the cost of war. Having rebuilt Al Quds TV for the next generation, in partnership with Israeli educational television, he now produces “Sesame Stories,” a Middle East version of Sesame Street that features Israeli and Palestinian children playing together and learning tolerance. Born in Bethlehem on 1 April 1955, Kuttab’s parents relocated the family to the United States when he was 17. Knowing that his future lay in Palestine, he returned home and briefly worked as business manager at Al Fajir in Jerusalem, soon joining the reporting team and starting his journey to change the face of Palestinian media. IONALDELAPRENSA,INSPANISH;INTERNATIONALESPRESSEINSTITUT,INGERMAN;HEREINAFTERR GERMAN AND SPANISH; THETHEY WORKINGHAVE LANGUAGE SHALL BEINFORMATION. ENGLISH. ¶ 4. THE INSTITUTE IS A ITDE.ENCH, ISTHEESSENTIAL THAT GOOD THE RESOURCES OF THE INSTITUTE ARE DERIVED FROM MEMBERSHIP DUES, CONTRIBUTIONS FROM BUSINESSES, WHICH SUPPORT THE PRINCIPLES OF FREEDOM OFTHERE THE PRESS AND FREEDOM OF EXPRES IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS IS ESTABLISHED FITOF ANYMEMBERORINDIVIDUAL. ¶5.THE GOALSBELIEF OFTHEINSTITUTE,ASDESCRIBED INTHEPREAMBLE , TRAINING COURSES, ACADEMIC LECTURES TV AND RADIO BROADCAST MATERIAL WHICH CANOF BE INN NT: FREEAND ACCESS THEAND NEWS, FREEAND TRANSMISSION ELEGATIONS MISSIONS TOTO COUNTRIES GOVERNMENTS, COLLABORATION WITH OTHER LANCE OF WOMEN AND MEN IN ITS STRUCTURES AND IN ITS ACTIVITIES. ¶ IPI CONSTITUTION PAGE 2 PLES.¶ THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF E, FOR THE• INSTITUTE, AND THE INSTITUTE ASSUMES NO LIABILITY, LEGAL OR OTHERWISE, FORACC ANY IN E INSTITUTE IS OPEN TO PERSONS WITH RESPONSIBILITIES FOR EDITORIAL OR NEWS POLICY IN NEWSP EN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ORON THEINTERNET, WHOSUPPORT THEPRINCIPLE OFFREEDOMOF THEPRESS ANDDESIRETOCO-OPE ALLY AND BY WRITTEN STATEMENT THEIR WILLINGNESS TO WORK FOR THE ACHIEVEMENT OFPRESSFR RING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS NCOUNTRIESWHERETHEREARENATIONALCOMMITTEES,APPLICATIONSSHALLBEMADETOTHENAT T TOENROLTHE APPLICANTS. INCOUNTRIESWHERE THERE ARENONATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICAT RANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B POWERTOINITIALLY DETERMINEWHETHERORNOT TOENROL THEAPPLICANTS. INALLCASES, ENROLM BE ON AN INDIVIDUAL BASIS. HOWEVER, IF A NATIONAL COMMITTEE SO DECIDES MEMBERSHIP MAYS A ENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SYSTEM OR AN INTERNET SERVICE. ¶ 4. A NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NEWS AGENCY, TV OR RADIO BROA R UP TO A LIMIT OF TEN. ¶ 5. THERE SHALL BEPEACE ELIGIBLE ASDEPENDS ASSOCIATE MEMBERS INDIVIDUALS WHO AR OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD ON UNDERSTAN STITUTE’S OBJECTIVES,FOREXAMPLE,THESEMAYINCLUDE: ¶·ASASSOCIATE MEMBERS: EXECUTIVES FFILIATEMEMBERS(LEADING JOURNALISTS GROUP): PERSONSOPERATINGINJOURNALISTIC CATEGO NDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PE ING OR NEWS AGENCIES, EDITORIAL WRITERS, COPY EDITORS, BUREAU CHIEFS, CORRESPONDENTS, TV SIMILAR EDITORIAL POSITIONS ON INTERNET SERVICES. ¶ THE NUMBER OF ASSOCIATE AND AFFILIATE M ION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: • T NISATION OR NEWS AGENCY IS NOT LIMITED. AFFILIATE MEMBERSHIP (LEADING JOURNALISTS¶ GRO IR EDITOR-IN-CHIEF. ¶ 6. ASSOCIATE AND AFFILIATE MEMBERSHIP CAN BE ACQUIRED AS FOLLOWS. IN C TION OF NEWSPAPERS, OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE NAL COMMITTEE, WHICH ALONE SHALLFREE HAVE THEEXPRESSION POWER TO INITIALLY DETERMINE WHETHER OR NOT TIONSNEWS FORMEMBERSHIP SHALLBE MADETOTHEINSTITUTE’S DIRECTOR, WHOALONESHALLHAVETHE THEP ED AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT NTSARESUBJECT TOTHEULTIMATE AUTHORITYOFTHE EXECUTIVE BOARD.¶7.ASSOCIATEOF ANDAFFILI RIGHTS. THE DUESTHAT FOR ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE HALF THE DUES FOR FULL MEMBERS ITVOTING ESSENTIAL THEY HAVE GOOD THE IPIIS CONSTITUTION PAGE3¶8.INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERSHIP SHALLBEINFORMATION. OPENUNDERTHECONDITIONS O LEGES, SCHOOLS AND CENTRES OF JOURNALISM, PRESS INSTITUTES AND JOURNALISTS’ ORGANISAT IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED HEINSTITUTE’S ACTIVITIES.THE DIRECTOR SHALLHAVE POWER TOENROLINSTITUTIONAL MEMBERSS IS NOT LIMITED. DUES FOR INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS SHALL BE FIXED BY THE DIRECTOR IN ACCORDANC NT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREEDUES TRANSMISSION OFOFTN RIGHTS. ¶9.INSO FARASASSOCIATE MEMBERS ARECONCERNED, FORCERTAINCATEGORIES EEMENT OF THE BOARD. ¶ 10. THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL HAVE POWER TO SUSPEND OR EXPEL ANY M PLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OFBETHE FREE EXCHANGE ACCP CONSTITUTION. SUSPENSION OFAMEMBERMAY ORDERED BYAMAJORITY VOTEOFTHEOF MEMBERS VAL OF TWO-THIRDS OF THE MEMBERS PRESENT OF THE BOARD. ¶ 11. WRITTEN NOTICE OF THE CONSID EN PEOPLES ANDPEOPLES. IFPEOPLES ARE TOOF UNDERSTAND EN TO THE MEMBER CONCERNED SIXTY (60) DAYS PREVIOUS TO THE MEETING THE EXECUTIVE BOA ESIRE.ANYMEMBERSOORDEREDSUSPENDEDOREXPELLEDBYTHEEXECUTIVEBOARDSHALLHAVETH RING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE PRESENT SHALL BE RECOGNISED AS THE FINAL DECISION OF THE INSTITUTE. ¶JOURNALISTS 12. ANY MEMBER SHALL OTHENATIONALCOMMITTEEORTOTHEDIRECTOR.¶13.ANYMEMBERRESIGNINGOREXPELLEDSHALLB NATIONORAND EXPULSION BECOMESEFFECTIVE.¶14.OF MEMBERSHIP SHOULDBE CANCELLED INCASESWHE RANCE SAFEGUARDING FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B DERWHICHMEMBERSHIPHASBEENGRANTEDANDWHERETHESECHANGESAREINCONTRADICTIONT S¶1A)SUBJECT TORECOGNITIONBYTHEEXECUTIVE BOARDANDCONSEQUENTLY TORATIFICATION ENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS ANDBYS RYWHERETHEREAREATLEASTFIVEFULLMEMBERSFORMALLYCOMMITTEDTOTHEPRINCIPLESOFTH RILYJOURNALISM.¶WORLD IMPLY THAT THE EXECUTIVE BOARD ALSO RECOGNISES THAT THE COUNTRY WHICH THE NATIO OF PEACE DEPENDS ONINUNDERSTAN ACTIVELYPURSUETHEAIMSOFTHEINSTITUTEINTHEIRCOUNTRIES,RECRUITMEMBERSANDMAYREP FREEDOMOFTHEPRESS ORTOTOWARDS THEFREEFLOWOFUNDERSTANDING NEWS.ATTHEREQUESTOFTHENATIONAL COMMITT NDAMENTAL STEP AMONG PEM EENTRUSTEDWITHADMINISTRATIVE TASKSSUCHASTHECOLLECTINGOFMEMBERSHIP DUES.THEY SECRETARIAT. FUND-RAISING ACTIVITIESTHE SHOULDFOLLOWING BE COORDINATED WITH THE IPI DIRECTOR. AN ION TOSHALL WORK OBJECTIVES: ¶ANN •T IVEBOARD HAVETOWARDS POWERTODECLARE ANATIONALCOMMITTEEINACTIVE ORSUSPENDRECOGNIT OFPARAGRAPH 2OR3ABOVEHAVENOTBEEN FULFILLED ORTHEREISAFUNDAMENTAL CHANGE IN THEC TION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF • THE .¶DECLARATION OFANATIONALCOMMITTEE’S INACTIVITY ORSUSPENSION OFVIEWS. ANATIONAL¶COMMITTE TICENEWS THATSUCHACTION WILLBENATIONS.¶ CONSIDEREDBYTHE EXECUTIVE BOARD,WITHASTATEMENT OFTHE THER ED AMONG • THE IMPROVEMENT OF IXTY (60) DAYS BEFORE THE MEETING OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. THE NATIONAL COMMITTEE SHALL H PERSONAL APPEARANCE OFAMEMBER ORMEMBERS OFGOOD THENATIONAL COMMITTEEATTHEEXECUTIV ITENAL IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE THE COMMITTEE FROMWHICH RECOGNITION HAS BEENORDERED TOINFORMATION. BESUSPENDEDBYTHEEXECUTIV PPEAL TOTHENEXTGENERALASSEMBLY, INWHICHBELIEF CASEAMAJORITY VOTEIS OFMEMBERS PRESENTSHA IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS THERE ESTABLISHED D MAY AT ANY TIME RESTORE RECOGNITION TO A NATIONAL COMMITTEE. ¶ NOTWITHSTANDING THE P F THE EXECUTIVE BOARD TO CONSIDER A NATIONAL COMMITTEE INACTIVE SHALL NOT AFFECT THE RIG NT: FREE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF N AS MEMBERS OFACCESS THE INSTITUTETO ANDTHE TO PARTICIPATE FULLY IN ITS AFFAIRS. ¶ WHERE THE EXECUTIVE B NACTIVE, THE TASKS FORMERLY EXECUTED BY THIS COMMITTEE WILL BE PERFORMED BY THE DIRECTOR PLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF FREE ACC F CONFERENCES, SEMINARS, WORKSHOPS, ETC, TOTHE DISCUSS MEDIAEXCHANGE FREEDOM ISSUES OR OF ANY OTHER R IVITY. THEY ARE ALSO ENCOURAGED TO COLLABORATE WITH ORGANISATIONS IN THEIR COUNTRIES O EN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES TO UNDERSTAND ARTICLE IV¶IPICOMMITTEES OFEXPERTS¶1.IPI COMMITTEES OFARE EXPERTS SHALL EXISTTODEALWITH VE BOARD ON POLICY ISSUES; ¶ · ASSIST THE DIRECTOR IN ARRANGING CONFERENCES/SEMINARS OR O RING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS PPOINTEDBYTHEBOARD,REPRESENTINGDIFFERENTGEOGRAPHICALREGIONS.FURTHERMEMBERSSH OFHERORHIS DEPUTIES. INGENERAL,COMMITTEE MEMBERSHIP SHOULDNOTEXCEED 20ANDIPIMEM RANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM B ESTABLISHED TOOVERSEE THEACTIVITIESOFTHEIPI PRESS FREEDOMFUND.OF THISTHE FUNDISPRESS, TOBEADMINIS Above, left and right: Daoud Kuttab at work. Middle, right to left: Kuttab speaking at the IPI World Congress and 45th General Assembly in 1996; mingling with conference delegates; pictured with fellow IPI World Press Freedom Hero, May Chidiac. Below: Kuttab interviewing U.S. Secretary of State Hilary Clinton. ATIONALE KING LANG DERIVED F PLES OF FR EGOALSO S TV AND R ENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALISTSOFTHEWORLD.¶INACCORDANCEWITH WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE N OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION O WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES ENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDIN DANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORGANISATIONTOWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGO SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMON MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEAC PEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDER TANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLO ARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPR NGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHANGEOFACCURATEANDBALANCEDNEWSAMONGNATIONS.¶•THEIMP EACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFO first UNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALISTSOFTHEWORLD.Gwen ¶INLister, ACCORDANCE WITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISES OLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:row,FREE ACCESS TOTHENEWS,FREETRANSMISSIO second from RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF right, with the HE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERS founding staff of OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNAL The Namibian. HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS ANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE ST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEME EPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATIO RSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTAB LOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF HE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERS OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNAL HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS ANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE ST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEME EPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATIO RSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTAB LOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF HE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERS OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNAL HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS ANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE ST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEME EPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATIO RSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTAB LOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF HE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERS OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNAL HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TOScenes WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS Above left and right: ANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND from the triple grenade CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER attack on the offices of RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON The Namibian, August 1990. G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI Below: Lister speaks at the DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH2004 IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE International Women’s ST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEME Media Foundation’s 15th EPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEEN PEOPLES ANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATIO Annual Courage in Journalism RSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISAwards TO inBRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTAB Beverly Hills, LOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION California. RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF HE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERS OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNAL HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS ANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE ST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEME EPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATIO RSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTAB LOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF HE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERS OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNAL HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS ANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE ST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEME EPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATIO RSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTAB LOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF HE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERS gWen lIster NAMIBIA 1953– t wenty-five years ago, at the height of the South African occupation of the province once known as South-West Africa, The Namibian emerged. The rebellious brainchild of founder and editor Gwen Lister, the newspaper dared to challenge the status quo, openly advocating the liberation of Namibia and serving as an international pipeline of unfiltered information for the atrocities and human rights abuses committed by the South African Army. Lister’s crusade to bring about both a free press and a free Namibia incurred the wrath of the government, which used all manner of threats and intimidation to muffle her increasingly influential voice. “I guess they thought being a woman … that if they put the fear of God into me, that I’d soon resign from journalism and go on and do something else,” Lister said in a 2003 interview on ABC Australia's Radio National. “But that didn’t happen because the more I guess they targeted me, the more I dug my heels in.” Born on 5 December 1953 in East London, South Africa, Lister moved to Namibia shortly after college and began her journalism career at the Windhoek Advertiser. Her tenure at the Advertiser was short however; she resigned when the South African government pressured the paper into a written agreement that it would stop publishing positive stories about the South-West Africa People’s Organization, or SWAPO, the opposition liberation group. Lister and former Advertiser editor Hanes Smith went on to found the Windhoek Observer in 1978. As political editor of the weekly Observer, Lister was repeatedly harassed and threatened by the South African government for her critical reporting on its apartheid policies in Namibia. During her six years with the Observer, Lister had her home raided by police and she was tried for several violations of South African laws, including the Publications Act, the Customs and Excise Act and the Internal Security Act. She fought the charges and was acquitted. In May 1984, the South African Publications Board imposed a ban on the Observer, one that Lister successfully fought after raising funds from the international community. While Lister was protesting the ban, the Observer’s management demoted her, blaming her for the legal battle. The paper’s staff walked out in solidarity with Lister. They were fired and Lister subsequently resigned. Later that year, Lister distributed to the media a government document that authorized the interception of her mail by the security police. The document had been sent to her by mistake rather than to the postmaster general and Lister was jailed for distributing it. Upon her release, her passport was confiscated, she was confined to the Windhoek district and she was required to report to the police three times a week. These measures were widely viewed as attempts to prevent her from generating the financial backing for a new newspaper. But they were unsuccessful. The Namibian was launched in August 1985 as the first and only independent journalistic voice in the country’s struggle for liberation. In the face of both government pressure and social pressure from white Namibians to not disturb the status quo, Lister used The Namibian to shine an international spotlight on the brutality of the South African occupation. The newspaper’s pioneering journalism helped lay the pavement for the United Nations settlement plan for Namibia, Resolution 435. It also made Lister a target again. In June 1988, Lister, four months pregnant, was detained as the government tried to pressure her into revealing the source of a confidential document outlining a plan to give greater powers to police and to declare a state of emergency in Namibia. Lister was held for several days before the government bowed to international pressure to release her. The government’s campaign of intimidation continued as issues of The Namibian were confiscated and white advertisers boycotted at the behest of authorities. The Namibian’s office was regularly shot at and tear-gas was put in the building’s air-conditioning system. In October 1998, the offices were burned down by a rightwing group known as the ‘White Wolves.’ Lister herself was branded a SWAPO supporter and as such received constant death threats, even after Namibia gained its independence in 1990. In 1991, the Civil Cooperation Bureau of the thenSouth African Defence Force, sent Irish mercenary Donald Acheson to Namibia in an unsuccessful attempt to assassinate Lister. Namibia’s independence brought with it a constitution that guaranteed press freedom, eventually bringing about a less dangerous environment for journalists. Still, Lister’s work continues to ruffle the government’s feathers. In 2000, the Namibian Cabinet banned all government advertising in The Namibian for its ‘antigovernment’ stance. Former President Sam Nujomo extended the ban in 2002 to prohibit government agencies from buying the paper with state money. Both bans remain in effect. In the interview with the ABC, Lister reflected on her decades-long journey in journalistic courage. “It’s a very strange thing, but I suppose I kind of felt as though nothing would happen to me,” Lister said. “I was so completely convinced that I was doing the right thing that I really didn’t look over my shoulder.” 79 moChtar luBIs INDONESIA 1922–2004 80 t ime had its own agenda for Mochtar Lubis, who spent his life defending Indonesia’s dignity through his newspaper editorials and the copious amount of fiction penned both in and out of his long periods of detention. Where most find being an author or a newspaper editor in chief job enough, Lubis wore both mantles successfully, earning himself the reputation of being one of Indonesia’s most respected journalists and best-known authors. While taking an active role in many of Indonesia’s journalism, communication and literary associations, he also forged relationships with many international bodies. His vast catalogue of work was recognised by an equally vast catalogue of awards and honours – from the National Literary Award in 1958 to his being the first Indonesian to receive the Raman Magsaysay Award for Journalism, Literature and Creative Communication Arts. In his acceptance speech (read for him in his absence) he said, “We maintain that freedom from hunger and freedom of expression are one and indivisible, that democracy, human dignity and freedom are worth fighting for.” In his 1959 short story “Kuli Kontrak” (Contract Coolies), Lubis remembers a pivotal childhood experience of secretly witnessing his father overseeing a lashing in the local prison. This upsetting event rooted Lubis’ belief in universal humanism and concern for human dignity. His human-focused moral code insisted he expose corruption and government misconduct in Indonesia. During his last detention, he wrote, “I am ... fully convinced that our era is the era of human freedom and human cooperation and not the era of human enslavement and inevitable confrontation ... But only a truly free press can help build up traditions of freedom.” As an intelligent, knowledge-hungry man, he read widely, making use of his Western-style education to understand his own nation and international affairs. Aware of his unique position and fuelled by his nationalism, he felt it his duty to translate his privileged education and firsthand experiences of the Western world – gained through his travels with the International Press Institute – for his Indonesian compatriots, exposing them to cultures dramatically different to their own. Lubis was born on 7 March 1922 into a wealthy, aristocratic family in Padang, West Sumatra. His biographer, Professor David Hill, described him as “tall, handsome, urbane, and articulate in several languages” with “a booming laugh.” Lubis’ father was a well-paid, Dutch-appointed demang (assistant regional administrative head); his childhood was filled with luxury. Nonetheless, his father instilled a strong work ethic alongside a hey recommendation that Lubis and his siblings never work for the colonial government. In fact, no Indonesian government was spared Lubis’ criticism. As a young crusading editor at the pro-Republican daily Indonesia Raya (Glorious Indonesia), his pencil sharpened against corruption, his questioning of President Sukarno’s motives and agenda linked him inextricably with Indonesia’s political upheaval of the 1950s. Lubis sided with the insurgents of a bloodless coup led by a West Sumatran regimental commander in 1956 suggesting, “If necessary for the greater good, then President Sukarno and Chief of Staff (Abdul Haris) Nasution must also be prepared to relinquish their positions.” This time, he was imprisoned – without trial – for four years, making him the first Indonesian journalist detained for more than a few weeks for stirring anti-government sentiment. As Lubis was chairman of IPI’s National Committee in Indonesia, the IPI succeeded in having him transferred to house arrest for the majority of his four-year detention. During this time he strolled free in his imagination and penned his internationally-acclaimed novel “Jalan Tak Ada” (Road with No End) in which he explored fear and courage during the Indonesian revolution. Unperturbed by his stolen years, Lubis, upon his sudden release in April 1961, gave an inspiring, damning address to IPI’s general assembly in Tel Aviv, resulting in his re-arrest on his return to Indonesia. Imprisoned hundreds of kilometres from his Jakarta home, he learnt that his book “Twilight in Jakarta” had been translated and published in English. This pioneering event inspired a series of other works drawn from the developing world and presented in English, establishing Lubis as a literary spokesperson for the Third World. Released by President Suharto in 1966, Lubis returned Raya to its previous notoriety: accusing the New Order government of working with Japanese investors to control the Indonesian economy. Raya was banned for the last time and Lubis was investigated and arrested a year later, accused of being heavily involved in the Jakarta riots on 15 January 1974, in reaction to Japanese Prime Minister Kakuei Tanaka’s visit. On his release, he toured Indonesia faithfully, recording its history, and he became director-general of the Press Foundation of Asia (PFA), established in 1967. Throughout his life, Mochtar Lubis’ dedication to truth and humanity was recognised and praised. Sadly, in his final years, Alzheimer’s stole his memories. He died in Jakarta on 2 July 2004 aged 82. HIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS IONAL DE LA PRENSA, IN SPANISH; INTERNA NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPER OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OFAND ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWSWORK AMONG N ENCH, GERMAN SPANISH; THE S.IFPEOPLES ARETOUNDERSTANDOF ONETHE ANOTHER, ITISESSENTIALTHAT THE DE. THE RESOURCES INSTITUTE ARE DING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITHD NG OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: THE FREE ACCESS TO THE BUSINESSES, WHICH SUPPORT PRINCIP AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION O FIT OF ANYON MEMBER ORBETWEEN INDIVIDUAL. ¶PEOPLES. 5.TH PEACE DEPENDS UNDERSTANDING PEOPLES AND DS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUTLECTURE UNDERSTANDI ,THE TRAINING COURSES, ACADEMIC FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING ELEGATIONS AND MISSIONS TOUNDERSTANDING COUNTRIES EE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF AMO NS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THEAND PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD P LANCE OF WOMEN MEN IN ITS STRUCT Y HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARD E, FOR THE INSTITUTE, AND THE INSTITUTE HIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATIONWITH OF NEWSPAPER ENEWS, INSTITUTE IS OPEN TO PERSONS RES OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG N OR ON THE INTERNET, WHO SUPPORT THE PR S.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHE DING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH ALLY AND BY WRITTEN STATEMENT THEIR W OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREENATIONAL ACCESS TO THE NNGPEACE COUNTRIES WHERE THERE ARE AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION O DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEENIN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. TTO ENROL THE APPLICANTS. COUNTRIES DS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDI POWER TO INITIALLY DETERMINE THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE ANDWHETHER SAFEGUARDING EE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OFHOWEVER, UNDERSTANDING AMO BE ON AN INDIVIDUAL BASIS. IF NS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD P SYSTEM OR AN INTERNET SERVICE. ¶ 4. A N Y HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARD BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS RHIS UP TO A LIMIT OF TEN. ¶ 5. THERE SHALL B NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPER STITUTE’S OBJECTIVES, FOR EXAMPLE, THE OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG N S.IFPEOPLESARE TOUNDERSTAND ONEANOTHER,JOURNALISTS ITISESSENTIALTHATTHE FFILIATE MEMBERS (LEADING DING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH ING NEWS AGENCIES, WRITE NG OFOR FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH EDITORIAL IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SOPOSITIONS AMONG PEOPLES.¶ •ON THE PROMOTION O SIMILAR EDITORIAL INTERNE PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. NISATION OR NEWS AGENCY NOT LIMITE DS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRINGIS ABOUT UNDERSTANDI THEEDITOR-IN-CHIEF. FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING IR ¶ 6. ASSOCIATE ANDAMO A EE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING NAL COMMITTEE, WHICH ALONE SHALL HA NS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD P Y HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE,SHALL A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARD TIONS FOR MEMBERSHIP BE MADE TO HIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS NTS SUBJECT THE NEWS,ARE FREE TRANSMISSION OFTO NEWS, FREEULTIMATE PUBLICATION OF AUTHO NEWSPAPER OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG N Middle: Mochtar Lubis, fourth from left, facing camera, leading the Indonesian delegation during the IPI hosted discussion designed to improve Dutch-Indonesian press relations, 1956. ATIONA KING LA DERIVE PLES OF ENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHE WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS O ENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,AFUNDAMENTALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDIN DANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORGANISATIONTOWORKTOWARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJE SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEME PEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION TANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISH ARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPROMOTIONOFTHEFREEEXCHANGEOFACCURA EACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONE UNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALISTSOFTHEW OLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISM RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEO HE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWE OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BR HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERA ANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMEN CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES O RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FU G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANIS DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PU ST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND B EPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTH RSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORL LOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS ME RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEO HE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWE OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BR HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERA ANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMEN CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES O RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FU G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANIS DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PU ST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND B EPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTH RSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORL LOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS ME RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEO HE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWE OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BR HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERA ANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMEN CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES O RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FU G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANIS DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PU ST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND B EPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTH RSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORL LOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS ME RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEO HE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWE OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BR HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERA ANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMEN CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES O RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FU G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANIS DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PU Clockwise, from far left: Kronid Lyubarsky pictured with friends, at work and resting. Below left: Lyubarsky says farewell to friends, Moscow 1977. Below right: Lyubarsky looking at the Tungus meteorite, Siberia 1961. KronId lyuBarsKy RUSSIA 1934–1996 t he unassuming Kronid Arkadyevich Lyubarsky drove Russia’s human rights movement for over 25 years. Despite being a prominent activist, he stayed quietly behind the scenes, opting instead to undermine USSR policies through factual, non-opinionated samizdat (Soviet literature) publications, his most famous being the Chronicle of Current Events. After graduating from Moscow University in 1956, Lyubarsky worked as an astrophysicist studying meteors and space biology at the AllUnion Institute of Scientific and Technical Information of the USSR Academy of Sciences, where he was involved in the Soviet programme of interplanetary exploration of Mars. The success of the Mars 2 space probe he read about inside his prison cell. Incensed by state censorship and the Soviet invasion of Czechoslovakia in 1968, Lyubarsky, like many scientists of his generation, joined the fight for human rights. On 14 January 1972, police raided his home, confiscating more than 600 documents, manuscripts and books. Throughout his closed trial Lyubarsky fought to defend his right to call himself a scientist – at one point the state threatened to revoke his degree – and to be allowed free access to the information he needed to fulfil his role as a scientist. In October 1972, sentenced to five years’ imprisonment, Lyubarsky was moved between Gulag labour camps and prisons in Mordovia and Vladimir Central Prison. His wife, Galina Salova, and their teenage daughter, Vika, lived 50 kilometres from Moscow, but “lived through the five long and hard years” with him, on the outside. When Salova visited him in prison she was proud, and relieved, to see “with [her] own eyes that there was not even a shadow of a soul break, and that even there Kronid was full of plans.” Where Lyubarsky had expected to meet “solid ranks of like-minded men in the camp, [he] found a large number of groupings of prisoners.” Camp administration actively sowed the seeds of suspicion to ensure the various groups’ continued segregation. A failed attempt to reveal prison conditions to the outside world helped him “realise that a common effort of all political and national groups was needed to overcome the internal disagreements ... The inmates were ready to unite and act jointly to confront their common enemy.” Lyubarsky’s goal was to unify the prisoners not only in his camp, but across the nation. He instituted the annual country-wide prison hunger strike in the 1970s, which Russia still celebrates annually on 30 October as ‘Political Prisoners’ Day.’ Released from the Gulag, Lyubarsky was exiled to Tarusa, near Moscow, where he remained under constant threat of re-arrest for his dissident activities. He helped manage a political prisoners’ aid fund set up by Alexander Solzhenitsyn, and was a member of the Soviet branch of Amnesty International. Eventually, he fled with his family to Munich, where he vigorously continued his human rights activities. During his 13 years in exile, he produced an abundance of publications, all made possible by brave, trusting contacts who smuggled to Munich information of Soviet human rights abuses. Lyubarsky established the bi-monthly Vesti iz SSSR (News from the USSR) printed in English and Russian, uniquely providing objective and comprehensive information about the human rights situation and resistance to the Communist regime, earning the Soviet political prisoners’ plight centre-stage in the Western human rights movement. Until the release of the last political prisoner in 1989, Vesti iz SSSR published the annual ‘List of Political Prisoners in the USSR,’ the go-to global reference for information about political prisoners in Soviet labour camps, prisons and mental hospitals. In 1984, as editor and publisher for Strana i mir (The Country and the World), Lyubarsky published works about international economic and political developments written by prominent Westerners, alongside reports of repression and conflict in the USSR. Boris Khazanov, one of the journal’s editors, explained that the paper was distributed, rather than sold: “We know that Strana i mir is kept in the special book repository of the Lenin Library, where it is read zealously by various people with access to the repository ... Our mailbox used to overflow with responses. We now receive even more material from the Soviet Union, as well as articles that have been written especially for our journal.” Born in Pskov, Russia, on 4 April 1934, Lyubarsky again became a Russian citizen in 1992. He rejoined his old dissident friends and was soon central in Russian politics. Boris Yeltsin trusted his advice, and Lyubarsky was one of the authors of the country’s new constitution, in which he focused strongly on citizens’ rights and freedom of choice. Concurrently, he edited a number of magazines and led the human rights organisation Moscow Helsinki Group. In February 1993, as the first deputy editor in chief of Novoye Vremya (New Times), his articles changed the personality of the magazine to one unafraid of speaking out against human suffering, political atrocities and the war in Chechnya. Novoye Vremya’s staff paid him tribute following his death: “Owing to his unblemished reputation, journalistic talent, encyclopaedic knowledge and polemical skill, each of his articles was an important event.” He had put so much of his heart into the fight for democracy and in defence of human rights that his heart eventually gave up while holidaying in Indonesia on 23 May 1996. He was 62. 83 savea sano malIfa SAMOA 1948– I n May 1998, after years of using physical threats and property damage in its fight against the Samoa Observer, the Samoan government took a new tack. Parliament granted top officials the right to use public money to file libel lawsuits against the media, leading to a barrage of claims against the Observer and its activist editor-in-chief Savea Sano Malifa. As was the case with the withdrawal of all government advertising two years earlier, the government funding of lawsuits was designed to bankrupt the Observer and prevent it from pursuing its investigations of government corruption. The lawsuits included a defamation case brought by Prime Minister Tofilau Eti Alesana in retaliation for a 1997 story claiming that public money was used to upgrade a hotel owned by his children. Together, the suits sought hundreds of thousands of dollars in damages and cost the paper just as much to fight. The prime minister was initially awarded a judgement of $125,000 (USD) before he died and the cases were thrown out. Another official withdrew his lawsuit without explanation. And a third official’s case is still pending despite the fact that he was jailed in 1999 for plotting the murder of another cabinet minister. “We did not break any of the laws for which we were sued,” Malifa said in a 2007 keynote address for UNESCO’s World Press Freedom Day. “... Those lawsuits were all acts of outright intimidation, as far as we’re concerned.” But the intimidation tactics were unsuccessful as Malifa never wavered in his mission to elimi- 84 nate corruption, increase government transparency and fight for press freedom in Samoa. Malifa, a poet, playwright and renowned novelist, studied engineering in Wellington, New Zealand, before he made the switch to journalism. He was living in the United States in the late 1970s when he got word that his mother was sick. He returned to Samoa, where he founded the weekly Samoa Observer in a cookhouse in a village near Apia in 1978. Together with his wife Jean he founded a second paper, the Sunday Samoan in 1987. The Observer ran into trouble with the government from the start as it rattled the establishment with investigative reporting of corruption that had previously been unheard of in Samoa. As a result of the paper’s reporting, Malifa and his family received numerous death threats. In 1994, the Observer’s printing plant was burned down in a fire. Later, it was discovered that the minister of women’s affairs, Leafa Vitale, had arranged for the arson in retaliation for a story the paper had run linking him to a scandal involving the sale of cattle. As a result of that story, Vitale threatened to kill Malifa and his family. Malifa was also assaulted by Vitale’s brothers. That same year, Malifa was awarded the Pacific Islands News Association’s Freedom of Information Award. “To practice serious journalism in Samoa during that time, one had to work one’s way carefully through a minefield of physical assaults; threats to kill; ‘suspicious’ arson; intimidation tactics such as refusing business licenses; bans .10,1948).¶2.THENAMEO NALDELAPRENSA,INSPA CH, GERMAN AND SPANIS THE RESOURCES OF THE IN INESSES, WHICH SUPPOR TOFANYMEMBERORINDIV AINING COURSES, ACADE EGATIONS AND MISSIONS NCE OF WOMEN AND MEN FOR THE INSTITUTE, AND T NSTITUTEISOPENTOPERS ONTHEINTERNET,WHOS LYANDBYWRITTENSTATE OUNTRIESWHERETHEREA ENROLTHEAPPLICANTS. ERTOINITIALLYDETERM ON AN INDIVIDUAL BASIS on government advertising; being followed at night as you drove down the street, and all the way to your home; defamation and criminal libel lawsuits,” Malifa said in the 2007 keynote address. “It was a time when the free press in Samoa was mangled underfoot at will by the mighty and the powerful.” Soon after the arson, the lawsuits began, bolstered by parliament’s decision to allow officials to use government funds for their legal fees. “It was clear then, that even parliament did not care what press freedom was, and whether it lived or died,” Malifa said. And yet, he persevered. In November 1998, Alesana died and Tuilaepa Sailele Malielegaoi took over as Samoan prime minister, ushering in an era of greater latitude for the press. Nonetheless, Malifa’s fight for press freedom continues. He is working to get the government to repeal the Printers and Publishers Act of 1992, which requires publishers and editors to reveal their sources to government officials who claim they have been defamed by the media, particularly newspapers. He views the law as a clear attempt to frighten sources from revealing information to the media, undermining freedom of information. He is also working to have the government abandon its policy of allowing public funds to be used for legal fees incurred by officials suing the media. “So what is press freedom?” Malifa asked rhetorically in his speech. “It is everyone’s freedom. It is the lifeblood of democracy; without it, democracy wilts and dies.” REE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AM AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD E ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWAR HE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARD HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAP AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG DINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATT PLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WIT THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO TH E ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION E PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLE EFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTAN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDIN REE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AM AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD E ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWAR HE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARD HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAP AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG DINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATT PLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WIT THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO TH E ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION E PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLE EFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTAN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDIN REE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AM AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD E ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWAR HE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARD HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAP AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG DINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATT PLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WIT THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO TH E ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION E PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLE EFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTAN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDIN REE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AM AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD E ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWAR HE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARD HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAP AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG DINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATT PLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WIT THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO TH E ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION E PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLE EFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTAN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDIN REE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AM AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD E ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWAR HE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARD HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAP AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG DINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATT PLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WIT THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO TH E ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION E PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLE Above: Savea Sano Malifa accepting the IPI World Press Freedom Hero award at the IPI World Congress in Boston, 2000. ENTALSTEPTOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONGPEOPLES ISTOBRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING FREEDOM OFTHE PRESS, BYWHICH ISMEANT WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES:OF ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF N VIEWS. ¶FREE • THE ACHIEVEMENT UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AN OFOF NEWSPAPERS, EXPRESSION OF VIEWS.OF ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEA WS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENTOF OFTHE THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS O ENTIAL THEYHAVEGOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, AFUNDAMENTALTHEREFORE, STEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDIN ER, ITTHAT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. A FUNDAME DANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE ANORGANISATION WORKTOWARDS FOLLOWINGOBJE ALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ISINESTABLISHED ACCORDANCE WITH THISTO BELIEF THEREFREE ISTHE ESTABLISHED A SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, EXPRESSION OF VIE OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRA MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF JOURNALISTS ACCURATE AND BALANCED AMONG NATIONS.¶ ••THE IMPROVEME UNDERSTANDING AMONGST AND SONEWS AMONG PEOPLES.¶ THE PROMOT PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEE TANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISH INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMO ARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OFF WITH THIS BELIEF THEREAND IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE NG AMONGST JOURNALISTS SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURA EANT: FREEON ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATI EACE DEPENDS UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ALISTS AND SOAMONG AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE ACC UNDERSTANDING PEOPLES ISTOBRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THEEXCHANGE JOURNALISTSOF OFTHE W RLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEO OLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISM UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISTOAND BRING ABOUT U RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS SO AMONG PEO HE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWE SHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶IS•TO TH OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, ANEWS, FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONGFREE PEOPLES BR S, FREE TRANSMISSION OF FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, EXPRES HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERA THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE ANDOF BALANCED AMO ANSMISSION OF NEWS,PEOPLES FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION VIEWS. ¶ • THENEWS ACHIEVEMEN NDING BETWEEN AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOT CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES O TANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURN RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, AOF FU WARDS THEFOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶•THAT THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANIS BLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OFPU U DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE OF ACCURATEAND AND NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OFAND THE ST JOURNALISTS SOBALANCED AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE B EOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD IN EPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTH UNDERSTANDING AMONG JOURNALISTS OF THEAMONG WORLD. ¶JOURNALISTS IN ACCORDANCE WIT RSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TOTHE BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING THE OF THE WORL FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOMOF PRESS, BYWHICH MEANT LOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OFTHE FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BYIS WHICH IS ME OF VIEWS. ¶ • THEACHIEVEMENT ACHIEVEMENT OFOF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONGAN PEO NRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ •OFTHE UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS HENATIONS.¶ IMPROVEMENT THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWE • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, ATHEY FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISPEA TO BR ER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAME HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERA ALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITHFREE THIS BELIEF THERE IS¶ESTABLISHED A ANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. • THE ACHIEVEMEN OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRA CHANGE OF ACCURATEAMONGST AND BALANCED NEWS AMONGAND NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF•THE O UNDERSTANDING JOURNALISTS SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ THEPRACTICES PROMOT RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FU PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ONTHERE UNDERSTANDING G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶AINFUNDAMENTAL ACCORDANCE WITH THIS TOWARDS BELIEF IS ESTABLISHED ANBETWEE ORGANIS INFORMATION. THEREFORE, STEP UNDERSTANDING AMO DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE WITH THIS BELIEF IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORKOF TOWARDS THEPU ST JOURNALISTS ANDTHERE SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE ACCURATE AND BF EANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATI EPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTH RSTANDING AMONG PEOPLESPEOPLES.¶ IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING JOURNALISTS OF THE ALISTS AND SO AMONG • THE PROMOTIONAMONG OF THETHE FREE EXCHANGE OFWORL ACC LOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THEON FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OFAND THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS ME RLD PEACE DEPENDS UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES PEOPLES. IF PEO RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEO UNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT U HE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWE SHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THEUNDERSTANDING FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶IS•TO TH OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, ANEWS, FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS AMONGFREE PEOPLES BR S, FREE TRANSMISSION OF FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, EXPRES HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERA THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE ANDOF BALANCED AMO ANSMISSION OF NEWS,PEOPLES FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION VIEWS. ¶ • THENEWS ACHIEVEMEN NDING BETWEEN AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOT CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES O TANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISITTO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURN RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FU WARDS THEFOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶•THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶FREE IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANIS BLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF U DOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PU OF ACCURATEAND AND NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OFAND THE ST JOURNALISTS SOBALANCED AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE B EPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES ANDPEOPLES. IFPEOPLESARE TOUNDERSTAND ONE ANOTH EOPLES ARE TOUNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, ITISESSENTIAL THAT THEYHAVE GOOD IN RSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TOTHE BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE OF THE WORL UNDERSTANDING AMONG JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶JOURNALISTS IN ACCORDANCE WIT LOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS ME FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OFFREEDOMAMONGST OFTHEPRESS, BYWHICH IS MEANT RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEO N OF VIEWS. ¶ •OFTHE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AN HE IMPROVEMENT THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWE NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, ATHEY FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISPEA TO BR ER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAME HERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERA ALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITHFREE THIS BELIEF THERE IS¶ESTABLISHED A ANSMISSION OFOF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. • THE ACHIEVEMEN OF FREEDOM THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRA CHANGE OF ACCURATEAMONGST AND BALANCED NEWS AMONGAND NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF•THE O UNDERSTANDING JOURNALISTS SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ THEPRACTICES PROMOT RE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FU PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ONTHERE UNDERSTANDING G THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF IS ESTABLISHED ANBETWEE ORGANIS INFORMATION. A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMO DOM OF THE PRESS, THEREFORE, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PU Above: Veran Matić announces B92 is resuming work under the new name, B2-92, and from a new office, four months after the government forcefully took over the original station in Belgrade on 2 August 1999. Below: Matić speaking about press freedom at a conference. Right: Matić at work on the airwaves. Veran matIć SERBIA 1962– I n March 1989, a group of young journalists and journalism students from Radio Beograd 202’s student programme, Indeks 202, and Studio B’s youth programme, Rítam srca, met to establish a new radio station in Belgrade – B92, which began broadcasting on 15 May 1989. Radio journalist Veran Matić, with Rítam Srca when he helped establish Radio B92, became the station’s editor in chief almost immediately. And just as the new station would quickly make its mark on Belgrade, so would Matić. In the beginning, Radio B92 was predominantly youth-oriented but with strong critical voices about the political developments in Serbia and the Socialist Federal Republic of Yugoslavia. It was a time when nationalism in Serbia was growing every day, and within a few months of its founding, B92 became one of the most important voices for democratic and anti-nationalist developments in Serbia. But there was one problem: B92 could only be heard in certain parts of the city. The fact that the signal was weak, however, also aided B92’s survival. It was assumed that as long as the station was small, authorities wouldn’t bother with it. Besides, Serbian president Slobodan Milošević and his regime were more than happy to use B92’s existence to show the world that they were accepting of alternative and critical voices. Nevertheless, B92 had a strong influence on the forming of public opinion. It became especially popular during the first big anti-Milošević demonstration in Belgrade in March 1991, when all other electronic media was under state control. While B92 was reporting the events of 9 March, including police violence against demonstrators, the state media only reported on a “small group of several hundred persons that were demonstrating.” During this first big public expression against Milošević, people in Belgrade began speaking about B92 and ‘crazy Veran,’ chief of the station. Matić, born in 1962, fought for press freedom and democracy from the very start. He was always unconventional; often he would be seen in the office with a bottle of beer. But he was always professional. Engaged in journalism since 1984 when he started to cooperate with alternative and youth media in Belgrade, Zagreb and Ljubljana, Matić, with his critical voice, was being observed by state security even before B92 was founded. It began in 1987 when Matić’s neighbours had a visit from authorities, asking questions about that “strange Matić,” the journalist recalls. When the war in former Yugoslavia began, Matić publicly supported anti-war activities and fought against nationalism. B92 became a strong anti-regime voice, but always upheld professional standards. Fighters for democratic developments in Serbia regularly met in the newsroom, where it was possible to speak openly on-air about the regime’s war crimes and criminal activities. By maintaining a very strong factual news programme amid the virulence of propaganda and war mongering of the state-owned broadcaster RTS, B92 had positioned itself firmly in the heart of the anti-war scene in Belgrade. In the Nineties, it became a hub for foreign journalists visiting Serbia. The station was an important and trusted source during a period in which getting independent and non-propagandist information in south eastern Europe was difficult. B92 was banned several times, but managed to continue broadcasting until it was taken over by the Milošević regime in 1999, during the NATO air strikes against former Yugoslavia. During this period, Matić was briefly detained by police. After the regime’s illegal take-over of B92, Matić and all employees of the radio station refused to co-operate with the new management and were fired. But that didn’t stop Matić. He took to the Internet, creating the FreeB92 website that subsequently led to Radio B2-92, broadcasting in Belgrade at 99.1 MHz. The website and FreeB92 were important elements in supporting democratic development and political changes in Serbia. “The biggest of all problems, besides being banned and technically disabled, was the state of war and military censorship,” Matić said in an interview with JURIST: The Law Professors’ Network. “Possibilities of working under military censorship is a big topic and insufficiently spoken about. Anyway, we somehow managed to work even under such conditions. At least in a way that hate speech was never used.” During B92’s first 10 years, Matić was often described by Milošević-controlled media as a spy, a criminal or anti-Serb. He was repeatedly accused of ‘selling Serbia’ or ‘working for NATO’ by the media and members of the Serbian Parliament. In 2000, in order to overcome the banning of B92 in Belgrade and with assistance from partners from Romania and Bosnia and Herzegovina, Matić launched a network that would cover the largest part of Serbia: Television B92, first broadcast via satellite and through regional networks. After the democratic changes in October 2000 in Serbia, Radio and Television B92 continued to develop its independent professional journalism. With Matić always at the helm. Independent of his power as editor in chief, and later also chief executive and co-owner of B92, Matić was unobtrusive and open to new ideas at all times, something that helped many young journalists in learning the profession. He developed B92 as a socially responsible media company by initiating a series of humanitarian and socially-relevant campaigns, such as the creation of safe houses for the victims of family violence, campaigning for breast cancer prevention or holding voluntary blood donations. He also supported minorities and diversity in society. Over the years the ‘weak’ B92 has become a strong company. It now runs two TV channels (TV B92, founded in September 2000, and B92 Info, launched in 2008); B92.net web (which began in 1995 as OpenNet) and a film and video division. It also has its own record label, a book publishing arm called Samizdat B92 and the Rex Culture Centre. 87 adam mIChnIK POLAND 1946– e ditor-in-chief of Gazeta Wyborcza (Electoral Gazette) since the newspaper’s launch in spring 1989, Adam Michnik is an historian by education, a commentator and essayist by nature, and a politician and human rights activist by temperament. During the Communist era, he spent a total of six years in prison for his political activities. Starting out as a student activist of the 1968 generation, he became an adviser in the first nonCommunist party-controlled trade union, Solidarity, and during the period of martial law, he served as one of Solidarity founder Lech Wałęsa’s closest aides. Michnik was born 17 October 1946 in Warsaw. In 1965, he became one of the leading figures in the fledgling Polish democratic opposition movement, with a secular and leftist tinge. In March 1968, at the very outset of the anti-Semitic and anti-intelligentsia campaign orchestrated by the Communist party, he was expelled from Warsaw University, triggering a series of strikes and student riots. As a result of the socalled ‘March events,’ he spent over a year in prison. In 1970, after earning a degree in history from Poznań University, he worked for more than a year on the assembly line at the Róża Luksemburg factory in Warsaw. There he co-founded the Workers’ Defence Committee (KOR), a structure aimed at building social ties and supporting workers who were persecuted after the July 1976 strikes and riots. KOR gave rise to a number of other independent initiatives, including the NOWA Independent Publishing House, an underground publishing operation co-founded by Michnik that reintroduced Polish readers to authors who had been banned by the communists. Another initiative was the ‘Flying University,’ a series of independent lectures and seminars on subjects such as literature and recent history, which took place in private homes, often bru- 88 tally interrupted by the political police. Michnik was among the regular lecturers. Imprisoned under martial law, Michnik was later arrested on charges of attempting to overthrow the political system by force (a charge carrying the maximum sentence of death). He was offered freedom and the possibility to emigrate to the West – in return for discontinuing his political activism – but he declined the offer and convinced other imprisoned Solidarity activists to do the same. He was imprisoned from 19811984 and again from 1985-1986. Each time, he was released under an amnesty. During the Polish Roundtable Talks, Michnik was one of the key architects of the agreement between the government and opposition groups. And following the 1989 elections, he became a member of Poland’s first non-Communist parliament after the Second World War. He published, among other things, the editorial “Your President – Our Prime Minister!” in Gazeta Wyborcza, which opened the way for Tadeusz Mazowiecki to become Poland’s first non-Communist head of government in post-war history. Gazeta Wyborcza, initially a daily newspaper launched to support Solidarity candidates in the June 1989 elections, became the first free newspaper ‘between the Elbe and Vladivostok.’ It was created as a result of the Roundtable Talks but was never an official Solidarity organ. Over the next year or so, despite pressure from the trade union and non-Communist MPs, as well as Lech Wałęsa himself, the paper successfully defended its independence. Michnik declared then that Gazeta – though proud of its dissident lineage, from the times of the KOR and martial law-era underground Solidarity – would operate on its own account and responsibility, for the independence and freedom of democratic Poland, rather than representing the interests of any political party or union organisation. He also stressed that, whilst he gladly took the blame for REE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS.O ¶• .10, 1948). ¶ 2. THE NAME AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF E ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION NAL DE LA PRENSA, IN HE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE ISSPA ESTABLIS HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION CH, AND SPANIS AMONGGERMAN PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF DINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERST PLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDINGOF AMONGTHE THE JOURNAL THE RESOURCES IN THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRES E ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AN INESSES, WHICH SUPPOR E PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER EFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON TOF ANY MEMBER OR INDIV ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES REE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF AINING COURSES, ACADE E ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION HE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLIS EGATIONS AND MISSIONS HICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF NCE OF WOMEN AND MEN DINGBETWEEN PEOPLES ANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLES ARETO UNDERST PLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNAL THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRES FOR THE INSTITUTE, AND T E ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AN E PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER NSTITUTE IS OPEN TO PERS EFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES ON THE INTERNET, WHO REE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS.S ¶• AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF ANOTHER, IT ISBY ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOODSTATE INFORMATION LYHEEHICH AND WRITTEN WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLIS IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSIONA OUNTRIES WHERE THERE AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF DINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERST ENROL THE APPLICANTS. PLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNAL THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRES EER ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AN TO INITIALLY DETERM E PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER EFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON ON AN INDIVIDUAL BASIS the paper’s mistakes and failures, its success was an effect of the hard work of its entire team. Soon Gazeta Wyborcza – today with many supplements, a colour reportage magazine and a weekly women’s magazine – became one of the most influential media outlets in Europe, and it is now the largest quality newspaper in Poland (second to only one tabloid in terms of circulation). Its publisher, the multimedia group Agora, created by people active in the pre-1989 democratic opposition movement, is one of Poland’s largest companies. Michnik has written hundreds of essays and many books, translated into dozens of languages. Undoubtedly, two of the most important are “The Church and the Left,” published in the late1970s, which opened the secular anti-communist opposition circles to cooperate with the Catholic Church; and “Letters from Prison and Other Essays,” a collection written in and smuggled out of communist prisons, one of the key readings of the martial law era explaining the need for talks and compromise. Privately, Michnik is the proud father of son Antek as well as a book lover, a raconteur, the life and soul of every party, until recently a keen – though bad – dancer and a connoisseur of fine liquor, though not someone to spurn simple whisky. The owner of hundreds of jokes, it was in the context of Michnik’s anecdotes that Pope John Paul II reportedly said he would be the first pope in history to die of laughter. Once during a 1990 meeting with intellectuals in Castel Gandolfo, John Paul II, deeply worried, posed the question: “Gentlemen, what will be with Poland now?” Those present pondered the question with the pope. Only Michnik replied: “It will be well, Holy Father, it will be well.” Written by Pawel Smolenski, staff reporter at Gazeta Wyborcza. Above: Adam Michnik in 1989. Below: portrait of Michnik while attending University of Warsaw. ENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTAND IONOFHUMAN RIGHTS, (DEC.10, 1948).¶2.THENA NCH;INSTITUTO INTERNACIONAL DELAPRENSA, WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING O UTE SHALL BE ENGLISH, FRENCH, GERMAN AND S fred s OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION Q. OF THE SWISS CIVIL CODE. THE RESOURCES OFO m’memBe THER INSTITUTIONS AND BUSINESSES, WHICH SU WS AMONG THEMEMBER IMPROV SHALL ENURETONATIONS.¶ THEBENEFITOF•ANY OR XCHANGE PROGRAMMES, TRAINING COURSES, A ENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFO ERNET, THE SENDING OF DELEGATIONS AND MISS DANCE WITH BELIEF THERE IS ES HALL PROMOTE ATHIS FAIR BALANCE OF WOMEN AN LITY, LEGAL OR OTHERWISE, FOR THE INSTITUTE, SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSIO 1.FULLMEMBERSHIPOFTHEINSTITUTEISOPENTO MOTION OF THE FREE OF BROADCASTING SYSTEMS OREXCHANGE ONTHEINTERNET, W MBERSHIP, DECLARE FORMALLY AND BY WRITTEN PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERST ACQUIREDASFOLLOWS:INCOUNTRIESWHERET ERMINEWHETHER ORNOT TOENROL THEAPPLIC TANDING AMONG THE JOURNALIST O ALONE SHALL HAVE THE POWER TO INITIALLY DE ARDING OF FREEDOM OFAN THE PRESS, D. ¶ 3. MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE ON INDIVIDUAL OR RADIO BROADCASTING SYSTEM OR AN INTERN NG AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO RE THAN ONE FULL MEMBER UP TO A LIMIT OF TEN DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDIN FEACE CO-OPERATING INTHE INSTITUTE’S OBJECTIVES SANDADVISORS.¶·ASAFFILIATE MEMBERS (LEA UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES MAGAZINES, BROADCASTING OR NEWS AGENCIE OLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURT NTERS,PERSONS HOLDINGSIMILAR EDITORIAL PO OURNAL, RADIO, TV ORGANISATION OR NEWS AG RESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM TEN APPROVAL FROM THEIR EDITOR-IN-CHIEF. ¶ 6 ALLIMPROVEMENT BE MADE TO THE NATIONAL COMMITTEE, WHI HE OF THE PRACTICES AL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS FOR MEMBERSHI OOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, S.INALL CASES,ENROLMENTS ARESUBJECTA TOFU T UT THEYISSHALL HAVE NO VOTING RIGHTS. THE DU HERE ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISA SSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP. ¶ IPI CONSTITUTION PAG ANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLIC OF UNIVERSITIES AND COLLEGES, SCHOOLS AND MAYPARTICIPATE INALLTHEINSTITUTE’S ACTIV CHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALAN ZAMBIA 1959– Above: Fred M’membe, also pictured below, and Lucy Sichone leave the High Court after a contempt case hearing, 1998. Above: M’membe holds a photocopy of a page from his newspaper, The Post. Below: M’membe leaving court on 4 June 2010 after being sentenced to four months hard labour. ince the launch of Zambia’s biggest selling newspaper, The Post, on 26 July 1991, every government that has come to power has either arrested or abused Fred M’membe. Armed with nothing but a pen, M’membe has had to bear the harassment of politicians who believe any criticism or challenge should remain taboo. Throughout The Post’s existence, Zambian politicians have used the police as their attack dogs in an operation to remove and intimidate M’membe. Throughout this campaign, the editor has witnessed police raids of not only The Post’s offices but also his own home and the homes of his staff. In addition, politicians have been peddling unfounded rumours that he intends to run for president. “We live in a society that is intolerant. When you differ with a dominant clan they will banish you … We have faced high levels of intolerance from those who do not want to be challenged. They wanted to abuse and misapply the resources of the country without being questioned,” M’membe told a fellow colleague in April 2010 on behalf of the International Press Institute. This intolerance has led to his imprisonment on various charges. “I have been detained by Parliament abusing the powers which they did not have. There is no regime that has not arrested or abused us,” says M’membe, adding that he is not intimidated or discouraged as he knew that “paving a road where there was previously a stop sign” would not be an easy task. “We had chosen to publish news in the conditions we were living in. Our goal was to advance democratic governance in our country, to create a much more fair and humane society. Without press freedom you cannot defend freedom of expression. Without freedom of expression there cannot be democratic governance. That is why press freedom is being defended in the U.S., in Europe and elsewhere. What’s more, for our society, the challenge becomes bigger.” Former Zambian President Frederick Chiluba pursued The Post with all his energy, but things turned against Chiluba when The Post called him a thief in 2001. “For all our deficiencies, we have made people speak out. People are still able to speak. We exposed the corruption of Chiluba and helped in his prosecution to secure a favourable judgment, which orders that he pays back what he stole. There are a number of top civil servants and top military officers who have been convicted of corruption,” said M’membe. He adds: “There is nothing that sets me apart from the others; I am just one of them. I have fought alongside others. I have learnt from others and they have learnt from me. Together we have struggled and together we will struggle, and together we will continue to improve. I am just part of the global army.” M’membe has not withered in the face of persecution; he has defended freedom of the press with all his energy. He is always ready to compromise, but not at the expense of press freedom and freedom of expression. “It appeared like an exercise that would end tomorrow, but now we have to fight for press freedom for the rest of our lives,” he says. M’membe leads a very busy life, and in the early years of the newspaper, he would get home very late to find his children sleeping on his bed, having fallen fast asleep waiting for his return. When the British-born columnist of The Post, Roy Clarke, was deported on charges of insulting the late-president Levy Mwanawasa, by calling him ‘muwelele’ (foolish elephant), M’membe reprinted the satire under his own name to share the responsibility. When a magistrate cited M’membe for contempt during the ‘pornography trial’ of the paper’s news editor, Chansa Kabwela, the former chairman of the International Press Institute and Guardian editor Peter Preston described M’membe as a hero in a mad world. “Fred M’membe, editor of the Zambia Post, is one of my heroes – utterly straight, utterly fearless, and utterly up to his neck in trouble again,” Preston wrote in his column. “A professor at Cornell University wrote an article criticising the minister. The journalist (M’membe) was promptly charged with distributing material that could corrupt public morals … Fred has been charged with contempt of court and M’membe could be sent to prison for six months. You couldn’t make it up. But that’s Fred, a rock-solid citizen in an utterly mad world.” Although he never sought acclaim, M’membe has found himself recognised as a fighter for press freedom and freedom of expression. Aside from being named a World Press Freedom Hero by the International Press Institute, he is also the recipient of freedom awards from the Media Institute of Southern Africa (MISA) and the Committee for the Protection of Journalists. In 1995, he was named International Editor of the Year for Entrepreneurship by the World Press Review for his “courage and leadership in advancing press freedom and human rights.” He also received the Pringle Media Award from the South African Union of Journalists and the Percy Qoboza Foreign Journalist Award from the U.S.-based National Association of Black Journalists. Written by Sam Mujuda, deputy managing director, The Post newspaper in Zambia. 91 INdro montanellI ITALY 1909–2001 I f there were one word to describe Indro Montanelli it would be “independent” – and fiercely so. Incurring the wrath of fascists, Nazis and leftist extremists, Montanelli, arguably Italy’s most famous journalist, refused to bow down to pressures from either the right or left of the Italian political establishment, taking great pride in being controcorrente – always swimming against the current. Born in Fucecchio, Tuscany, on 22 April 1909, Montanelli studied law at the University of Florence before starting his career with newspaper L’Universale, which was founded by the GUF, the student wing of the National Fascist Party (PNF). He later moved on to Paris Soir in France and the United Press news agency in New York, where he developed a distinctive, uncomplicated style, in stark contrast to his Italian contemporaries, who preferred a more verbose, long-winded style of writing. In his youth, Montanelli had been a supporter of the early anti-establishment ideals of fascism, but this initial enthusiasm began to wane following Italian leader Benito Mussolini’s clampdown on the press in 1935 – including L’Universale – for questioning the nature of fascism. In 1936, when Mussolini launched the campaign in Abyssinia (modern day Ethiopia), Montanelli left his post at United Press and enlisted as a volunteer, but the colonial campaign left Montanelli further disillusioned with the fascist movement. On his return from Abyssinia, Montanelli became a war correspondent for Il Messaggero, reporting from the Spanish Civil War. Refusing to toe the fascist propaganda line, his objective reporting of the war earned him expulsion from the Italian journalists’ union as well as from the fascist party in 1937. Exiled from Italy, Montanelli was sent to report from all over Europe by Corriere della Sera for his own safety. His reporting took him to Estonia, Finland, Norway, Albania and Greece, earning him a reputation for honest and independent reporting. His unflattering reports in 92 Italy on Mussolini and his mistress, Clara Petacci, led to his arrest by the Gestapo, and in 1944 he was sentenced to death as a traitor. He luckily avoided his death sentence with the help of the archbishop of Milan, Cardinal Ildefonso Schuster, and escaped to Switzerland, where he stayed until the end of the war. After the Second World War, Montanelli returned to Corriere della Sera as a columnist and built a reputation as one of Italy’s most-respected, though controversial journalists. He reported from various European countries and was one of the first correspondents in Budapest during the Hungarian revolution in 1956. In 1974, Montanelli left Corriere della Sera, after refusing to follow the leftist editorial line set by the new owners. Montanelli, along with several other former Corriere writers, founded a new conservative newspaper – aptly named Il Giornale Nuovo (The New Newspaper), later known simply as Il Giornale – with Montanelli as its editor. Montanelli’s conservative, anti-communist line gained him not only a readership, but also the ire of the extremist left. On his way to the paper’s offices in Milan on 2 June 1977, Montanelli was shot four times in the legs by members of the revolutionist radical Red Brigades movement. Undaunted, he returned to his position as editor in chief of Il Giornale, launching a campaign against terrorism. “If [the terrorists] think I am going to shut up, they are very mistaken,” he said at the time. “There is no one at the paper who would give in to these tactics.” Montanelli continued to challenge political and media establishment throughout his career and well into old age. In 1994, he left Il Giornale after then-proprietor Silvio Berlusconi moved into politics against Montanelli’s advice and wishes, moving on to set up yet another paper, La Voce (The Voice). At the time, Montanelli said: “Without my knowledge he came into the newsroom and said everything must now be changed because now the newspaper must be put at his service.” EC.10,1948).¶ IONALDELAP ENCH, GERMA DE. THE RESOU BUSINESSES, W EFITOFANYME , TRAINING CO ELEGATIONS A Although not as successful as his previous newspaper – La Voce closed after just one year due to financial difficulties – the paper maintained a hard line against Montanelli’s former friend, a line he maintained even when many of his former colleagues had firmly backed the media mogul. Author of more than 60 books, mostly on Italian history, the tall, slim Italian – noted by those who knew him as gruff and grumpy – was eventually persuaded to return to Corriere della Sera, which was considered by some as his natural journalistic home. The now elderly Montanelli continued to write, answering readers’ letters on a wide range of topics. However, unsurprising given his conservative nature, he never owned a computer, preferring his old typewriter, and shunned the Internet, admitting in an interview with the UK’s Financial Times that he did “not know how to adapt.” Ever the relentless critic, at age 92 he wrote a number of editorials criticising Berlusconi ahead of the 2001 elections, less than five months before his death. Montanelli passed away following a short illness on 22 July 2001. Corriere della Sera carried his obituary on the front page and even his longtime nemesis Berlusconi declared: “With Indro Montanelli a witness of the century disappears … I weep for the friend with whom I have shared many battles and to whom I was bound even when he expressed dissent at my positions, with the spirit of freedom that has always animated his work and I have always respected.” ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THE E AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRA F UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCH URNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE T ENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE O WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA EWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS O SSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTAND CORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWIN REE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESS .¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IM OPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODIN ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THE E AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRA F UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCH URNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE T ENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE O WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA EWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS O SSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTAND CORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWIN REE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESS .¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IM OPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODIN ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THE E AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRA F UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCH URNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE T ENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE O WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA EWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS O SSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTAND CORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWIN REE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESS .¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IM OPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODIN ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THE E AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRA F UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCH URNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE T ENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE O WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA EWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS O SSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTAND CORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWIN REE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESS .¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IM OPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODIN ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THE E AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRA F UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCH URNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE T ENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE O WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNA EWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS O SSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTAND CORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWIN REE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESS Above and left: Indro Montanelli after he was shot four times in his legs by members of the revolutionist radical Red Brigades movement on 2 June 1977. NACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTH REE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRA NIZAR THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCH NAYOUF PLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETO T UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOU D SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF T I ERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALIST ¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDER OWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONG DSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶• FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE P Y HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THERE S BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN O S, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FR E FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AN PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE G AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF TH G OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WH AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A NCH;INSTITUTOINTERNACIONALDELAPRENSA,INSPANISH;INTERNATIONALESPRESSEINSTITUT,INGERMAN;HEREINAFTERREFERR UTE SHALL BE ENGLISH, FRENCH, GERMAN AND SPANISH; THE WORKING LANGUAGE SHALL BE ENGLISH. ¶ 4. THE INSTITUTE IS A NONEQ. OF THE SWISS CIVIL CODE. THE RESOURCES OF THE INSTITUTE ARE DERIVED FROM MEMBERSHIP DUES, CONTRIBUTIONS FROM NEW THER INSTITUTIONS AND BUSINESSES, WHICH SUPPORT THE PRINCIPLES OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS AND FREEDOM OF EXPRESSION A SHALLENURETOTHEBENEFITOFANYMEMBERORINDIVIDUAL.¶5.THEGOALSOFTHEINSTITUTE,ASDESCRIBEDINTHEPREAMBLE,MAY XCHANGE PROGRAMMES, TRAINING COURSES, ACADEMIC LECTURES TV AND RADIO BROADCAST MATERIAL WHICH CAN BE IN THE FO ERNET, THE SENDING OF DELEGATIONS AND MISSIONS TO COUNTRIES AND GOVERNMENTS, AND COLLABORATION WITH OTHER ORGA HALL PROMOTE A FAIR BALANCE OF WOMEN AND MEN IN ITS STRUCTURES AND IN ITS ACTIVITIES. ¶ IPI CONSTITUTION PAGE 2 ¶ 7. NO LITY, LEGAL OR OTHERWISE, FOR THE INSTITUTE, AND THE INSTITUTE ASSUMES NO LIABILITY, LEGAL OR OTHERWISE, FOR ANY INDIVID 1.FULLMEMBERSHIPOFTHEINSTITUTEISOPENTOPERSONSWITHRESPONSIBILITIESFOREDITORIALORNEWSPOLICYINNEWSPAPERS BROADCASTINGSYSTEMSORONTHEINTERNET,WHOSUPPORTTHEPRINCIPLEOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESSANDDESIRETOCO-OPERATEI MBERSHIP,DECLAREFORMALLYANDBYWRITTENSTATEMENTTHEIRWILLINGNESSTOWORKFORTHEACHIEVEMENTOFPRESSFREEDOM ACQUIREDASFOLLOWS:INCOUNTRIESWHERETHEREARENATIONALCOMMITTEES,APPLICATIONSSHALLBEMADETOTHENATIONAL ERMINEWHETHERORNOTTOENROLTHEAPPLICANTS.INCOUNTRIESWHERETHEREARENONATIONALCOMMITTEES,APPLICATIONSF OALONESHALLHAVETHEPOWERTOINITIALLYDETERMINEWHETHERORNOTTOENROLTHEAPPLICANTS.INALLCASES,ENROLMENTSA D. ¶ 3. MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE ON AN INDIVIDUAL BASIS. HOWEVER, IF A NATIONAL COMMITTEE SO DECIDES MEMBERSHIP MAY ALSO BE OR RADIO BROADCASTING SYSTEM OR AN INTERNET SERVICE. ¶ 4. A NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NEWS AGENCY, TV OR RADIO BROADCAS RE THAN ONE FULL MEMBER UP TO A LIMIT OF TEN. ¶ 5. THERE SHALL BE ELIGIBLE AS ASSOCIATE MEMBERS INDIVIDUALS WHO ARE DEV FCO-OPERATINGINTHEINSTITUTE’SOBJECTIVES,FOREXAMPLE,THESEMAYINCLUDE:¶·ASASSOCIATEMEMBERS:EXECUTIVESOFME SANDADVISORS.¶·ASAFFILIATEMEMBERS(LEADINGJOURNALISTSGROUP):PERSONSOPERATINGINJOURNALISTICCATEGORIESFO MAGAZINES, BROADCASTING OR NEWS AGENCIES, EDITORIAL WRITERS, COPY EDITORS, BUREAU CHIEFS, CORRESPONDENTS, TV AND NTERS,PERSONSHOLDINGSIMILAREDITORIALPOSITIONSONINTERNETSERVICES.¶THENUMBEROFASSOCIATEANDAFFILIATEMEMBE OURNAL, RADIO, TV ORGANISATION OR NEWS AGENCY IS NOT LIMITED. AFFILIATE MEMBERSHIP (LEADING JOURNALISTS GROUP) SH TEN APPROVAL FROM THEIR EDITOR-IN-CHIEF. ¶ 6. ASSOCIATE AND AFFILIATE MEMBERSHIP CAN BE ACQUIRED AS FOLLOWS. IN COUNT Clockwise from left: Drawing by ALL BE MADE TO THE NATIONAL COMMITTEE, WHICH ALONE SHALL HAVE THE POWER TO INITIALLY DETERMINE WHETHER OR NOT TO EN Nizar Nayouf while in the SydALCOMMITTEES,APPLICATIONSFORMEMBERSHIPSHALL BEMADETOTHEINSTITUTE’SDIRECTOR,WHOALONESHALLHAVETHEPOWER naya Military Prison, Damascus, S.INALLCASES,ENROLMENTSARESUBJECTTOTHEULTIMATE AUTHORITYOFTHEEXECUTIVEBOARD.¶7.ASSOCIATEANDAFFILIATEM dated 2 January 2001; Nayouf UT THEY SHALL HAVE NO VOTING RIGHTS. THE DUES FOR ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE HALF THE DUES FOR FULL MEMBERSHIP. T on the first day of his release, 6 SSOCIATEMEMBERSHIP.¶IPICONSTITUTIONPAGE3¶May 8.2001, INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERSHIPSHALLBEOPENUNDERTHECONDITIONSOFARTI together with his OF UNIVERSITIES AND COLLEGES, SCHOOLS AND CENTRES OF JOURNALISM, PRESS INSTITUTES AND JOURNALISTS’ ORGANISATIONS youngest brother Hayyan; Nizar MAYPARTICIPATEINALLTHEINSTITUTE’SACTIVITIES. THEDIRECTORSHALLHAVEPOWERTOENROLINSTITUTIONALMEMBERSSUBJEC Nayouf arriving in the Royan BEROFTHEIRDELEGATESISNOTLIMITED.DUESFORINSTITUTIONAL Station, near Bordeaux, south-MEMBERSSHALLBEFIXEDBYTHEDIRECTORINACCORDANCEWITH SSHALLHAVENOVOTINGRIGHTS.¶9.INSOFARASASSOCIATE ARECONCERNED,DUESFORCERTAINCATEGORIESOFTHESEM western France, JulyMEMBERS 2001. DIRECTOR WITH THE AGREEMENT OF THE BOARD. ¶ 10. THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL HAVE POWER TO SUSPEND OR EXPEL ANY MEMBE SETOUTINTHEPRESENTCONSTITUTION.SUSPENSIONOFAMEMBERMAYBEORDEREDBYAMAJORITYVOTEOFTHEMEMBERSPRESEN ED EXCEPT ON THE APPROVAL OF TWO-THIRDS OF THE MEMBERS PRESENT OF THE BOARD. ¶ 11. WRITTEN NOTICE OF THE CONSIDERAT GED CAUSES, SHALL BE GIVEN TO THE MEMBER CONCERNED SIXTY (60) DAYS PREVIOUS TO THE MEETING OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD AN THATMEMBERSHALLSODESIRE.ANYMEMBERSOORDEREDSUSPENDEDOREXPELLEDBYTHEEXECUTIVEBOARDSHALLHAVETHERIGH JORITY VOTE OF MEMBERS PRESENT SHALL BE RECOGNISED AS THE FINAL DECISION OF THE INSTITUTE. ¶ 12. ANY MEMBER SHALL BE FR NSHALLBEGIVENEITHERTOTHENATIONALCOMMITTEEORTOTHEDIRECTOR.¶13.ANYMEMBERRESIGNINGOREXPELLEDSHALLBEBOU METHATMEMBER’SRESIGNATIONOREXPULSIONBECOMESEFFECTIVE.¶14.MEMBERSHIPSHOULDBECANCELLEDINCASESWHERETH GEINTHECONDITIONSUNDERWHICHMEMBERSHIPHASBEENGRANTEDANDWHERETHESECHANGESAREINCONTRADICTIONTOTHE II¶NATIONALCOMMITTEES¶1A)SUBJECTTORECOGNITIONBYTHEEXECUTIVEBOARDANDCONSEQUENTLYTORATIFICATIONBYTHENE OVISIONALLYINACOUNTRYWHERETHEREAREATLEASTFIVEFULLMEMBERSFORMALLYCOMMITTEDTOTHEPRINCIPLESOFTHEPRES OARD SHALL NOT NECESSARILY IMPLY THAT THE EXECUTIVE BOARD ALSO RECOGNISES THAT THE COUNTRY IN WHICH THE NATIONAL C ONALCOMMITTEESSHALLACTIVELYPURSUETHEAIMSOFTHEINSTITUTEINTHEIRCOUNTRIES,RECRUITMEMBERSANDMAYREPORTT TICULARLYONTHREATSTOFREEDOMOFTHEPRESSORTOTHEFREEFLOWOFNEWS.ATTHEREQUESTOFTHENATIONALCOMMITTEE,TH IONALCOMMITTEESMAYBEENTRUSTEDWITHADMINISTRATIVETASKSSUCHASTHECOLLECTINGOFMEMBERSHIPDUES.THEYMAYEM ITH THE APPROVAL OF THE SECRETARIAT. FUND-RAISING ACTIVITIES SHOULD BE COORDINATED WITH THE IPI DIRECTOR. AN ANNUAL A ONPAGE4¶4.THEEXECUTIVEBOARDSHALLHAVEPOWERTODECLAREANATIONALCOMMITTEEINACTIVEORSUSPENDRECOGNITIONOF NSIDERSTHEOBJECTIVESOFPARAGRAPH2OR3ABOVEHAVENOTBEENFULFILLEDORTHEREISAFUNDAMENTALCHANGEINTHECONDIT ITTEEHASBEENGRANTED.¶DECLARATIONOFANATIONALCOMMITTEE’SINACTIVITYORSUSPENSIONOFANATIONALCOMMITTEEMAY RDPRESENT.WRITTENNOTICETHATSUCHACTIONWILLBECONSIDEREDBYTHEEXECUTIVEBOARD,WITHASTATEMENTOFTHEREASO COMMITTEE CONCERNED SIXTY (60) DAYS BEFORE THE MEETING OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. THE NATIONAL COMMITTEE SHALL HAVE T HERINWRITINGORBYTHEPERSONALAPPEARANCEOFAMEMBERORMEMBERSOFTHENATIONALCOMMITTEEATTHEEXECUTIVEBOA RESENTATIONS.¶ANATIONALCOMMITTEEFROMWHICHRECOGNITIONHASBEENORDEREDTOBESUSPENDEDBYTHEEXECUTIVEBOA HALLHAVETHERIGHTTOAPPEALTOTHENEXTGENERALASSEMBLY,INWHICHCASEAMAJORITYVOTEOFMEMBERSPRESENTSHALLBE HAT THE EXECUTIVE BOARD MAY AT ANY TIME RESTORE RECOGNITION TO A NATIONAL COMMITTEE. ¶ NOTWITHSTANDING THE PROVIS ITTEE OR THE DECISION OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD TO CONSIDER A NATIONAL COMMITTEE INACTIVE SHALL NOT AFFECT THE RIGHT OF T COUNTRY TO CONTINUE AS MEMBERS OF THE INSTITUTE AND TO PARTICIPATE FULLY IN ITS AFFAIRS. ¶ WHERE THE EXECUTIVE BOARD ANATIONALCOMMITTEEINACTIVE,THETASKSFORMERLYEXECUTEDBYTHISCOMMITTEEWILLBEPERFORMEDBYTHEDIRECTOR.¶NAT A EVENTS" IN THE FORM OF CONFERENCES, SEMINARS, WORKSHOPS, ETC, TO DISCUSS MEDIA FREEDOM ISSUES OR ANY OTHER RELEVA ARING ON EDITORIAL ACTIVITY. THEY ARE ALSO ENCOURAGED TO COLLABORATE WITH ORGANISATIONS IN THEIR COUNTRIES OR REG FREEDOMOFTHEMEDIA.¶ARTICLEIV¶IPICOMMITTEESOFEXPERTS¶1.IPICOMMITTEESOFEXPERTSSHALLEXISTTODEALWITHDIFFE O: ¶ · ADVISE THE EXECUTIVE BOARD ON POLICY ISSUES; ¶ · ASSIST THE DIRECTOR IN ARRANGING CONFERENCES/SEMINARS OR OTHER ON,PLUSTWODEPUTIES,APPOINTEDBYTHEBOARD,REPRESENTINGDIFFERENTGEOGRAPHICALREGIONS.FURTHERMEMBERSSHALLB E’SCHAIRPERSONORONEOFHERORHISDEPUTIES.INGENERAL,COMMITTEEMEMBERSHIPSHOULDNOTEXCEED20ANDIPIMEMBERS INGCOMMITTEESHALLBEESTABLISHEDTOOVERSEETHEACTIVITIESOFTHEIPIPRESSFREEDOMFUND.THISFUNDISTOBEADMINISTERED IPFOREDITORS,MEDIAEXECUTIVESANDACADEMICSINTHEFIELDOFCOMMUNICATION,WHO,FORSPECIALREASONSANDCIRCUMSTAN RTICIPATE IN ACTIVITIES OF THE INSTITUTE. THIS PERMANENT COMMITTEE MAY ALSO DECIDE TO USE FUND RESOURCES FOR THE ORGA AGE 5 ¶ ARTICLE V ¶ GENERAL ASSEMBLIES ¶ 1. GENERAL ASSEMBLIES OF THE ENTIRE MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE HELD ANNUALLY. ¶ 2. THE G ASMUCH AS THE PRIMARY PURPOSE OF THE GENERAL ASSEMBLIES IS TO PROVIDE A MEETING PLACE WHERE JOURNALISTS OF THE FREE HERESHALLBETOTHISENDBOTHORGANISEDANDINFORMALDISCUSSIONOFNEWSPAPERS,RADIO,TVANDINTERNETOBJECTIVES,PO EMBLY WILL FOCUS ON THE PROBLEMS OF THE COUNTRY OR THE REGION IN WHICH THE CONFERENCE IS HELD, CONFERENCE ORGANIS OR“BURNING”)INTERNATIONALISSUESOFTHEDAY.ASSEMBLYARRANGEMENTSMAYVARYFROMTIMETOTIMEANDNEEDNOTFOLLO MULATE THE INSTITUTE’S GENERAL PROGRAMME AND POLICY, ELECT THE EXECUTIVE BOARD, APPROVE THE ACCOUNTS AND VOTE THE AVE THE POWER TO ADOPT AMENDMENTS TO THE CONSTITUTION PROVIDED THAT PROPOSALS FOR AMENDMENTS TO THE CONSTITUT THEGENERALASSEMBLYDATE.UNDERTHESAMECONDITIONSTHEYSHALLHAVEPOWERTODECIDEONTHEHEADQUARTERSOFTHES R IN A DIFFERENT COUNTRY, IN SO FAR AS POSSIBLE. THE SITE AND DATE OF EACH GENERAL ASSEMBLY SHALL BE DECIDED BY THE EXECU UIDELINES OF THE GENERAL ASSEMBLY. ¶ 3. THE CHAIRPERSON OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL PRESIDE AT GENERAL ASSEMBLIES. ¶ DIVIDUAL MEMBERS, EACH FULL MEMBER PRESENT HAVING ONE VOTE. BALLOTING TO ELECT THE MEMBERS OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD E EMPLOYED IF SO MOVED AND SECONDED. ¶ 5. NOMINATIONS FOR ELECTION TO THE EXECUTIVE BOARD MUST BE SUBMITTED IN WRITIN MEMBERS.¶ONEMONTHINADVANCEOFTHEGENERALASSEMBLYTHEDIRECTORMUSTSENDOUTALISTTOALLMEMBERSCONTAININ ¶B)THENAMESOFTHOSEMEMBERSOFTHEEXECUTIVEBOARDWHOSETERMSAREEXPIRING,AND¶C)THOSERETIRINGMEMBERSOFTH LE VI ¶ EXECUTIVE BOARD ¶ 1. THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL HAVE FULL SUPERVISION OF THE AFFAIRS OF THE INSTITUTE, IN ACCORDAN HALL REPORT ON ITS ACTIVITIES TO THE GENERAL ASSEMBLY. IT SHALL MEET AS OFTEN AS IT DEEMS NECESSARY, BUT IT SHALL HOLD A GENERAL ASSEMBLY. IT SHALL SELECT THE PLACE FOR EACH OF ITS MEETINGS. NOTICE OF THE TIME AND PLACE OF THE MEETING SHALL GE 6 ¶ 2. THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL CONSIST OF 24 MEMBERS WHO SHALL BE ELECTED BY THE GENERAL ASSEMBLY FOR A TERM OF UEREGARD,ASFARASPOSSIBLE,TOGEOGRAPHICALDISTRIBUTION,MEDIASKILLSANDGENDERANDNOCOUNTRYSHALLBEREPRESE HE END OF THEIR FIRST TERM BOARD MEMBERS MAY OFFER THEMSELVES FOR RE-ELECTION FOR ONE FURTHER FOUR-YEAR TERM. NO M SYRIA 1962– n 1998, after years of torture, solitary confinement and three attempts on his life, Nizar Nayouf was forced to choose between his deeply principled convictions and his health, possibly his life. Until he promised to refrain from political activity and admit that he had made false declarations about human rights abuses in his homeland, Syria, he would not receive medical treatment for his curable, but debilitating Hodgkin’s disease, or for any of the injuries sustained under torture. Aware that he and 32 other human rights activists were wanted by authorities for membership in an illegal organisation, publishing false information about alleged violations of human rights and for undermining public confidence in the revolution and the socialist system, Nayouf – who was also charged with inciting people to revolt against the socialist system, organizing and leading an illegal association and issuing a monthly publication without a license – went into hiding. But on 2 January 1992, he was forced to surrender in order to obtain the release his then-wife, Nada and 11-month-old daughter, Sara. On 17 March 1992, the Syrian Supreme Court for State Security sentenced Nayouf to 10 years hard labour for “founding and leading [the banned Committee for the Defence of Democratic Freedom in Syria (CDF)] and issuing its monthly Sawt ad-Dimocratiyyah (Democracy’s Voice) without permission”. ‘Hard labour’ it turned out meant living in a tiny, solitary cell with no access to daylight. During those dark years, he managed to publish four books, write the incomplete collection, “The Prison Cahiers,” and win several awards for his fight for human rights and a free press. Ignoring his own suffering, given even half a chance to support others, Nayouf moves into gear. When first imprisoned, Nayouf tried to organise a prisoners’ rebellion, so he was transferred to a military prison where he began a hunger strike. In another attempt to quash his resilience, Nayouf was soon moved to a solitary cell in the notorious Palmyra desert military prison. Although torture left him partially paralysed, nearly blind in one eye and almost deaf in one ear, he continued his struggle for justice and human rights by smuggling out information about the torture methods inflicted both on him and his fellow prisoners. Although attempts were made by various delegations to visit Nayouf in prison, none were successful. But word of his torture was spreading like wildfire. He managed to smuggle out details of his torturous life behind the gates of the military prison revealing that he was near death and that he had “been subjected to the most excruciating forms of torture, including being tied to the notorious ‘German chair,’ which stretches the spine. He also [had] been thrown into an electrified bath and hung by his feet for two to three hours a day for a month. And while he was hanging by the feet, he was beaten with an iron pipe. Following another beating, guards urinated on his broken skull in a mock ‘baptism’ after he refused to pray, in a ritual required of other inmates, before a portrait of President Hafez al-Assad.” For over two years following the report, international human rights and freedom press organisations appealed to Syrian ambassadors and applied pressure to Syrian authorities to free Nayouf and allow him the medical treatment he needed to save his life. Finally, when he visited Syria, Pope John Paul II’s personal plea on behalf of global human rights bodies resulted in Nayouf’s transferral on 6 May 2001 to house arrest, where he awaited a passport so he could travel to Europe for medical treatment. Astonishingly, despite his nine-year incarceration and failing health, Nayouf immediately returned to his cause: just days after his release, in a letter to the International Press Institute, he requested “monetary and logistic support” in order to re-activate the Syrian Organisation for Defence of Press Freedom. Born 29 May 1962 in Syria, near the Mediterranean town of Jablah, Nayouf had a varied, but successful tertiary education that enabled him to study at the American University of Beirut, where he became a master of economics and political science in 1989. Nayouf left Syria for Paris on 15 July 2001. Barely settled in Paris, he founded the National Council for Truth, Justice and Reconciliation in Syria, (SYNATIC), an NGO defending human rights, particularly investigating and documenting the “specific” crimes committed by the Syrian regime. On 7 September 2001, Syrian authorities again issued a warrant for his arrest following an interview he gave on 15 August on Al Jazeera TV that revealed he had evidence of crimes committed by the Syrian regime and of “the existence of mass cemeteries of former political prisoners in Syria, ” and “importing nuclear and chemical waste in the 1980s by then Vice-president Abdulhalim Khaddam and his sons in order to be buried in the Syrian desert for millions of dollars .” By January 2004, Nayouf had said publicly that he knew the exact locations of Iraq’s hidden weapons of mass destruction, which, he claimed, had been transported by seemingly innocuous ambulances and stashed deep behind their borders. For three years, Nayouf coordinated a research team at the European Centre for Arab-Levant Studies. Opposed to the French administration’s relations and intelligence cooperation with the Syrian regime, he is now based in London where he is editor in chief of Syria Truth, through which he continues his irrepressible campaign for the release of political prisoners and to highlight abuses against the freedom of expression in both Syria and the Arabic World. 95 freedom neruda CÔTE D’IVOIRE 1956– 96 f reedom was more than Neruda’s moniker. It was his mantra. Born Tieti Roch d’Assumption in 1956, he adopted the surname Neruda as a tribute to Chilean poet Pablo Neruda whose writings served as his inspiration. But Freedom was his destination, the compass by which he pursued a journalistic path that defied the establishment in the Côte d'Ivoire that used brute force to crush those who spoke truth to power. A former mathematics teacher, Neruda began his journalism career as a copy editor for the daily Ivoir’ Soir in 1988. But it was through his work as an investigative reporter for La Chronique du Soir and later La Voie that he shed light on the corrupt government of then-Ivorian president Henri Konan Bédié. He did so in violation of national censorship laws that made perceived disrespect of government officials a criminal offense. A journalist found to have insulted or attacked an official was subject to prosecution for criminal libel and two years in jail. Of the Ivorian laws that strangled free expression, Neruda said in an interview for the 2000 book “Speak Truth To Power”: “If you read these laws and you want to become a journalist, you really should go grind peanuts because it is better for you.” And yet he pressed on as managing editor of La Voie. In the face of near constant harassment by the Bédié government, the daily threat of imprisonment and the October 1995 fire-bombing of his offices, Neruda turned La Voie (called Notre Voie in 1998) into the country’s best-selling independent newspaper. The battle of wills between Neruda and the Bédié government came to a head in December of that year. That’s when La Voie published “He Brought Bad Luck to the ASEC,” Neruda’s satire about President Bédié’s attendance at the African Champions Cup final and how, contrary to Bédié’s ‘I’m good luck’ campaign slogan, the president’s presence at the match may have doomed the Cote-d'Ivoire soccer team. As a result of the article, Neruda was arrested on 2 January 1996 for seditious libel in a sweep that also netted La Voie publisher Abou Drahamane Sangare and reporter Emmanuel Kore. The three were sentenced to two years in prison while the paper was fined $6,000 (USD) and banned for three months. The next day, L’Alternative emerged as a thorn of another name in Bédié’s side. Using the temporary pseudonym Bintou Diawara, Neruda smuggled stories out of prison, using his stint there to write about deplorable prison conditions as well as the judicial bias in the sentencing of rich Lebanese émigrés, who were often given much lighter punishments EC.10,194 CIONALD ENCH, G DE. THE R BUSINESS than their Ivorian counterparts. Both Neruda and La Voie operated under their respective assumed names until the three-month ban was lifted. For a year, Neruda and his colleagues shared a cell in the Maison d’Arret et de Correction d’Abidjan (the Abidjan House of Arrest and Correction), a prison built for 1,500 in which 5,000 prisoners were wedged. They subsisted on meager food rations – in some cases just two small yams a day – that were supplemented by food sent to them by the paper. There was widespread disease. And yet the group refused Bédié’s offer of a pardon in exchange for the withdrawal of their appeal that was pending before the country’s Supreme Court. “We said no, we are fighting for justice,” Neruda said in the Speak Truth To Power interview. “Release would be good, but not if you can’t look in your neighbour’s eyes,” The war of words between Neruda and Bédié raged on after his release in 1997 as La Voie continued to hammer away at Bédié’s political failings, exposing his vulnerability to a challenge by former Ivorian prime minister, Alassane D. Ouattara, in the upcoming presidential election. The paper chronicled Bédié’s attempts to repress Ouattara’s candidacy by challenging his nationality and ordering his arrest on charges of forgery of the documents Ouattara presented proving his eligibility. Bédié also imprisoned 11 leaders of Ouattara’s party for demonstrating against the biased reporting of the state-run broadcasters. La Voie reported on each twist and turn, with Bédié’s growing intolerance laid bare for all his countrymen to see. In the end, it was Neruda and free expression that were the ultimate victors. On Christmas Eve 1999, the Bédié government was overthrown by an Ivorian military coup that ushered in democratic rule and greater press freedom. About a month later, Neruda was promoted to deputy chief editor of Notre Voie. In the wake of the coup, Neruda wrote about the need for reconciliation. The time had come for renewal, not revenge. “The people have no need to avenge themselves,” Neruda wrote. “On the contrary, they should stand above that and offer a pardon to those who failed to understand that no star shines forever.” TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WO ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG P S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WO ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG P S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES TOno, UNDERSTAND “We ARE said we are ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SAFEGUARDING OFfighting FREEDOM OF PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE forTHE justice. NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND NALISM.¶WORLDPEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING PEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO would be PEOPLESBETWEEN TAL STEP TOWARDSRelease UNDERSTANDING AMONG IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WO ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG P good, not if OF¶ THE S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THEbut IMPROVEMENT PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO youTHERE can'tISlook in AN ORGANISATION ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF ESTABLISHED TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM your neighbour's MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA – OF SAFEGUARDING OFeyes.” FREEDOM THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND Neruda on the offer or a NALISM.¶WORLDPEACE DEPENDS ONUNDERSTANDING BETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO pardon if he dropped AL STEP TOWARDSprison UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WO ORK TOWARDS THE hisFOLLOWING court appeal OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG P S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE Top to bottom: ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A Neruda, NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THEFreedom WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA managing editor SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE of La Voie IS newsNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG paper, at work. PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO AL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WO ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG P S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO AL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WO ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG P S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE NACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHED REE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE PLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEA T UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WO D SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH I ERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPE ¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEEN OWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRING DSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEA FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UN ONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURN Y HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTA S BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WO S, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF N E FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSEN G AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCOR G OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE A AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • TH DPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLE RDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOU THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UN ONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURN Y HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTA S BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WO S, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF N E FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSEN G AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCOR G OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE A AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • TH UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELI NCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREEACCE ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMON ¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEND SENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP T HE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANIS MOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREEACCESSTOTHENEWS,FREETRANSMISSION NDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES ON. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLE ELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING E ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE T ALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTAN RGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERA NSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE OTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATION WEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISES MONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALISTSOFT EFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMO OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTAN TE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES ETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATIO NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELI NCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREEACCE ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMON ¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEND SENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP T HE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANIS MOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREEACCESSTOTHENEWS,FREETRANSMISSION NDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES ON. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLE ELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING E ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE T ALSTEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTAN RGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERA NSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE OTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATION WEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISES MONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJOURNALISTSOF T EFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMO OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTAN TE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES ETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATIO NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELI NCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREEACCE ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMON ¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEND SENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP T HE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANIS MOFTHEPRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT:FREEACCESSTOTHENEWS,FREETRANSMISSION NDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES Above: Pius Njawé standing next to a memorial commemorating Dr. Martin Luther King Jr.’s “I Have a Dream” speech. Below: Njawé with his late wife Jane and supporters after a trial in Douala. Below left: Njawé with his granddaughter and daughter. Below right: Njawé with his late wife Jane. PIUs NJaWé CAMEROON 1957–2010 P ius Njawé always said that journalism was his religion. “I came into journalism as a priest coming into a religion; journalism is my religion because I found the power of the word.” Over the course of his career, Njawé was arrested 126 times – a test of faith by any measure. But the founder and editor of Cameroon’s oldest independent newspaper, Le Messager, never let any of it – the arrests, the threats, or the attacks – stop him from fighting for press freedom. “From time to time, when the situation is very bad, many ideas pass through my spirit, among them the idea of giving up,” wrote Njawé. “But this never prospered because giving up would have meant a victory for my prosecutors … a victory that they don’t merit!” At age 19, Njawé had his first run-in with the authorities when he helped reveal the news that oil had been discovered in Cameroon, according to a 2008 interview with Radio Netherlands. The first time he was tortured came a few years later, when he reported that students in a local Doula city high school had scored poorly on entrance examinations. After a day of beatings and placement on an electric chair, he was eventually let off when he proved that his story was factually correct. Njawé founded Le Messager in 1979, when he was 22 years old. He had been working for a Doula-based weekly named La Gazette, but decided to start his own paper “in accordance with my conviction about the social function of a journalist,” Njawé said. “I thought that the best way for me to fulfil my mission as a journalist was to own a personal instrument to share and promote values in which I believed.” The paper would go on to make Cameroonian and African history. “There is no doubt in my mind and in the mind of serious analysts that the genuine history of democratic progress in Cameroon, especially between 1990 and 2000, will have to include [Njawé] and his pioneering newspaper Le Messager as crucial actors of that defining period,” wrote Professor Jean-Emmanuel Pondi, secretary general of the University of Yaoundé in Cameroon. The newspaper was banned in November 1992 and Njawé was forced into exile after he received threats to his life. He launched a substitute paper, Le Messagere, from Benin. Although he had unofficially been accused of gun running, sedition, drug dealing, and counterfeiting money, Njawé was able to return to Cameroon in February 1993, when he founded the Cameroon Organisation for Press Freedom (Ocalip). Njawé served three prison terms. In August 1995, Njawé and another journalist at Le Messager were handed deferred sentences of two months in prison and fined 300,000 Cameroonian francs for “abuse and slander” of the Cameroonian police chief, Jean Fochive. The newspaper had published an article that accused the police force of mishandling millions of francs. The next year, on 18 October, Njawé was arrested and convicted of insulting the president and members of the National Assembly after he published an article and two cartoons in his satirical publication, Le Messager Popoli. He was granted a provisional release after one month. In December 1997, Njawé was again arrested, and on 13 January 1998 was sentenced to two years in prison for spreading “false information.” The charge was linked to a report that appeared in Le Messager on 22 December 1997, which alleged that President Paul Biya had suffered heart problems during a football match. Njawé’s wife, Jane, miscarried as the result of abuse at the hands of prison guards. “I could not stop myself from crying when Jane gave birth to a still-born child on 9 January 1998, four days before my trial, following beatings she received the previous day when she brought me food, by prison guards who did not even have pity on her late pregnancy,” Njawé recalled in a statement for the World Association of Newspapers on World Press Freedom Day in 2006. Through the pain, Njawé kept writing. Bribing a string of guards and fellow prisoners to ensure that his column, “The Convict’s Notebook” (“Le Bloc-notes du bagnard”), came out. His efforts in the face of unrelenting repression earned Pius Njawé numerous accolades, including the WAN Golden Pen of Freedom Award and the International Press Freedom Award from the Committee to Protect Journalists. Ronald Koven of the World Press Freedom Committee, who translated Njawé’s letter from prison in 1998 into English, said of Njawé: “He has a gift of making the fight for press freedom seem worthwhile.” Njawé’s conviction also earned him plenty of enemies, including President Biya. “Since the Biya regime failed in its projects to silence me by assassination, intimidation and corruption, or by definitely banning Le Messager, they understand, I think, that there is no way to kill a spirit,” wrote Njawé. He was nonetheless wary: “Mr. Biya and his government had no other choice but to tolerate me […] But with them, I can’t close my two eyes while sleeping, because I’m sure that they will ‘finish with me’ at the first occasion. And I don’t want to give them this opportunity.” One month before the tragic car accident that ended his life, at age 53, in July 2010, Njawe bravely wrote: “A word can be more powerful than a weapon, and I believe that with the word, with verbs, we can build a better world and make happier people. So, why give up while duty still calls? No one will silence me, except the Lord, before I achieve what I consider the mission in my native country, in Africa and, why not, in the world.” 99 germán ornes DOMINICAN REPUBLIC 1919–1998 100 f or more than 50 years, Germán Ornes, editor and publisher of El Caribe and an architect of the Inter American Press Association (IAPA), stood watch over press freedom in the Dominican Republic and throughout the Western hemisphere. The concept of a free press operating outside the interference of government was novel in Latin America and yet necessary, in Ornes’ opinion, if dictatorships were to be defeated and democracy to flourish. Seeing that freedom of the press in the region was under attack more than ever before, Ornes issued a report at IAPA’s 1994 Hemisphere Conference on Freedom of the Press, an ominous warning about the terrorism, dictatorships, censorship and legal and physical threats that thwarted Latin American publications. Ornes was pivotal in drafting IAPA’s Declaration of Chapultepec, which outlined 10 principles necessary for a free press to thrive. Named after the Mexico City castle at which the 1994 IAPA free speech conference was held, it was based on a concept Ornes lived by: “no law or act of government may limit freedom of expression or of the press, whatever the medium.” Born on 30 July 1919 in the Dominican Republic, Germán Emilio Ornes Coiscou, like many journalists, studied law at the University of Santo Domingo and worked briefly as a lawyer before switching to journalism. As a young man, he was a member of the Central Committee of Revolutionary Youth, an activist group at the forefront of the fight against dictator General Rafael Leonidas Trujillo Molina, who ruled directly from 1930 to 1947 and by proxy until his assassination in 1961. Ornes began his career in 1940 as a reporter for the La Nación newspaper in the Dominican Republic. In 1945, he worked for a short time as editor in chief of La Opinión before he became editor of El Caribe. In 1955, a picture caption in El Caribe mistakenly said that flowers had been placed before Trujillo’s tomb when they had actually been placed before a bust of the dictator. In a 1956 Time magazine article, Ornes said the error was a fatal one because Trujillo “is very vain and superstitious. He thinks he is immortal, and the worst thing you can do is suggest his death.” Ornes went on to say that when he saw the word ‘tumba’ in print, he told his wife: “This is the end of everything.” El Caribe was confiscated by the Trujillo regime and Ornes went into exile. He lived in the United States and Cuba and wrote for a variety of publications, including Harper’s, The Colorado Quarterly and El Mundo. He continued his jour- EC.10,1948).¶2 IONALDELAPR ENCH, GERMAN E. THE RESOUR USINESSES, WH FITOFANYMEM , TRAINING COU ELEGATIONS AN LANCE OF WOM nalistic crusade against Trujillo, whom he described in the Time interview as a “despot.” Ornes said Trujillo’s regime was a “tyranny” and accused him of “usurpation, plunder and criminal violence.” After Trujillo’s 1961 assassination, Ornes returned to the Dominican Republic and resumed the editorship of El Caribe. He was also publisher of the paper, which he quickly re-established as the country’s leading daily. In a December 1961 El Caribe editorial published after the fall of Trujillo’s regime, Ornes spoke of a new chapter in the paper’s history. “The official hand has left the newsroom. This newspaper, for the first time since its foundation, is published free of foreign interference to direction,” he wrote. He went on to say that the people of the Dominican Republic “sighed because the long-awaited day arrived that there was freedom of the press.” The following year, Ornes was elected to IAPA’s board of directors and played a vital role in the association’s work, championing press freedom through the Americas. Among several positions he held within the organisation, Ornes was IAPA president from 1978 to 1979 and headed its Committee on Freedom of the Press and Information for several years. His work opposing a New World Information and Communication Order, which he considered a serious threat, established him as one of the world’s most fervent defenders of press freedom. The Chapultepec Declaration was endorsed by heads of state throughout the Americas. Ornes died of a heart attack on El Caribe’s 50th anniversary, 14 April 1998. He was 78. TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UN ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAF F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERS S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL ST ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TO SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSP MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMON ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL T NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANC SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCES NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PRO NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESAN TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UN ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAF F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERS S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL ST ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TO SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSP MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMON ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL T NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANC SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCES NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PRO NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESAN TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UN ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAF F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERS S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL ST ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TO SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSP MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMON ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL T NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANC SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCES NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PRO NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESAN TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UN ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAF F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERS S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL ST Germán Ornes with other fellow former presidents of IAPA. Right: sharing a laugh with George Beebe in 1977. Left: Ornes pictured with Lee Hills and Horacio Aguirre, 1976. N ACCORDANCE WITHTHIS THEREISESTA MISSIONS TO COUNTRIES ANDBELIEF GOVERNMENTS, AN N AND MEN INTO ITSTHE STRUCTURES AND IN ITS ACTIVIT REE ACCESS NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION anna UTE, AND THE INSTITUTE ASSUMES NO LIABILITY, LE THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF A ENTOAND PERSONS WITH RESPONSIBILITIES FOREDITO PolItKovsKaya PLES PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTA NET, WHO SUPPORT THE PRINCIPLE OF FREEDOM OF T TTEN UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS STATEMENTTHEIR WILLINGNESS TOWORKFORO RE THEREARENATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATI DPLICANTS. SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B INCOUNTRIES WHERE THEREARE NO NA ERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A LY DETERMINE WHETHER OR NOT TO ENROL THE APP ¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ONUNDERSTANDING o UAL BASIS. HOWEVER, IF A NATIONAL COMMITTEE OWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLESNE IS TERNET SERVICE. ¶ 4. A NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, FDS TEN. ¶ 5.FOLLOWING THERE SHALL BE ELIGIBLE AS ASSOCIATE THE OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH TIVES, FOR EXAMPLE,OF THESE MAY INCLUDE: ¶·ASAS FREE EXPRESSION VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEME (LEADING JOURNALISTS GROUP): PERSONS OPERA ONS.¶EDITORIAL • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES O NCIES, WRITERS, COPY EDITORS, BUREA Y HAVE GOODON INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUN AL POSITIONS INTERNETSERVICES. ¶THENUMBE WS AGENCY IS NOT LIMITED. AFFILIATE MEMBERSH SF.BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATI ¶ 6. ASSOCIATE AND AFFILIATE MEMBERSHIP CA S, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICA WHICH ALONE SHALL HAVE THE POWER TO INITIAL ERSHIP FREESHALL EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANC BE MADE TO THE INSTITUTE’S DIRECTO PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONEEXECUTIVE ANOTHER,BO I TOTHEULTIMATE AUTHORITYOFTHE HE DUES FORTHE ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE HA GPAGE AMONG JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ 3¶8.INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE GAND OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEA CENTRES OF JOURNALISM, PRESS INSTITUTES AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEO CTIVITIES. THE DIRECTOR SHALL HAVE POWER TO EN DES PEACE DEPENDSONUNDERSTANDING FORINSTITUTIONAL MEMBERSSHALLBEBETWE FIXEDB ARAS ASSOCIATEMEMBERS ARECONCERNED, DUE RDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BR ARD. ¶ 10. THE EXECUTIVE BOARD¶SHALL HAVE POW THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: • THE FURTHER SPENSION OF A MEMBER MAY BE ORDERED BY A MA FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS.OF ¶ • THE ACHIEVEME DS OF THE MEMBERS PRESENT THE BOARD. ¶ 11. ONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OFPREVIOUS THE PRACTICES O R CONCERNED SIXTY (60) DAYS TO THE M SOORDERED SUSPENDEDOREXPELLED BYTHE EX YERHAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUN FINAL DECISION OF THE INST SRECOGNISED BELIEF THEREAS ISTHE ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATI RUSSIA 1958–2006 Politkovskaya leaves a theater after negotiations with gunmen in Moscow as Chechen rebels threatened to begin killing their 600 hostages in a Moscow theatre 25 October 2002. Above: A man holds a portrait of the killed journalist Anna Politkovskaya as a woman lights up a candle during a commemorative rally in St. Petersburg on 7 October 2009, three years after her murder. n 7 October 2006, the news of Anna Stepanovna Politkovskaya’s death rocked the world when she was found shot dead in her elevator. Even in death, her life’s work inspires and drives others to pursue truth, justice, press freedom and accountability. Anna Politkovskaya’s sister tells of a little girl whose conscience questioned authority and protected the vulnerable: “Since she was very young, she was quite a determined person, she always wanted to protect people. At school, she was a kind of leader in her class. When she thought that the teacher wasn’t being fair to somebody, she would stand up and say so.” For Chechnya’s oppressed and terrified civilians, Anna shone through their darkness as one of the world’s most respected journalists. As a rare voice defending the true principal of peace and reconciliation, she gave hope and inspired strength. As a mother of two, and expectant grandmother, she fought to create a better world for posterity. She was born in New York to two Russian diplomats on 30 August 1958 and raised in Russia; she could have chosen a comfortable and controversy-free path, but journalism called early, tempting her with places and people otherwise hidden behind the Iron Curtain. With a Moscow State University degree in journalism, her career took off in 1980 at the Soviet paper Izvestiya. She later worked for Aeroflot, the Soviet Union’s state-owned airline. In 1994, she joined the vibrant national newspaper Obshchaya Gazeta as a crime correspondent; she was part of a dynamic reporting team that focused on the controversial issues of Chechnya’s war, state corruption and privatisation. The paper was a champion of the people, committed, like Politkovskaya, to forcing back the ever-encroaching state from the boundaries of press freedom and the public’s right to know. When she left to join Novaya Gazeta in 1999, she had risen to editor-in-chief. Working at one of Russia’s only remaining independent newspapers, she wrote passionately about Chechnya’s unhappy destiny and national sorrow – reports that state-owned papers tried to squash. Her book, “A Dirty War,” documented those reports, revealing her commitment to the Chechen people’s liberation and safety, which led her into incredible personal danger, a danger she considered to be her obligation to face. “Everyone has a conscience,” Politkovskaya believed. “I think that I currently fulfil all the obligations I have to my conscience.” Ignoring the suffering of others was, for her, utterly abhorrent; she committed her life to ensuring that readers could not ignore the atrocities experienced by others. With cropped grey hair and a diminutive appearance, she could slip across borders and become invisible. Despite numerous death threats, she continued to report the true nature of the occupation of Chechnya, revealing human tragedy and the suffering of the Chechen people. In 2001, after interviewing a Chechen grandmother who had endured 12 days of beatings, electric shocks and confinement in a pit by federal forces, Politkovskaya was detained by Russian troops and tortured before being subjected to a mock execution. But it did not stop her. As President Putin’s nemesis, she was damning of the corruption within the government, which was once again paralysing Russia’s freedom. Politkovskaya’s book “Putin’s Russia” exposed Putin as a power-hungry product of his own KGB history. Mourning the decline of the dissident intelligentsia, she revealed mafia dealings and scandals in the provinces, and detailed corruption in the military and judiciary. Many consider her near-fatal poisoning in 2004 to be connected to the release of her pejorative exposé, which Putin’s regime dismissed as ‘insignificant’ and also rubbished her criticism of the Kremlin. Following the poisoning, friends and family implored her to go abroad, to write a book – to write about anything but conflict and corruption. She negotiated a compromise: the birth of a grandchild would, her sister said, see “her write about something more pleasant.” Politkovskaya’s negotiating skills had been called upon on 23 October 2002 when Chechen rebels stormed a Moscow theatre, taking 850 hostages. Trusting her journalistic integrity, they requested she mediate their demands for the extraction of Russian troops from Chechnya. In Los Angeles to accept an award, Anna promised to speak with the authorities, but by the time she arrived in Russia the siege was over and 120 hostages were dead. With her focus to work “for people, and for the sake of people,” Politkovskaya was threatened, coerced and intimidated by a state trying to protect its society from ugly truths. The government made it difficult for journalists to interview her. But interview her they did. On 5 October 2006, she gave her last interview, in which she expressed the hope that Chechnya’s President Ramzan Kadyrov would be tried for numerous human rights’ abuses. Her family was looking forward to the promised step-down from Anna’s crusade; mother and pregnant daughter spent the morning of Putin’s birthday shopping for a baby’s bath. When Anna seemed tired – a residual after-effect from the poisoning – her daughter Vera insisted she return home. A few hours later, her son, Ilya, popped in to see how she was, to find his mother murdered. Politkovskaya’s fight for others’ lives had stolen her own. As those initially accused of her murder were found not guilty in February 2009, fingers point liberally into the upper echelons of Russian government, igniting Anna’s crusade and fuelling a deeper national passion for truth and a free press. 103 PerCy qoBoZA SOUTH AFRICA 1938–1988 H is colour rendered his opinions irrelevant, but Percy Qoboza, nonetheless, faced up to the monster known as apartheid. He shared his opinions loud and clear – in black and white. Speaking at the IPI 29th Annual General Assembly in Florence, Qoboza said: “One of the problems with South Africa is that we are a society obsessed by race. With shining consistency, South Africa has condemned journalists.” Qoboza dedicated his life to truth, transparency and tolerance: He believed South Africa should belong to all its peoples. Born on 17 January 1938 in the harsh Sophiatown to a strong Xhosa family, Qoboza experienced the brutalities of daily discrimination and oppression of blacks. Entrenching Qoboza’s quiet anger, the government destroyed his home township in 1952 during a systematic cleansing in which residents were packed into cattle trucks and relocated. Where many could easily find reason to be bitter, Qoboza was a light-hearted gentleman with an indomitable humour, as remembered by most. His friend, former Harvard University Nieman Fellow, Aggrey Klaaste, reminisced about discussions with a group of white Catholic priests, during which he and Qoboza put the world to rights: “We argued religion, discussed politics ... over copious quantities of booze, to the extent that when the money ran out, we convinced the prelates to raid the collection plate. We cleaned that out. Not once, if my memory serves me right.” Set to become a priest himself, Qoboza took a degree in theology at Lesotho National University, but when his father suffered a stroke Qoboza’s path changed. In 1963, as breadwinner for his father and two sisters, he entered the controversial world of South African journalism as a junior reporter at the then-entertainment daily, The World. 104 Qoboza’s careful-yet-persistent criticism of the South African government stepped away from the regulations, laws and restrictions that stifled serious reporting, and saw him promoted to editor in chief within a decade. “One has to make a choice whether to be outspoken and go to jail where you’ll be silenced, or to take a milder platform so you can keep working,” he said. In 1975, Qoboza was nominated as a Nieman Fellow at Harvard University. In the United States, he saw equality, he saw colour-blind respect; in essence he saw the dream he had been chasing for so long. Secure in the knowledge that equality between races was possible, he returned to South Africa even more committed to his passive-aggressive fight against oppression: “I found myself completely maladjusted, quite unable to accept the things that seemed quite normal before.” In June 1976, now The World’s editor-in-chief offering hope and a voice to politically-motivated blacks, Qoboza ran the only first-hand account of the violent Soweto riots, cementing his role as an enemy of the government and a figure-head in the fight against oppression. For the paper’s dedicated readers, in his everanticipated column Percy’s Pitch, he wrote, “I do not believe that I will be serving the interests of my country and all her peoples by suppressing the truth simply because such a truth is unpalatable to certain sections of the population.” Qoboza preached sanity, truth and moderation despite many threats and attacks against both him and his family. When The World again fervently condemned the apartheid regime following political activist Steve Biko’s death in detention in September 1977, the government banned the paper. Qoboza was arrested without charge and was not seen or heard from for six months. An international campaign secured his release – a fate that did not meet six of his reporters who were “wiped off the face of the earth,” Qoboza recalled. Despite months in prison and the loss of several close friends, when asked by a reporter what lessons he had learned in prison, Qoboza’s typically dry response was, “How to diet.” For Harvey Tyson, editor-in-chief of Johannesburg’s The Star, the end of The World marked the end of press freedom in South Africa: “We knew that from the moment they came to take Percy Qoboza away no newspaper was safe in South Africa.” Committed to his crusade, Qoboza remained in journalism as editor in chief at The Post (owned by white liberals) until it, too, was banned. As journalism became increasingly dangerous for anti-apartheid voices, Qoboza accepted the role of guest editor covering Third World and UN affairs for The Washington Star in the United States capital. For two years, with his family in Washington, D.C., he continued to champion the anti-apartheid movement. Upon his return home in 1984, he became editor of The City Press, where, despite pro-government ownership, he enjoyed editorial independence, allowing him to continue his anti-apartheid crusade and to inspire the paper’s recordbreaking 200,000 readers. Qoboza’s death on his 50th birthday in 1988 cut his career, and life, tragically short. Breaking the rules, in a style of which he would have been enormously proud, 5,000 mourners attended his funeral, bucking governmental orders to limit numbers to 200. Twenty-two years later, on 28 April 2010, South African President Jacob Zuma posthumously honoured Percy Qoboza with the Order of Ikamanga, the highest national honour bestowed on individuals who have excelled in shaping South Africa. EC.10,1948).¶2.THENAMEOFTHE IONALDELAPRENSA,INSPANISH ENCH, GERMAN AND SPANISH; TH E. THE RESOURCES OF THE INSTIT USINESSES, WHICH SUPPORT TH FITOFANYMEMBERORINDIVIDUA , TRAINING COURSES, ACADEMIC ELEGATIONS AND MISSIONS TO CO LANCE OF WOMEN AND MEN IN IT E, FOR THE INSTITUTE, AND THE IN EINSTITUTEISOPENTOPERSONS ORONTHEINTERNET,WHOSUPPO ALLYANDBYWRITTENSTATEMEN NCOUNTRIESWHERETHEREAREN TOENROLTHEAPPLICANTS.INCO OWERTOINITIALLYDETERMINEW BE ON AN INDIVIDUAL BASIS. HOW SYSTEM OR AN INTERNET SERVIC R UP TO A LIMIT OF TEN. ¶ 5. THER STITUTE’SOBJECTIVES,FOREXAM FILIATEMEMBERS(LEADINGJOU ING OR NEWS AGENCIES, EDITORIA TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WO ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG P S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WO ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG P S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO TAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WO ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG P S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE Above: Percy Qoboza with ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A wife Anne, son Vusi and NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OFNtuliTHE twin daughters and WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BYtrulyWHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE Mangi who are surprised to seeSO Qoboza, NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND also pictured below, after NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDING BETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO he was released from AL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WO detention without their ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: knowledge. ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG P S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO AL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WO ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG P S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE NDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND NALISM.¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO AL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WO ORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS F NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG P S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET TIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO ANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH SS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM MOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICE ND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE SES, ACADEMIC Lraúl MISSIONS TO CO rIvero N AND MEN IN IT UTE, AND THE IN ENTOPERSONSW NET,WHOSUPPO TENSTATEMENT ERETHEREAREN PLICANTS.INCO LYDETERMINEW NACCORDANCEWITHTHISBELIEFTHEREISESTABLISHEDANORGANISATI REE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICAT THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED PLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISES T UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCO D SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE A ERSTANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALISTSANDSOAMONGPEOPLES.¶•THEPR ¶WORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDP OWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERS DSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARD FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING ONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD Y HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARD S BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS T S, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FRE E FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATION PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY G AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH TH G OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE N AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION DPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES RDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTAND THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDIN FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING ONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD Y HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARD S BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS T S, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FRE E FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATION PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY G AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH TH G OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE N AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION DPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES RDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTAND THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDIN FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING ONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD Y HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARD S BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS T S, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FRE E FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATION Above: Raúl Rivero at work. Below: Rivero talks on the phone while holding his daughter Yenia as his wife Blanca stands with them on the balcony of their home in Havana, 2004. CUBA 1945– P oet and journalist Raúl Rivero Castañeda was born in Morón, Camagüey, in central Cuba, in 1945. Disenchanted with the Cuban revolution and Fidel Castro’s movement, for which he campaigned, he later became, like many other Cuban writers, artists and intellectuals, a dissident. Few people embody and represent, by themselves and with such vigour, the courage and inner strength to fight for their own freedom and that of their country as Raúl Rivero. He represents, through his struggle as a journalist and poet and through his allegations from the Cuban dungeons where he was imprisoned, one of the best examples worldwide of political dissent. His struggle serves many purposes, including highlighting the sick side of the Cuban dictatorship – capable of muzzling, silencing and imprisoning poets, writers, journalists. Perhaps because verse is more powerful than the bullet, Rivero embodied the words of Spanish poet Blas de Otero: “Only the word is left to us” (“Nos queda la palabra”). Rivero graduated from the Journalism Faculty at the University of Havana in 1969, 10 years after Castro rose to power. He collaborated with the Cuban leader in the renowned journals Bohemia and Cuba Internacional. Later on, he worked at the official news agency of the communist regime, Prensa Latina. During that time, his literary work was recognised by the Castro regime and he was awarded the David Prize for Poetry, an award from the Cuban Writers’ Union. Rivero was, at first, like other Cuban writers and intellectuals – an enthusiast of the Revolution. But in 1972, the Cuban regime sent Rivero to Moscow as a correspondent for Prensa Latina and in the Soviet capital – where he remained for nearly three years – his personal disenchantment began when he found out what so-called “real Soviet socialism” was. On his return to Cuba, Rivero’s progressive detachment from the Revolution made his writings ever less important: he returned to the magazine Cuba, where he had begun his career and later, as international editor of a small local newspaper, Tribuna de la Habana. He re-wrote carefully selected and censored articles that he received from the news agency. Eventually he was expelled from Tribuna de la Habana and ended up barely surviving on his mother’s monthly pension of 75 pesos (just over two euros a month). He was marginalised further after signing the famous “Charter of Ten,” a letter to Fidel Castro in 1991, which was widely distributed all over the world and called for the release of prisoners of conscience. He became victim of personal attacks by the regime; fear made his friends and acquaintances turn away or alienate him. In 1995, along with some companions and coinciding with the Cuban telephone connection to satellite, Rivero set up the Cuba Press Agency, where he began writing for newspapers in other Latin American countries. To receive money from abroad, the agency joined the Inter American Press Association. By the year 2000, Raúl Rivero already had the embryo of a news agency; a rudimentary school of journalism, which, for lack of classrooms, taught classes in private homes; a magazine, De Cuba, which published just three or four editions; and a fledgling Independent Journalists Association. In 2003, he was imprisoned, together with the ‘Group of 75,’ accused of receiving money from the United States. He was kept in solitary confinement in the most famous political prison in Cuba, Villa Marista, where he received a nauseating meal of hunger, based on herbal broth, sugared water, a ball of rice and a flour dumpling for breakfast. For dinner, a similar menu. His solitary confinement cell, where he remained for a year, was a small enclosure in which he lived in total isolation, given respite only for 50 minutes twice a week in another, roofless cell where he was exposed to the sun’s rays. Later, to complete his two remaining years in prison, he shared cells with common criminals. His release was a product of international pressure on the Cuban government. Besides the numerous awards won by Rivero, and his accusatory articles, which appeared in newspapers in continental America, there were also the initiatives by European press freedom organisations, such as IPI; support for Rivero from media like CNN; personalities such as French actress Catherine Deneuve, and notable writers, for example, the now deceased Susan Sontag. He even had the support of someone influential to Castro – Gabriel García Márquez, the Colombian Nobel Prize winner for literature and a personal friend of the dictator. The ultimate support was from the Spanish government, which lobbied the Cuban executive through President José María Aznar and José Luis Rodríguez Zapatero’s governments. After his release from prison in 2004, Rivero travelled to Spain, where he now lives, working as a journalist and columnist for the newspaper El Mundo. In Spain, he continues with his books and other literary works and his activism for the release of political prisoners and prisoners of conscience in Cuba and the implementation of human rights on the island. Written by José Luis Gutiérrez (originally in Spanish). Guitérrez is a journalist, writer and publisher of LEER magazine. He is also a columnist for the newspaper El Mundo. 107 NUNo roCha PORTUGAL 1933– 108 d ragged away from his wife and one-yearold daughter at six o’clock in the morning on 13 April 1975, Nuno Rocha was bundled from his bed by four armed soldiers ready to fire. Taken to the high-security fortress-prison in Caixas, near Lisbon, he was clad in prison garb and forced into a cell. His crime? Fighting for the right to a free press. He was among 40 bankers and businessmen arrested in the early hours of 13 April, all accused of being counter-revolutionary by the ruling Portuguese Communist Party. While Rocha’s agenda remained moderate and focussed on the truth, his country’s politics swung from one extreme to the other. Born in Porto on 13 February 1933, Nuno Augusto Ferreira Alves Rocha grew up under the dictatorial ‘New State’ government that was founded on fascist ideologies, creating a country in which civil liberties and political freedom were repressed. Portugal, however, enjoyed unprecedented financial stability and growth provided by the popular New State regime, which was wholly different to the chaos that ruled the First Republic. Starting his journalism career when he left school, Rocha enjoyed something of a dream job for young men, writing for the Sportive Press for four years before joining his town’s more serious daily O Primeiro de Janeiro. In search of gravitas, he moved to Diário Ilustrado in Lisbon and mingled with the politicians and journalists of the day. Within 10 years, by 1962, he had made a name for himself at O Diário Popular as a senior reporter, where he interviewed the big names of the day: Willy Brandt, Jimmy Carter and Valerie Giscard. During the New State’s regime, many intellectuals and free-thinkers fled the country, with a million finding a new home in France. At O Diário Popular, Rocha composed articles detailing the experiences of those emigrants based on his own undercover investigations. In 1965, Rocha published the articles in his critically-acclaimed bestseller, the first of several publications, “France: A Painful Emigration,” in which he documented observations made on his ‘dummy’ journey to Paris with other emigrants on a bus transporting some legal and some illegal emigrants. He shared with his rapt readers his disgust of the transport, the injustice and the exploitation of the migrants trying to make a life in a free country. As an open liberal, his opposition to António de Oliveira Salazar’s dictatorship was satisfied when Marcelo Caetano ascended to Portugal’s premiership in September 1968. Any hopes Rocha had harboured for a moderate Portugal were dashed: “When Marcello Caetano took over the leadership of the government, hope was reborn. EC.10,1948). IONALDELA ENCH, GERM DE. THE RESO USINESSES, FITOFANYM , TRAINING C But, instead, censorship was tightened,” Rocha said. “At the same time, the journalists, because it was alleged that they had engaged in political activities, were repeatedly put into prison, and they spent years in these prisons of the secret police.” By the time a band of young army officers overthrew Caetano in a bloodless coup on 25 April 1974, Rocha had been director of O Diário Popular’s Sunday edition – Diário de Lisboa – for two years. The junta promised liberal reforms and a much brighter future. A few days later it was an enthusiastic, relieved Rocha who addressed the 23rd IPI General Assembly in Kyoto, Tokyo: “In Portugal, 48 years after it was trampled underfoot, the flower of liberty opened its petals on the 25 April, and with it was reborn the freedom of the press.” Liberal Portugal was short-lived. After a failed counter-coup orchestrated by high-ranking rightwing officers, the country’s political pendulum swung left in March of 1975 and the Supreme Revolutionary Council was born. “Those in power at the time [revolutionary military officers and the Portuguese Communist Party], aware of the importance of the press ... managed to penetrate the press milieu and dominate it completely,” Rocha said. “A year after the revolutionary action, most of the newspapers in Portugal were in the hands of communist directors and journalists.” After years of fighting for freedom, the socialists proved worse; furious about the censorship imposed on his writing, Rocha quit and moved to start a new, independent publication, which led to his arrest in April 1975. Accused of criminal associations and CIA links, Rocha was released after 17 hours, thanks to significant global support and exposure. Forty-five days after his release, Rocha’s liberal, dissident Tempo hit the shelves and became immediately popular with an audience disenchanted with propaganda. Within a year, Portugal elected the more moderate General Ramalho Eanes, and Tempo was Portugal’s best selling newspaper, with a circulation of 150,000. Leaving Tempo in 1988, Rocha became director of the journalism school at Lisbon’s Universidade Independente in 1995 and created its Center for the Study of Communications Sciences, often travelling to lecture aboard. He founded Media XXI in 1996 and was director there until retirement. When he was named a freedom press hero for the International Press Institute in 2000, the former IPI executive board member announced his intentions to promote press freedom and empower journalists in Portugal’s former colonies. In 2002, Rocha suffered a small stroke, which prompted him to leave his lecturing days behind and retire from public life. G NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALIS T THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL S TH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK E NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AM LES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIA ANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDA RDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACC NDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE P ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESA OWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT U ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SA APERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDE G NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALIS T THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL S TH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK E NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AM LES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIA ANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDA RDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACC NDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE P ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESA OWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT U ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SA APERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDE G NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALIS T THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL S TH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK E NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AM LES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIA ANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDA RDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACC NDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE P ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESA OWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT U ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SA Above: Nuno Rocha, also pictured below, accepting the IPI World Press Freedom Hero award at the IPI World Congress in Boston, 2000. ANT: ACCESS T E ACCESSFREE TO THE NEWS, FREE TRAN PaP HE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCH AND SO AMONG PEO saIne S AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO U E DEPENDS ON UND NDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOU AFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF TH AL STEP TOWARDS STANDINGAMONGSTJOURNALIST ORGANISATION TO ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERS WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG P RANSMISSION OF N THEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•T OMOTION THE FR EE EXPRESSION OFOF VIEWS. ¶ • THE A S.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PR BETWEEN PEOPLES AVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREF ELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN OR ING AMONG PEOPL REE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FRE RDS THE FOLLOWIN REE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND OPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE A LICATION OF NEWSP MONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE OF ACCURATE AND B F FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHI MONGST JOURNALISTS AM PEOPLES AREAND TOSOUN THE GAMBIA 1952– Above: Pap Saine, also pictured right and below, working as a broadcaster at the Swedish-founded Syd Radio in Banjul in the 1970s. P ap Saine, managing director, co-founder and editor of The Point newspaper in The Gambia and the dean of Reuters correspondents for West and Central Africa, is also a renowned and widely-respected advocate for press freedom in a country whose reputation for implementing draconian laws on freedom of expression have greatly restricted the rights of journalists. Through The Point and other forms of news media, Saine has helped to change the role of mass media in the country by providing an outlet for the expression of divergent views and opinions, championing press freedom and noble governance in the country. Throughout his journalistic career, Saine has faced multiple threats, criminal charges and arrests for the pursuit of justice, particularly in his public opposition to the Gambian government’s refusal to thoroughly investigate the mysterious death in December 2004 of The Point co-founder Deyda Hydara, who was also Saine’s long-time friend and fellow press freedom advocate. Saine’s valiant efforts in maintaining indispensable human rights have proven him to be a man who has earned honourable recognition. Born in the Gambian capital city of Banjul on 4 October 1950, Pap Saine eventually pursued a career in journalism after gaining inspiration from radio news broadcasters at Radio Gambia and Senegalese Radio. In 1970, Saine entered the journalism world as a broadcaster at the Swedish-founded Syd Radio in Banjul. Six years later, Saine was recruited by Reuters news agency to work as its correspondent in Banjul, a position he still holds today. By 1982, Saine joined forces with Babucarr Gaye and Deyda Hydara as editors for the Senegambia Sun newspaper, which was published weekly in The Gambia. Motivated by a common desire to create an independent newspaper and to promote respect for human rights and the consolidation of democracy in The Gambia, Saine, Hydara, and Gaye collaborated to form The Point newspaper in 1991. The Point faced many challenges in its first few years, including Gaye’s resignation within the paper’s first months of formation, the spatial limitations of a tiny cardboard-partitioned office at the Banjul Press Centre and a severe lack of proper publishing equipment and computers. Despite such challenges, Saine and Hydara moved forward with The Point, choosing the phrase “For Freedom and Democracy” as the motto for the newspaper. In 2004, the Gambian government, under the supervision of President Yayha Jammeh, implemented strict media laws that resulted in widespread self-censorship by the country’s news media. Journalists convicted of press violations became subject to heavy fines, criminal lawsuits, harassment, imprisonment and death threats. In December of the same year, Hydara was brutally murdered following his announced plans to challenge two controversial laws introduced in The Gambia. The investigations into his murder yielded no results, despite pleas for further investigation from Saine and The Gambia Press Union. Consequently, Hydera’s death was widely believed to be a result of his work in journalism. Following the murder, Saine took the role as managing director and editor of The Point. In August 2009, Saine and five fellow journalists were sentenced to two years in prison on criminal defamation and seditious publication charges for issuing a joint statement holding President Jammeh’s regime responsible for Hydara’s murder. The group of journalists was detained at Mile Two prison in Banjul under harsh conditions, and Saine, after collapsing in his prison cell, was hospitalised. By September 2009, the imprisoned journalists were released on presidential pardon. Although under pressure from organisations such as IPI, The Gambia Press Union and the Media Foundation for West Africa to release the detained journalists, President Jammeh reportedly claims to have pardoned the journalists in the ‘spirit of Ramadan,’ an Islamic spiritual observance which encourages forgiveness and purification through honourable acts. Currently, Saine remains the managing director and editor of The Point, and continues to advocate for human rights and press freedom in The Gambia. The newspaper maintains its pivotal role in Gambian society as a watchdog against corruption, drug trafficking, crime and political discrepancies and has acted as a strong instrument for expressing diverse opinions and perspectives. The perseverance of Saine for the sake of restoring freedom of expression among The Gambian people functions to inspire others who are committed to the fight for press freedom. 111 yoanI sánCheZ CUBA 1975– ime magazine may have chosen Yoani Sánchez as one of the 100 most influential people in the world, but she has never seen the award. In fact, she hasn’t been granted permission to leave her native Cuba to collect any of the awards showered on her in the past three years. For Sanchez, though, it’s not about the awards. Born on 4 September 1975 in Havana, Cuba, Sánchez accidentally fell in love with computer science and the Internet. For a person of her age, a member of Generation Y, it seemed natural. The problem lay in the politics of her homeland. A philologist by training, Sánchez studied at the Pedagogical Institute in Havana with a focus on Spanish literature. In 1995, she transferred to the faculty of arts and humanities, graduating five years later with a degree in Hispanic philology. In 2000, Sánchez went to work for the publisher Gente Nueva (New People), but soon realised that she couldn’t support her family, which included her 5-year-old son, on the average Cuban wage. Quitting her social service position, she decided to pursue a more lucrative path – teaching Spanish to German tourists visiting Havana. In 2002, Sánchez emigrated to Switzerland, but returned to Havana two years later “for family reasons.” It was a decision that would not only change her life, but would eventually call greater attention to the dismal press freedom record of a struggling nation. Upon her return to Cuba, Sánchez and a group of friends founded Consenso, a magazine “of reflection and debate.” That experience led her to the Internet. Partly to reach more tourists interested in Spanish and Cuban culture, Sánchez and her husband, journalist Reinaldo Escobar, set up the domain http://www.desdecuba.com in mid 2006. Unable to buy a web domain in Cuba as normal citizens, Sánchez and Escobar reached out for help from a long-time friend based in Germany, who registered the site in his name. Sánchez and Escobar’s site carried a tourism profile, offering intensive Spanish language T 112 courses and tours of Havana and Cuban culture. The site was popular – and profitable. Eventually, the money raised for the site allowed Sanchez to foray into another area – blogging. In April 2007, Sánchez launched her blog, Generación Y, with much trial and error. “I had designed everything with an old version of Dreamweaver on an obsolete laptop that I had bought from a chronic rafter who was in need of a motor for a Chevrolet,” recalled Sánchez in an online interview with Ted Henken, author of the El Yuma blog. “My new ‘site’ lacked a database and did not make use of the magic triad ApachePHP-MySQL that has afforded blogs so much potential. It was like trying to fly to the moon with a rocket made of rocks and tree limbs.” Such a sight would draw attention from even the most remote corners. And draw attention Generación Y did. In December 2007, Generación Y was reborn with more sophisticated tools, including the ability to allow readers to post comments. Sánchez’ success lasted just three months, yet she had already gained a reputation as the most prominent member of Cuba’s independent blogger movement. In mid March 2008, the Cuban government set up a filter to block the domain from Cubans trying to access it from public Internet sites. “If it was already difficult without a blockade, it became impossible with the wall of censorship. Luckily, by that time I had already developed good friendships with various assiduous commentators and readers of the blog. Some of them offered me a hand in solidarity and I decided to trust in this virtual relationship that had developed over the course of a few brief months,” Sánchez told Henken’s readers. “I began to send my texts via e-mail, accompanied by an image which my ‘helpers’ would then publish for me. “A web of citizen solidarity was stitched around me.” That solidarity grew exponentially after the events of 6 November 2009 when Sánchez and fellow bloggers Claudia Cadelo and Orlando Luis Pardo Lazo were abducted and beaten by Cuban authorities while on their way to an anti-violence march in Havana. The three were left lying on a street in Timba. The incident made international news and soon people from all over the world were hearing about the bold blogger from Cuba, who dared to challenge the Revolution by writing about challenges and struggles in Cuba. Readers offered to translate the blog into Dutch, English, Chinese, Portuguese. Today the blog can be read in 17 different languages. Sánchez, webmaster, international columnist and editor of desdecuba.com, is the recipient of numerous awards, including Columbia University’s Maria Moors Cabot Award for excellence in Latin American reporting; the site has also received several notable honours. Months after the attack, Sánchez wrote to President Barack Obama with a list of seven questions, addressing issues that “keep her from sleeping.” To her surprise, Obama responded and praised the blogger for her courage. “It is telling that the Internet has provided you and other courageous Cuban bloggers with an outlet to express yourself so freely, and I applaud your collective efforts to empower fellow Cubans to express themselves through the use of technology,” Obama wrote. “The government and people of the United States join all of you in looking forward to the day all Cubans can freely express themselves in public without fear and without reprisals.” Sánchez shares this sentiment. “Material autonomy is the base upon which citizen autonomy is built,” she says. “This precept is one of the maxims of my life and I will neither be ashamed nor made to feel guilty for having freed myself from paternalism, state dependence and ridiculous subsidies. I aspire to a Cuba where anyone who wishes can have a web domain, pay for it with their work, not be forced to pay any ideological quota to obtain it, and above all neither be accused of being a ‘mercenary’ nor of being constructed by a foreign power for the mere act of refusing to conform to material indigence and technological disability.” LISM.¶WORLD PEACEXIX DEPENDS ONUNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLESANDPEOPLES. IFPEOPLESARE TOUNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER,¶IT2. ISTHE ESSENTIAL THATTHEY HA ED ARTICLE INTHE UNUNIVERSAL DECLARATION OFHUMAN RIGHTS, (DEC. 10,WORLD. 1948). NAME TEPIN TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLESISTOBRING ABOUTUNDERSTANDING AMONGTHE JOURNALISTS OFTHE ¶INACCORDANCE WITHOF THISTHE BEL WARDS THEFOLLOWING OBJECTIVES:¶•THE FURTHERANCE ANDIN SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOMOFTHE PRESS,BYWHICHISMEANT: FREE ACCESSTOTHE FREET GE; INSTITUT INTERNATIONAL DE LAPRESSE, FRENCH; INSTITUTO INTERNACIONAL DELA PRENSA, INOFNEWS, SPANISH PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶LANGUAGES • THE ACHIEVEMENT OFTHE UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SOFRENCH, AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION THE FREETE ITUTE. ¶ 3. THE OFFICIAL OF INSTITUTE SHALL BE ENGLISH, GERMAN AND SPANISH; NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES A HIP PURSUANT SECTION 60 ET SEQ.PEACE OF THE SWISS CIVILPEOPLES CODE.ISBETWEEN THE RESOURCES OF THE INSTIT THEYCORPORATION HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE,TO A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG T ERS AND AND TV SYSTEMS FOUNDATIONS, OTHER INSTITUTIONS SUPPORT TH H THIS BELIEFRADIO THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES:AND ¶ • THEBUSINESSES, FURTHERANCE ANDWHICH SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OFINSTITUTE NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOUR ART THE NETEARNINGS, IFANY, OFTHE SHALL ENURE TOTHE BENEFIT OFOF ANY MEMBEROR INDIVIDUA FUGH: THEOF FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN PUBLICATIONS, SEMINARS, CONFERENCES, EXCHANGE PROGRAMMES, TRAINING COURSES, ACADEMIC ES. IF PEOPLES AREAND TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEPMISSIONS TOWARDS UNDERSTA /OR VIDEOS ELECTRONIC MATERIAL ON THE INTERNET, OFAN DELEGATIONS AND TO CO NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEFTHE THERESENDING IS ESTABLISHED ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW DING OF FREEDOM OFTHESE THE PRESS,PURPOSES, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS,PROMOTE FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREEIN EXPR CARRYING OUT THE INSTITUTE SHALL A FAIR BALANCE OF WOMEN AND MEN IT DINGOR AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONGAND NATIONS.¶ • TH BER NATIONAL COMMITTEE ASSUMES ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL OR OTHERWISE, FOR THE INSTITUTE, THE IN ORLDPEACECOMMITTEE. DEPENDSONUNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLESANDPEOPLES. IFPEOPLES ARETOUNDERSTAND ONEANOTHER, ITISESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVEGOO ATIONAL ¶ARTICLE IIBRING ¶MEMBERSHIP ¶1.FULL MEMBERSHIP OFOF THE ISOPEN TO PERSONS WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS THEINSTITUTE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF T THLY JOURNALS, NEWSAGENCIES ORTV AND RADIOBROADCASTING ORISON THEFREE INTERNET, WHO SUPPO ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THESYSTEMS PRESS, BY WHICH MEANT: ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE T PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶AND • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE E NSTITUTES OBJECTIVES WHO, IN SEEKING MEMBERSHIP, DECLARE FORMALLY AND BY WRITTEN STATEMEN • THE IMPROVEMENT THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ONFOLLOWS: UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ENATIONS.¶ PREAMBLE ABOVE. ¶OF 2. FULL MEMBERSHIP CAN BEACQUIRED AS INCOUNTRIES WHERE THERE AREATN THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG CH ALONE SHALL HAVETHE TOINITIALLY DETERMINE WHETHER OR TOENROLAND THE APPLICANTS. INCO H THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED ANPOWER ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ •NOT THE FURTHERANCE SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURW SHALL BE MADE TO THE INSTITUTE’S DIRECTOR, WHO ALONE SHALL HAVE THE POWER TO INITIALLY DETERMINE FETHE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN ULTIMATE OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶HAVE 3.• THE MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE ON AN INDIVIDUAL BASIS. HOW IF PEOPLES ARE AUTHORITY TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT ISAGENCY, ESSENTIAL THAT THEY GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTA EES. OF A NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NEWS TV OR RADIO BROADCASTING SYSTEM OR AN INTERNET SERVIC AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW NNDING INTERNET SERVICE MAY BE REPRESENTED BYTO MORE THAN FULLOF MEMBER UPPUBLICATION TO A LIMIT TEN. ¶ 5. THER DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS THE NEWS, FREEONE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE OFOF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPR DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGEIN ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • TH CIPLES OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS AND DESIROUS OF CO-OPERATING THE INSTITUTE’S OBJECTIVES, FOR EXAM ORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOO NS, MEMBERS OFJOURNALISM FACULTIES, LAWYERS AND ADVISORS. ¶·ASOF AFFILIATE (LEADING JOUT WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS THE WORLD. MEMBERS ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF DS OFTHE DEPARTMENTS/SECTIONS OF NEWSPAPERS, MAGAZINES, BROADCASTING NEWS EDITORI ARDS FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH ISOR MEANT: FREEAGENCIES, ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE T PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OFPROGRAMME VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREEOE CURRENT AFFAIRS EDITORS OR PRESENTERS, PERSONS HOLDING SIMILAR EDITORIAL POSITIONS NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES A NALISTS GROUP) FROM ANY ONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, RADIO, TV ORGANISATION OR NEWS AGENCY IS N THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG T NTED PROVIDING THE APPLICANTS PROCURE WRITTEN APPROVAL FROM¶THEIR EDITOR-IN-CHIEF. ¶ 6. ASSOCIA H THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE BE EXPRESSION VIEWS. THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOUR ENEWS, AREFREE NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL MADEOF TO THE¶OF•NATIONAL COMMITTEE, WHICH ALONE F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT THE PRACTICES FOR OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN ANTS. IN COUNTRIES WHERE THERE ARE NO NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE ES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEPTO TOWARDS UNDERSTA RMINE WHETHER ORNOT APPLICANTS. INBELIEF ALL CASES, ENROLMENTS ARESUBJECT THETHE ULTIMA NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OFTO THEENROL WORLD. ¶THE IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS FOLLOW ICIPATE IN ALLOFTHE ACTIVITIES OF THEFREE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY HAVE VOTING RIGHTS. DUESFREE FOREXPR AS DING OF FREEDOM THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREESHALL TRANSMISSION OFNO NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF THE NEWSPAPERS, DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SOBE AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREEMEMBERSHIP. EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • TH LIATE MEMBERSHIP SHALL HALF THE DUES FOR ASSOCIATE ¶ IPI CONSTITUTION PAGE 3 ¶ 8. INST ORLD1PEACE DEPENDS ONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEEN PEOPLESANDPEOPLES. PEOPLESARETOUNDERSTAND ONEANOTHER,SCHOOLS ITISESSENTIALAND THATTHEY HAVEGOOO PHS AND 2, TO COMMUNICATIONS DEPARTMENTS OFIFUNIVERSITIES AND COLLEGES, CENTRES WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF D T BROADCASTING FIELDS.INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS MAY INALL THEINSTITUTE’S ACTIVITIES. ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OFPARTICIPATE FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS,THE FREE T PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OFTHE VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION THE FREE E TE AUTHORITY OF EXECUTIVE BOARD. THENUMBER OFTHEIR DELEGATES ISNOT LIMITED. DUES FOROFIFINSTITU • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN¶PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. PEOPLES A YNATIONS.¶ THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS SHALL HAVE NO VOTING RIGHTS. 9. IN SO FAR AS ASSOCIA HAVEEXECUTIVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEPTHE TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG DHTHEY BY BOARD SHALL BE FIXED WITH THE¶AGREEMENT OF THE BOARD. ¶OF10. THE ET THISTHE BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORKBY TOWARDSDIRECTOR THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING FREEDOM UTE WHO SHALLACTOFCONTRARY TOTHEOF PRINCIPLES SETEXPRESSION OUTINTHE PRESENT CONSTITUTION. SUSPENSION A NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION NEWSPAPERS, FREE OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGSTOF JOUR F THEBOARD, FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE ANDSHALL BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OFTWO-THIRDS JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN IVE BUT EXPULSION NOT BE ORDERED EXCEPT ON THE APPROVAL OF OF THE MEM ES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT ISOF ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTAS ON, TOGETHER WITH THE STATEMENT THE ALLEGED CAUSES, SHALL BE GIVEN TO THE MEMBER CONCERNED NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW EDING BOARD SHALL BEPRESS, GRANTED TO SUCHFREE MEMBER, THAT MEMBER SHALLOF SONEWS, DESIRE. ANYMEMBER SOORDERED OF FREEDOM OF THE BY WHICH IS MEANT: ACCESS TOIFTHE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPR DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶CASE • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWSBE AMONG NATIONS.¶ • TH E NEXT GENERAL ASSEMBLY INBETWEEN WHICH APEOPLES. MAJORITY VOTE OF MEMBERS PRESENT SHALL RECOGNISED ORLDPEACEOF DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING PEOPLES AND IFPEOPLES ARE TOUNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, ITISESSENTIAL THATTHEYHAVE GOO MEMBER THE INSTITUTE; NOTICE OF SUCH ACTION SHALL BE GIVEN EITHER TO THE NATIONAL COMMITTEE OR TT WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF OR HIS OBLIGATIONS TO THE INSTITUTE, UP TO THE TIME THAT MEMBER’S RESIGNATION OR EXPULSION BECOMES ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE T RD CONSIDERS THAT THERE FUNDAMENTAL CHANGE INTHEJOURNALISTS CONDITIONS UNDER WHICH•MEMBERSHIP BEE PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THEIS ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ THE PROMOTION OFHAS THE FREE NATIONS.¶ • THETHE IMPROVEMENT OF CONSTITUTION. THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING¶ BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES A RTICLE II OF PRESENT ¶ ARTICLE III ¶ NATIONAL COMMITTEES 1A) SUBJECT TO RECOGNITION THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE,MAY A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING PEOPLES ISWHERE TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG MBLY, ANATIONAL COMMITTEE BE FORMED PROVISIONALLY INAMONG ACOUNTRY THERE AREATOF LEAST FIT H THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING FREEDOM ON. ¶ FREE 1B) SUCH RECOGNITION THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALLOF NOT NECESSARILY IMPLY THAT THE EXECUTIVE NEWS, TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREEBY PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOUR FED THEENJOYS FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS¶ AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN FULL FREEDOM OF THE PRESS. 2. NATIONAL COMMITTEES SHALL ACTIVELY PURSUE THE AIMS OFTH ES. IFON PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER,THE IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEPPRESS TOWARDSOR UNDERSTA AT DEVELOPMENTS AFFECTING PRESS, PARTICULARLY ON THREATS TO FREEDOM OF THE TO TH NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OFYEAR THE WORLD. ¶ INLIMIT. ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED ANBE ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW RD CAN WAIVE THE EIGHT TERM ¶ 3. NATIONAL COMMITTEES MAY ENTRUSTED WITH ADMINISTRA DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPR OLLECTED FOR THE PURPOSES OFPEOPLES.¶ THE INSTITUTE, WITH APPROVAL THE SECRETARIAT. FUND-RAISING DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG • THE PROMOTION OF THE THE FREE EXCHANGE OFOF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ •AC TH PEACEDEPENDSON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES ANDPEOPLES.IFPAGE PEOPLES4ARE TOTHE UNDERSTAND ONEANOTHER, ITISESSENTIAL THATTHEY HAVEGOO LLORLD BE SUBMITTED TO THE DIRECTOR. ¶ IPI CONSTITUTION ¶ 4. EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL HAVE POWER TO WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONGTHE PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THEOBJECTIVES JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE THIS BELIEF T MITTEE IN CASESOBJECTIVES: WHERE EXECUTIVE BOARD CONSIDERS THE OFPARAGRAPH 2ORTO3WITH ABOVE HAV ARDS THE FOLLOWING ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS THE NEWS, FREE T CH ORIGINAL ACCREDITATION OFANATIONAL COMMITTEE HAS BEENGRANTED. ¶DECLARATION OFANATIONAL PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EC NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES AJORITY VOTE OFMEMBERS OFTHE EXECUTIVE BOARD PRESENT. WRITTEN NOTICE THAT SUCH ACTION WILL BEATC THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG OSED ACTION, SHALL BE GIVEN TO THE NATIONAL COMMITTEE CONCERNED SIXTY (60) DAYS BEFORE THE MEE THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TOBOARD, WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM EHNEWS, REPRESENTATIONS THE EXECUTIVE EITHER INWRITING OR¶BY PERSONAL APPEARANCE OFJOUR AM FREE TRANSMISSION OFTO NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. • THETHE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST THE SHALL CONSIDER ¶ A NATIONAL COMMITTEE FROM WHICH RE F THEEXECUTIVE FREE EXCHANGEBOARD OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWSSUCH AMONGREPRESENTATIONS. NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN ES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONEBOARD ANOTHER,TO IT ISBE ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVEHAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTA CLARED BY THE EXECUTIVE INACTIVE SHALL THE RIGHT TO APPEAL TO THE NEXT GENERAL ASS NDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THISTHE BELIEFEXECUTIVE THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW HE FINAL DECISION OF THE INSTITUTE, PROVIDED THAT BOARD MAY AT ANY TIME RESTORE REC DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPR GRAPH, THE SUSPENSIONS OF APEOPLES.¶ NATIONAL COMMITTEE DECISION OF THE TO CONS DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG • THE PROMOTION OF THEOR FREETHE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE ANDEXECUTIVE BALANCED NEWSBOARD AMONG NATIONS.¶ • TH PEACEDEPENDS ONINSTITUTIONAL UNDERSTANDINGBETWEEN PEOPLESAND PEOPLES.COUNTRY IFPEOPLESARETO TOUNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, ITISESSENTIAL THAT THEYHAVEGOO ,ORLD ASSOCIATE AND MEMBERS IN THAT CONTINUE AS MEMBERS OF THE INSTITUTE AN WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONGCOMMITTEE PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OFINACTIVE, THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEFEX T ENSION OF A NATIONAL OR DECLARES A NATIONAL COMMITTEE THE TASKS FORMERLY ARDSARE THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • HOLD THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OFTHE THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS,WOR FREE T EES ENCOURAGED TO THEIR OWN "MEDIA EVENTS" IN FORM OF CONFERENCES, SEMINARS, PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE E AL OR BUSINESS-ORIENTED ISSUE WHICH HAS A BEARING ON EDITORIAL ACTIVITY. THEY ARE ALSO ENCOURAG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES A THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRINGIV ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG VITIES INVOLVE FREEDOM OF EXPRESSION AND/OR FREEDOM OF THE MEDIA. ¶ ARTICLE ¶ IPI COMMITTEES OFTE H THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM AINING THE MEDIA. ¶ 2.FREE THEIR TASKOF SHALL BE TO: ¶ EXPRESSION · ADVISEOF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD ON POLICY ISSUES; ¶ ·A FREETO TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, PUBLICATION NEWSPAPERS, FREE VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOUR ENEWS, SHALL BEMADE UPOFANEWS CHAIRPERSON, PLUS TWODEPUTIES, APPOINTED BYTHEBOARD, REPRES F COMMITTEES THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN ES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDSIN UNDERSTA EDIRECTOR INJOURNALISTS ACCORDANCE WITH¶ITINTHE COMMITTEE’S CHAIRPERSON ORTHEREFORE, ONE OFHER ORHISDEPUTIES. GENE NDING AMONG THE OF THE WORLD. ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED ANESTABLISHED ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW GATORY FOR ALL EXPERTS. ¶ 4. A PERMANENT WORKING COMMITTEE SHALL BE TO OVERSEE THE ACT DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPR E DIRECTOR AND BE USED TO ENABLE IPI MEMBERSHIP FOR EDITORS, MEDIA EXECUTIVES AND ACADEMICS IN THE DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • TH RWISE NOT BE ABLE TO COVERBETWEEN THEIR DUES PARTICIPATE IN OFANOTHER, THE INSTITUTE. PERMANE ORLDPEACE DEPENDS ONUNDERSTANDING PEOPLESAND ANDPEOPLES. IFPEOPLESARE TOACTIVITIES UNDERSTANDONE ITISESSENTIALTHIS THATTHEY HAVEGOO WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TOCONSTITUTION BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF T TS IN SELECTED COUNTRIES. ¶ IPI PAGE 5 ¶ ARTICLE V ¶ GENERAL ASSEMBLIES ¶ 1. GENERAL ASS ARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶MAIN • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT:OF FREETHE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE T BLIES SHALL HAVE THESE FUNCTIONS: ¶ A) INASMUCH AS THE PRIMARY PURPOSE GENERAL ASSEM PERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE E Left: Yoani Sánchez in portrait. Above: Sánchez walking inside her Havana home. Below: Sánchez takes the stage during a performance at the 10th Biennale of Contemporary Art in Havana, 2009. Below left: An injured Sánchez gets assistance from a friend. SES, ACADEMIC MISSIONS TO CO N AND MEN IN IT UTE, AND THE IN ENTOPERSONS NET,WHOSUPPO TENSTATEMEN ERETHEREAREN PLICANTS.INCO LYDETERMINEW TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF N EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSE faraJ NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCO sarKohI EEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE GST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • T EDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPL DERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABO OLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AN XPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF U THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURN GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMEN F THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO W TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF N EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSE NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCO EEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE GST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • T EDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPL DERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABO OLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AN XPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF U THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURN GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMEN F THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO W TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF N EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS IRAN 1947– Faraj Sarkohi has been a key organiser of the Declaration of 134 Writers in Iran. I ranian writers were disappearing under a cloud of terror in the 1990s, leaving others behind to suffer persistent persecution. Desperate to restore freedom of speech and opinion to Iran, Faraj Sarkohi became a key organiser of the 1994 Declaration of 134 Writers, which appealed to the Iranian government to allow expression of beliefs, individual independence and democracy and claimed that “defending the human and civil rights of every writer is, under all circumstances, the professional duty of all writers.” While his wife, Farideh Zebarjad Sarkohi, and two children fled to safety in Germany in 1995, Sarkohi, was threatened, arrested, imprisoned and tortured several times between 1994 and 1996. On 3 November 1996, he vanished. Sarkohi had been waiting at Tehran Mehrabad Airport to board a plane to Hamburg. Alerted to his enigmatic disappearance, international human rights bodies feared the worst. Later Sarkohi reported, “From the very first day they told me: ‘You have been reported missing. It has been made known that you have left the country. You will be kept here in isolation and when the interrogations, the interviews and our inquiries are over, we are going to kill you and bury your body in secret’.” Publically, the Iranian authorities insisted he had flown to Germany; the Germans insisted he had never arrived. A reliable source reported seeing Sarkohi with an Iranian official, which sparked further international demands to know the whereabouts of the press freedom fighter. At a press conference in Toronto his wife, terrified that her husband was dead, compelled Western governments to keep their focus on Iran, and on her husband’s disappearance: “If Faraj is still alive it is only due to these international pressures.” On 20 December, after 48 days, Sarkohi reappeared at a press conference at Tehran airport claiming, unconvincingly, that he had been visiting Germany. Forbidden to leave Iran, on 3 January 1997, he smuggled a letter to his wife, revealing that he had never left Iran; that instead, he had been subjected to intensive interrogation, which included beatings and death threats. “I am writing this note in great haste in the hope that one day someone or some people will read it so that Iranian and international public opinion and especially my loved ones will learn of the terrifying experiences I have had ... a testament to the pain and suffering I have experienced. “I don’t know how long I have. I await imminent arrest or an incident whereby I will be murdered and my death will be presented as a suicide. Torture, prison and death await me.” True to his expectations, Sarkohi was soon arrested again and detained for nine months before going to trial in September 1997; initial sources said he was arrested on charges of espionage, but he was ultimately sentenced to a year’s imprisonment for spreading illegal propaganda and slandering the Islamic Republic. Sarkohi’s nightmare ended on 28 January 1998 when he was released, although when interviewed his wife said she would not be content until he was out of the country: “He has no papers, any document to prove who he is, and in his situation – considering that many Iranian journalists and intellectuals have died in very mysterious circumstances – anything could happen to him.” Finally issued a new passport – his old one had been used fraudulently to send another man to Hamburg in his place on the day of his disappearance – Sarkohi left Iran to live in exile with his family in Germany in May 1998. Born in Shiraz, Iran on 3 November 1947, Sarkohi studied art, sociology and Persian literature at universities in Tehran and Tabriz. During his university years, he found his dissident voice, writing papers and essays that spoke out against censorship and repression. As a member of the student movement opposing Muhammad Reza Shah Pahlavi’s autocratic rule, he was imprisoned in 1969 for a year and then sentenced again for 15 years in 1971. He was released, along with other political prisoners, during the 1979 revolution, having served eight years of his sentence. He founded and edited the independent literary Iranian magazine Adineh in 1985. The magazine soon became crucial reading matter for those both at home and abroad who were opposed to the repressive politics, thanks to its focus on controversial social issues, like the status of women in Iran. For the rebellious articles he wrote, along with his peers, he was branded a ‘cafe-dwelling guerrilla’ by The Identity, a statecontrolled, prime-time television show. Now no longer living under imminent threat, Sarkohi continues to battle resolutely for freedom of expression in Iran. In 2007, he wrote regular book reports for Radio Farda in which he commented that “under Ahmadinejad there has been an increase in the intensity and recklessness of censorship.” From his home in Germany he serves on the board of advisors at the Middle East Media Research Institute, which aims to bridge the language gap between the West and the Middle East. He continues to defend press freedom and the right to write. 115 NedIm Şener TURKEY 1966– a s an investigative journalist working on corruption, organised crime and money laundering, Nedim Şener’s main motivation has always been to reveal to the public the realities that others try to hide. Born in Germany on 28 November 1966, Şener studied for his master’s degree in Economics at Istanbul University before joining the Turkish national newspaper Dünya and later the daily national newspaper Milliyet in 1994 as a news reporter. Although he started out reporting on the financial markets and agriculture, Şener chose to pursue writing and reporting on poverty and corruption. Believing that journalists in Turkey have great influence, he started working in investigative journalism. By his own admission, he was curious, determined and stubborn. Şener developed a reputation as a leading investigative journalist in Turkey, uncovering corruption, raising the ire of the Turkish authorities and finding himself in the dock for his writing. Always taking his readers seriously and reporting with utmost care and accuracy, he is well respected by the wider Turkish journalist community for being noncommittal to any side or group and approaching every event fair-mindedly and from the aspect of the victim. He defines it as the motto for his professional life. His most famous piece of writing to date is “Dink Murder and Intelligence Lies,” a book on the murder of fellow Turkish IPI World Press Freedom Hero, Hrant Dink. Because of it Şener faced trial in Turkey, accused of multiple charges: targeting the persons who have taken responsible tasks in the fight against terrorism, identifying people as targets for terror organisations, obtaining secret information, revealing secret information, violating communication privacy and attempting to affect a fair trial. 116 Through his investigations for the book, Şener uncovered the truth behind the preparation, implementation, investigation and adjudication of Dink’s murder, drawing attention to the roles played by official staff. Şener’s investigative writing showed that the murder had been professionally planned well in advance, blowing the cover of officials at the National Intelligence Organisation who threatened the Turkish-Armenian editor in 2004. Furthermore, he revealed that the police investigating the Dink murder case also played a role in Dink’s death, indicating that the head of the Directorate of Security Affairs attempted to blur the evidence, while at the same time investigating the murder. Name by name, Şener showed the Turkish public that not only the Istanbul Police Department, but also the Trabzon and Ankara Intelligence departments, the National Intelligence Organisation and Gendarmerie Organisation shared responsibility for Dink’s untimely death. Not surprisingly, the reality revealed by Nedim Şener disturbed the police. A number of senior police chiefs launched legal complaints. The prosecutors called for a 28 year sentence to be imposed on Şener, and in another, separate case for a sentence of four years and six months, for publishing diagrams showing the relations between the Ergenekon suspects (an alleged secret ultra-nationalist group with links to the Turkish military and security forces) and the Dink murder in his book. Thus, Şener faced a total requested prison sentence of 32 years and six months, whilst Dink’s murderer faced only 20 years in prison. Şener’s trial gained the attention of several international organisations which urged the Turkish authorities to drop the charges against him. He was eventually acquitted in June 2010, after a year-long trial. It can clearly be put that Şener’s main success in the scope of the Dink murder was in changing the perception of Dink’s assassination. He claimed that the facts were blurred in the case and perverted the course of justice. Furthermore, the Dink case helped bring together other families who had been denied justice. A civil platform was formed, which named itself “We are Dink’s deep family.” Thanks to Şener’s work, published not only in his book but also in Milliyet, where he still works as a reporter, newspapers and TV stations no longer view Dink’s murder through a narrow window. Originally, only the group who committed the murder and the negligent gendarmerie were considered responsible. Now it is acknowledged that other official agencies were also involved. Nedim Şener is now accepted and called on as an expert on this issue. Şener’s work has gained him a host of awards and accolades. The Publishers’ Association of Turkey honoured him with the Freedom of Thought and Expression award and the Turkish Journalists’ Association (TGC) bestowed upon him the 2009 Press Freedom Award. And in 2010, he was awarded the Abdi İpekçi Journalist of the Year award, named after another fellow Turkish IPI World Press Freedom Hero. Besides his investigative reporting and writing, which includes several other books, Şener holds a Ph.D. in economics from Istanbul University and writes a column in Posta, Turkey’s largest-selling daily newspaper. He confesses, frankly, that he is scared but feels that he has to reveal the facts. Neither the courts nor the threats he has faced have been able to stop him from being an investigative journalist. Written with contributions from Yurdanur Atadan, secretary of the Turkish IPI National Committee. TEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAM WARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVE ERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF T THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. TH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEW F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURAT S. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND O DING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS O DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTA WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG P RDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ ERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF T THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. TH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEW SM. ¶ ARTICLE I ¶ GENERAL ¶ 1. THE ORGANISATION DEFENDS EVERYONE’S PERSON EDINARTICLEXIXINTHEUNUNIVERSALDECLARATIONOFHUMANRIGHTS,(DEC.1 GE;INSTITUTINTERNATIONALDELAPRESSE,INFRENCH;INSTITUTOINTERNACION ITUTE. ¶ 3. THE OFFICIAL LANGUAGES OF THE INSTITUTE SHALL BE ENGLISH, FRENC HIP CORPORATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 60 ET SEQ. OF THE SWISS CIVIL CODE. T ERS AND RADIO AND TV SYSTEMS FOUNDATIONS, OTHER INSTITUTIONS AND BUSI ARTOFTHENETEARNINGS,IFANY,OFTHEINSTITUTESHALLENURETOTHEBENEFITO UGH: PUBLICATIONS, SEMINARS, CONFERENCES, EXCHANGE PROGRAMMES, TRA /OR VIDEOS AND ELECTRONIC MATERIAL ON THE INTERNET, THE SENDING OF DELEG CARRYING OUT THESE PURPOSES, THE INSTITUTE SHALL PROMOTE A FAIR BALAN BER OR NATIONAL COMMITTEE ASSUMES ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL OR OTHERWISE, FO ATIONALCOMMITTEE.¶ARTICLEII¶MEMBERSHIP¶1.FULLMEMBERSHIPOFTHEIN THLYJOURNALS,NEWSAGENCIESORTVANDRADIOBROADCASTINGSYSTEMSORO NSTITUTESOBJECTIVESANDWHO,INSEEKINGMEMBERSHIP,DECLAREFORMALLY EPREAMBLEABOVE.¶2.FULLMEMBERSHIPCANBEACQUIREDASFOLLOWS:INCO CHALONESHALLHAVETHEPOWERTOINITIALLYDETERMINEWHETHERORNOTTOE SHALLBEMADETOTHEINSTITUTE’SDIRECTOR,WHOALONESHALLHAVETHEPOW E ULTIMATE AUTHORITY OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶ 3. MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE O E OF A NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NEWS AGENCY, TV OR RADIO BROADCASTING SYS N INTERNET SERVICE MAY BE REPRESENTED BY MORE THAN ONE FULL MEMBER UP CIPLESOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESSANDDESIROUSOFCO-OPERATINGINTHEINSTIT NS,MEMBERSOFJOURNALISMFACULTIES,LAWYERSANDADVISORS.¶·ASAFFILIA DS OF DEPARTMENTS/SECTIONS OF NEWSPAPERS, MAGAZINES, BROADCASTING O CURRENTAFFAIRSPROGRAMMEEDITORSORPRESENTERS,PERSONSHOLDINGSIM NALISTS GROUP) FROM ANY ONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, RADIO, TV ORGANISA NTED PROVIDING THE APPLICANTS PROCURE WRITTEN APPROVAL FROM THEIR ED E ARE NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BE MADE TO THE NATIONAL ANTS.INCOUNTRIESWHERETHEREARENONATIONALCOMMITTEES,APPLICATION RMINEWHETHERORNOTTOENROLTHEAPPLICANTS.INALLCASES,ENROLMENTS ICIPATE IN ALL THE ACTIVITIES OF THE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY SHALL HAVE NO VOTI LIATEMEMBERSHIPSHALLBEHALFTHEDUESFORASSOCIATEMEMBERSHIP.¶IPIC PHS 1 AND 2, TO COMMUNICATIONS DEPARTMENTS OF UNIVERSITIES AND COLLEG BROADCASTINGFIELDS.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSMAYPARTICIPATEINALLTHEIN TEAUTHORITYOFTHEEXECUTIVEBOARD.THENUMBEROFTHEIRDELEGATESISNO YTHEEXECUTIVEBOARD.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSSHALLHAVENOVOTINGRIGH D BY THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL BE FIXED BY THE DIRECTOR WITH THE AGREEME UTEWHOSHALLACTCONTRARYTOTHEPRINCIPLESSETOUTINTHEPRESENTCONS IVE BOARD, BUT EXPULSION SHALL NOT BE ORDERED EXCEPT ON THE APPROVAL ON, TOGETHER WITH THE STATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED CAUSES, SHALL BE GIVEN T EBOARDSHALLBEGRANTEDTOSUCHMEMBER,IFTHATMEMBERSHALLSODESIRE E NEXT GENERAL ASSEMBLY IN WHICH CASE A MAJORITY VOTE OF MEMBERS PRE MEMBEROFTHEINSTITUTE;NOTICEOFSUCHACTIONSHALLBEGIVENEITHERTOTH ORHISOBLIGATIONSTOTHEINSTITUTE,UPTOTHETIMETHATMEMBER’SRESIGNAT RDCONSIDERSTHATTHEREISFUNDAMENTALCHANGEINTHECONDITIONSUNDER RTICLEIIOFTHEPRESENTCONSTITUTION.¶ARTICLEIII¶NATIONALCOMMITTEES¶1 MBLY,ANATIONALCOMMITTEEMAYBEFORMEDPROVISIONALLYINACOUNTRYW ON. ¶ 1B) SUCH RECOGNITION BY THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL NOT NECESSARILY EDENJOYSFULLFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS.¶2.NATIONALCOMMITTEESSHALLACT ATONDEVELOPMENTSAFFECTINGTHEPRESS,PARTICULARLYONTHREATSTOFRE RDCANWAIVETHEEIGHTYEARTERMLIMIT.¶3.NATIONALCOMMITTEESMAYBEEN OLLECTED FOR THE PURPOSES OF THE INSTITUTE, WITH THE APPROVAL OF THE SEC LLBESUBMITTEDTOTHEDIRECTOR.¶IPICONSTITUTIONPAGE4¶4.THEEXECUTIVEB MITTEEINCASESWHERETHEEXECUTIVEBOARDCONSIDERSTHEOBJECTIVESOFPA CHORIGINALACCREDITATIONOFANATIONALCOMMITTEEHASBEENGRANTED.¶D Nedim Şener speaks to the media after his trial in Istanbul, June 2009. SES, ACADEMIC LECTURE MISSIONS TO COUNTRIES arun N AND MEN IN ITS STRUCT shourIe UTE, AND THE INSTITUTE ENTOPERSONSWITHRES NET,WHOSUPPORTTHEPR a TENSTATEMENTTHEIRW ERETHEREARENATIONAL PLICANTS.INCOUNTRIES LYDETERMINEWHETHER UAL BASIS. HOWEVER, IF TERNET SERVICE. ¶ 4. A N F TEN. ¶ 5. THERE SHALL B TIVES,FOREXAMPLE,THE (LEADINGJOURNALISTS NCIES, EDITORIAL WRITE ALPOSITIONSONINTERNE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UN EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOU S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAME NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION EEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICAT GST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANC EDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITIS DERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN A OLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: F XPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEO GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING AB F THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE A TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UN EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOU S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAME NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION EEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICAT GST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANC EDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITIS DERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN A OLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: F XPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEO GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING AB F THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE A TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UN EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOU S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAME NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION EEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICAT GST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANC EDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITIS DERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN A OLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: F XPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEO GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING AB F THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE A TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UN EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOU S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAME NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION EEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICAT GST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANC EDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITIS DERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN A OLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: F XPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEO GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING AB F THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE A TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UN EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOU S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAME NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION EEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICAT GST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANC EDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITIS DERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN A OLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: F XPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEO GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING AB F THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE A TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UN EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOU S ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAME NG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION Arun Shourie, pictured, said: “Criticising a government and pillorying it is most certainly not ‘anti-national.’ It is the media’s job to keep governments on their toes … Correspondingly, it is the job of governments to explain the reasons that have led them to a policy or measure.” INDIA 1941– run Shourie has been compared to a racehorse, described variously as a pioneer, a crusader and a muckraker. He has also been identified at various times as a journalist, author, columnist, editor, politician and administrator. In his own words, according to the 1982 Magsaysay Award citation, he describes himself as “a concerned citizen employing his pen as an effective adversary of corruption, inequality and injustice.” The one label that cannot be denied him, though, is that of the journalist who forever changed the landscape of journalism in the country that he served: India. Shourie was born in 1941. His family, along with other Hindu families in the city at the time, was moved across the border into India, where his father started work in the Punjabi city of Jalandhar. “I have been very fortunate, meaning I have not had to struggle with poverty, so to say. I am the son of a very honest civil servant, a very creative one,” says Shourie. “But I struggled against authority, which would mean governments, dominant intellectual fashions, etc.” Shourie’s real ‘struggle,’ however, was not to begin until many years later. He had a privileged childhood, attending a progressive school in the Indian capital Delhi, before going on to study at Delhi’s St. Stephen’s College and then on to Syracuse University in New York. In 1966, he joined the World Bank as an economist, a job he was to stay in for 11 years. In 1975, Indian Prime Minister Indira Gandhi invoked Article 352 of the Indian Constitution to declare an internal emergency that, in her own words, “brought democracy to a grinding halt.” The Emergency, as it became known, heralded an intense crackdown on civil liberties and the free press, and its wrath descended heavily on the paper Shourie was later to head, the Indian Express. In 1979, he accepted an offer to become Executive Editor of the Indian Express. The magazine India Today praised Shourie for giving the paper “not just a new look but a conscience.” Tehelka magazine wrote: “Shourie’s years as an editor shone with inspiration: he was a lighthouse in a dark time.” Shourie instigated a series of high-profile exposés at the Indian Express, many of which he wrote, unmasking corruption at the highest levels of government and sparking major scandals, including one dubbed ‘India’s Watergate.’ “It is nobody’s case that the press should not be critical,” Shourie said in a 2010 interview. “Criticising a government and pillorying it is most certainly not ‘anti-national.’ It is the media’s job to keep governments on their toes … Correspondingly, it is the job of governments to explain the reasons that have led them to a policy or measure.” In 1981, Shourie started a crusade against Abdul Rahman Antulay, who extorted millions of dollars from businesses dependent on state resources and deposited the money in a trust named after Indira Gandhi. The story led to the resignation of the state governor, the highestranking official in India ever forced from office by newspaper reporting, and was of great embarrassment to Gandhi and her ruling Congress Party. Also in 1981, under Shourie’s editorship, an Indian Express reporter purchased a young girl to highlight the trafficking of women. In 1982, government pressure led to Shourie’s dismissal from the newspaper. Between 1982 and 1986, Shourie wrote for various newspapers and magazines. He was appointed executive editor of The Times of India in 1986 but returned to the Indian Express in 1987. That same year, the Express broke the story of an incident that has passed into collective Indian memory as the Bhagalpur Blindings, where policemen in the city of Bhagalpur blinded 33 prisoners by pouring acid into their eyes. The reports by the Express were accepted by the Supreme Court as a writ petition. The case ended in a judgement that became a landmark precedent in Indian legal history. Among the many battles Shourie fought for press freedom, perhaps the most famous was his crusade against the government’s proposal in 1988 to introduce a defamation bill. It was widely perceived that the bill had been introduced to parliament with unusual speed in an attempt to muzzle the Indian Express, and the entire media community joined Shourie and the Indian Express in condemning the move. At one stage, there were 300 cases filed by the government against the Express, and the paper’s credit supply from banks was cut off. Shourie, however, continued his battle against government corruption until 1990, when differences on editorial policy forced him to resign from the paper. After that, he devoted his energy to writing books and regular columns that appeared in 30 newspapers throughout India. His writings have gained him a vast following, as well as many enemies, across the country. Shourie, who was India’s minister of disinvestment for many years, has earned many national and international awards, including the World Press Review’s International Editor of the Year and the Freedom to Publish Award of the Indian Federation of Publishers. He continues to be one of the most respected and revolutionary figures in Indian journalism. 119 andré sIBomana RWANDA 1954–1998 120 a ndré Sibomana, editor of Rwanda’s oldest newspaper, was widely known and respected as a principal human rights activist in his country before, during, and after the 1994 Rwandan genocide. In a nation whose political regime violated the most basic human rights on an enormous scale, Sibomana devoted his life to helping the voiceless while fearlessly denouncing the injustices facilitated by Rwandan authorities. He faced many death threats and assassination attempts in order to publicly condemn the organised murder of more than half a million ethnic Tutsis and moderate Hutus by the Hutu majority. Sibomana later became an outspoken critic of human rights abuses by the new Tutsiled government, which remained intolerant of investigative reporting and political dissent. Born in the central Rwandan town of Masango on 21 July 1954, Sibomana took the path toward priesthood. He trained at the Nyakibanda Major Seminary and was ordained as a Roman Catholic priest in 1980. Following a period of journalism coursework at the Catholic University of Lyon, France, Sibomana became the director and editor of the Roman Catholic newspaper Kinyamateka, in 1988. As the only private newspaper in Rwanda, Kinyamateka was published in the national language and circulated widely via the network of parish churches. Strong-willed, Sibomana was determined to promote legitimate, systematic journalism via Kinyamateka with no guarantee of freedom of expression from the Rwandan government. Known as “the father of journalism” to many of his contemporaries, Sibomana was among a handful of brave journalists who remained in Rwanda after the first few days of violence of the 1994 genocide had ensued, despite the fact that most reputable journalists were either killed or forced to flee the country. By April 1994, Kinyamateka had to stop publishing after one of its journalists and several employees were killed and the newspaper offices were badly damaged during the substantial fighting. The newspaper recommenced publication in December of that same year, even in the face of direct and indirect pressures placed on the Kinyamateka staff. NGST JOURNA SM. ¶ ARTICLE EDINARTICLE GE;INSTITUTI ITUTE. ¶ 3. THE HIP CORPORA ERS AND RAD ARTOFTHENE Despite being of Hutu ethnic origin, Sibomana publicly criticised the ‘hate media’ that was fostered by the Rwandan government to promote anti-Tutsi propaganda and facilitate support for the slaughter of the minority Tutsis. Sibomana’s publication remained highly influential and acted as a powerful opponent to the surplus of anti-Tutsi propaganda despite multiple death threats and arrests of the staff. In addition to his work as a journalist and a priest, Sibomana served for several years as the chairman of both the Association of Rwandan Journalists and the Association for the Defense of Human Rights and Public Freedoms, where he worked endlessly to encourage investigation into reports of human rights violations committed by state authorities and armed opposition groups. His pursuits acted as matters of the ethical preservation of human rights, rather than for the purpose of maintaining loyalty to strict political or ethnic allegiances. Sibomana’s unwillingness to adhere to the Hutu portrayal of the genocide as a resolute battle between good and evil showed him to be a man who had fought for the rights of all Rwandan citizens, regardless of their gender, background, ethnic group or profession. In October 1997, Sibomana resigned as editor of Kinyamateka. He died on 9 March 1998 in the Rwandan city of Kabgayi, after the government refused to let him travel to Europe for medical treatment. In a letter dated 4 March, which reached Europe only after his death, he issued a final denunciation of the violence and human rights violations in his country, promising that if he survived, he would “call to account those who have refused to respect fundamental human rights.” Although André Sibomana can never be replaced, the memory of this extraordinary man functions to inspire people from inside and outside Rwanda who are committed to rebuilding respect for inalienable rights within the country. TEPTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGABOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTHEJ WARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEANDSAFEGUARDINGOFFREEDOMOFTHE ERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALIST NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UND THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AM THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN S. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMAT DING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTA DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISS DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDE WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOUR RDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE P ERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALIST NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UND THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AM THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN S. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMAT DING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTA DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISS DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDE WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOUR RDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE P ERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALIST NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UND THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AM THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN S. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMAT DING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTA DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISS DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDE WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOUR RDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE P ERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALIST NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UND THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AM THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS F THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMEN S. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMAT DING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTA DING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISS DING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE ORLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDE WARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOUR RDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE P ERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALIST NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UND THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AM THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI André Sibomana was editor of Rwanda’s oldest newspaper, Kinyamateka, and was widley respected as a principal human rights activist before, during and after the 1994 genocide. ANT:FREEACCESS U AND SO AMONG PE thaung E DEPENDS ON UND AL STEP TOWARDS ORGANISATION TO RANSMISSION OF N OMOTION OF THE F BETWEEN PEOPLE INGAMONGPEOPL RDS THE FOLLOWIN LICATION OF NEWS OF ACCURATE AND ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTA ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG P S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLIS ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN . THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTA ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG P S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLIS ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN . THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTA ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG P S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLIS ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN . THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTA ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG P S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLIS ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN . THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTA ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG P S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCEU WITH THIS Thaung, third from BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLIS ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO FREE TRANSMISSION OF left,THE picturedNEWS, with S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OFPressTHE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC fellow World OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN Freedom Heroes during the IPI WorldAMONG THE JOURNALISTS . THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING Press Freedom ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OFHeroes FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY awardAMONGST ceremony in EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING JOURNALISTS AND SO A Boston, 2000. RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTA ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG P S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLIS ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAN . THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO A RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTA ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG P S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATION.T BURMA 1926–2008 B urmese monarchs of the past once lauded the enriching powers they believed that writing possessed, considering it powerful and important to the country’s rich culture. Newspaper editors were often entertained at the palace of the last monarch, King Mindon. Yet now the country is one of the world’s most secretive. “Throughout the Burmese struggles against British rule, all the political issues, movements, meetings, demonstrations, riots, rebellions and even the revolutions were instigated, inspired, influenced and led by newspapers,” U Thaung gently recalled. Born on 4 October 1926, the childhoodnamed Tin Maung blossomed into the heroic writer and crusader Kyemon U Thaung. He began his journalism career as a reporter for The Burma Times in Rangoon a year before Burma freed itself from British rule in 1948. He committed to reporting what was true and credible, a stance which saw U Thaung promoted to chief editor by 1951 at the tender age of 25. The Burmese media aligned with the groups opposed to the Anti-Facist People’s Freedom League, which dominated the new parliament. Through Kyemon (The Mirror), the paper he founded in 1957, U Thaung was actively critical of the socialist government but remained aware of the risks he took in his battle to maintain press freedom: “When General Ne Win took power in 1958, the first thing he did was build a concentration camp on a far-away island in the ocean to tyrannise the Communists and dissidents ... More than 40 per cent of the victims were writers and journalists.” In 1960, best-selling Kyemon, regarded as an ‘enemy of the people,’ was first confiscated; in 1964 it was nationalised following the general election in which Prime Minister U Nu secured an overwhelming majority. At the same time, U Thaung and three of his editorial staff were imprisoned for three years without trial. “Political prisoners were kept incommunicado,” U Thaung said. “Spouses did not know when their husbands would come back, and faced great hardship outside the jails ... About half of the prisoners’ marriages were destroyed. Mine was one of them.” While only temporarily thwarting U Thaung’s crusade, General Ne Win had destroyed his marriage. After toppling the civilian government, run by U Nu, in a bloodless coup, General Ne Win opted to keep his enemies close: he pardoned U Thaung in 1967 and employed him at the Ministry for Information. As deputy director of the ministry, U Thaung often had words dictated to him and manipulated. U Thaung remembered the minister of finance’s answer when he commented on the “devaluation” of the kyat: “No! No! You must not use that word. Use the word ‘re-valued,’ ” U Thaung was told. U Thaung’s continued condemnation of the revolutionary government meant his writing licence was soon revoked, but he was ‘permitted’ to travel to the United States as a writer for a small newspaper, The Missourian, in Washington, Missouri, in 1977. Away from the junta government and liberated in the land where freedom of speech is a constitutional right, he wrote a damning, revealing article in The Reader’s Digest exposing the conditions he had endured during his three years in prison. As a result, the Burmese authorities revoked his passport. Essentially exiled, U Thaung was granted political asylum by the United States’ government. Writing as Aung Bala, his war of words continued – composing copious articles and essays, taking part in pro-democracy meetings around the world and publishing 30 books, including the best-sellers “General Ne Win and His Executioner” (1990) and “A Journalist, a General and an Army in Burma (1995).” In support of his homeland, renamed Myanmar in 1989, U Thaung was chief editor at New Era Journal, which was U.S.-produced, Thailandprinted, and clandestinely disseminated in Myanmar. Involved also with Radio Free Asia and as an honorary member of the Burma Media Association (BMA), U Thaung considered the preparations for Burma’s future press freedom: “Today that is not possible under the military regime, but there will come a day when a new government takes power. We must prepare ourselves to demand that freedom of speech be respected and develop our skills as journalists. BMA is an organization that will accomplish these goals.” In an interview with the BBC World Service in 2004, U Thaung was asked how press freedom could return to Burmese soil. “First of all, release all the political prisoners; allow press freedom; let privately-owned newspapers operate freely and independently – only then can the country transform into a democratic one,” he said. “Otherwise there won’t be any hope as long as the Burmese generals meddle and control the media, and political prisoners are still behind bars.” When he died at age 82 on 3 April 2008 in Fort Lauderdale, Florida, U Thaung left behind an inspired generation of Burmese fighting for the right to a voice, all harbouring the hope that one day the art of credible writing will once again be free. 123 M. ¶ ARTICLE I ¶ GENE JaCoBo DINARTICLEXIXINTHtImerman E;INSTITUTINTERNA UTE. ¶ 3. THE OFFICIA HIP CORPORATION PU d RS AND RADIO AND T RTOFTHENETEARNIN UGH: PUBLICATIONS, OR VIDEOS AND ELECT ARRYING OUT THESE ER OR NATIONAL COM TIONALCOMMITTEE. HLYJOURNALS,NEW PTOWARDSUNDERSTANDINGAMONGPEOPLESISTOBRINGAB ARDSTHEFOLLOWINGOBJECTIVES:¶•THEFURTHERANCEAND RS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDE ATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALI HEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK EWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AM IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIA DING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDA NG OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACC NG AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE P RLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESA ARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT U DS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND S RS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDE ATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALI HEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK EWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AM IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIA DING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDA NG OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACC NG AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE P RLDPEACEDEPENDSONUNDERSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESA ARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT U DS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND S RS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDE ATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALI HEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK EWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEW THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AM IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIA DING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDA Jacobo Timerman, above and right, founded La Opinión newspaper. ARGENTINA 1923–1999 uring Argentina’s ‘Dirty War’ that stretched from 1976 to 1983, tens of thousands of political dissidents, known as desaparecidos (“the disappeared”), vanished from the streets, victims of a military regime that routinely kidnapped, falsely imprisoned and killed those who campaigned against the widespread human rights abuses in the country. Unlike the vast majority of desaparecidos who were never heard from again, Jacobo Timerman, a journalist and author, lived to tell his story, his harrowing stint in Argentine secret prisons serving as the subject of his seminal work, “Prisoner Without a Name, Cell Without a Number.” Timerman’s tale of electric shock torture, beatings and solitary confinement sparked international outrage and intensified pressure on the Argentine government to bring an end to the war. The book, along with his work for La Opinión, the now-defunct liberal daily he founded in 1971, spotlighted the plight of the persecuted in Argentina and demanded justice for those whose voices had been silenced. Born on 6 January 1923 in Bar, Ukraine, Timerman immigrated to Argentina with his family five years later to escape the pogroms. Though he was fond of saying, “I did not become a journalist, I was born one,” Timerman actually began his studies in engineering before the political turmoil in Argentina prompted him to switch his focus to journalism in the 1940s. He founded several publications before finding success in 1962 with the newsmagazine Primera Plana, which he modelled on Newsweek and Time. Timerman’s inspiration for La Opinión was Paris’ Le Monde. The paper took a strong stance against human rights abuses committed by those on both the right and the left. The paper’s investigative reporting targeted government corruption, state-sponsored anti-Semitism and repression. In addition to Argentina, Timerman’s editorials condemned similar abuse in Cuba, the Soviet Union, Chile and Israel. He published the names of the desaparecidos in the paper, using its pages to criticise the regime of Isabel Peron, who assumed power after her husband’s death in 1974. Timerman, who supported Juan Peron, advocated for the overthrowing of Isabel’s government by the military in 1976. The paper’s campaign against the government’s violence and economic policies drew the ire of the regime. La Opinión’s offices were bombed as was Timerman’s home. The paper was closed down several times between 1973 and 1976 and was eventually shut down by the Argentine government in 1977. In April of that year, armed military agents surrounded Timerman’s home and arrested him. He was held for two and a half years – first in secret prisons in which he was interrogated, tortured and held in solitary confinement – and later under house arrest. Timerman was held despite ever being formally charged. As the result of mounting international pressure on the government, Timerman was released in 1980. He was stripped of his Argentine citizenship and his property and forced into exile. That same year, Timerman was awarded the Golden PEN of Freedom by the World Association of Newspapers for his courage in defending press freedom. In 1981, he received both the Letelier-Moffitt Human Rights Award from the Institute for Policy Studies and the Conscience-in-Media Award from the American Society of Journalists and Authors. Timerman also helped found the Asociacion para la Defensa del Periodismo, an independent press freedom group. Timerman and his family settled in Israel, where he continued to provoke the establishment with his 1982 book “The Longest War,” a blistering criticism of Israel’s occupation of Lebanon. Despite being a fervent Zionist, Timerman decried the invasion and what he viewed as the unjust treatment of Palestinians. In 1984, with democracy restored in Argentina, Timerman returned. He sued the government for his stolen property, including the paper which had been sold in his absence for $5 million (USD). He won damages from the government in an equal amount. Two years later, he testified at the trial of the former military leaders responsible for his imprisonment, including General Ramon Camps, whom Timerman described as a “lunatic, paranoid assassin.” Camps was convicted on 73 counts of torture and sentenced to 25 years in prison. Timerman eventually took over as editor of the daily La Razon, running into trouble with the establishment yet again when he was sued for libel and defamation in 1988 by Carlos Saul Menem, then governor of Rioja province and a presidential candidate. Timerman was acquitted in two separate trials, prompting Menem, who was by then president, to have the Supreme Court of Argentina reopen the case. Timerman fled to Uruguay and the charges were eventually dropped. Timerman wrote another book, “Chile: Death in the South,” in 1988 along with a host of newspaper and magazine articles. He had begun work on his memoirs, writing out passages longhand, but he never finished. Timerman died of a heart attack in his Buenos Aires home on 11 November 1999. He was 76. 125 ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ •WITH THE F MISSIONS TO COUNTRIES ANDTOWARDS GOVERNMENTS, AND COLLABORATION FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, EXPRESSION¶OF ¶ • THE ACH NEWS, AND MEN IN ITS STRUCTURES AND INFREE ITS ACTIVITIES. IPIVIEWS. CONSTITUTION UTE, INSTITUTE ASSUMES NO LIABILITY, LEGAL OR OTHERWISE, RATEAND ANDTHE BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THEFOR PRA ENONE TOPERSONS WITH RESPONSIBILITIES FOR EDITORIAL ORNEWSPOLICY IN ND ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFO NET, SUPPORT THE PRINCIPLEOF FREEDOM OFTHE PRESS ANDDESIREAN TO STEN OFWHO THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED STATEMENT THEIR WILLINGNESS TOWORK FOR THE ACHIEVEMENT OFP S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS ERE THERE AREPEOPLES.¶ NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALLBEOF MADE TOT ND SO AMONG • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE ACCURAT PLICANTS.BETWEEN INCOUNTRIES WHERE THERE ARE NONATIONAL COMMITTEES,ON AP RSTANDING PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND LYDETERMINE WHETHER ORNOT TOENROLTHEAMONG APPLICANTS. INALLCASES, E NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING THE JOURNALISTS OF T UAL¶ •BASIS. HOWEVER, IFAND A NATIONAL COMMITTEE SO DECIDES MEMBERSHIP ES: THE FURTHERANCE SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WH TERNET SERVICE. ¶ 4. A NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, NEWS AGENCY, TV OR RAD S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OFBE UNDERSTANDING AMONGSTMEMBERS JOURNALISTS AND SO AM FOF TEN. ¶ 5. THERE SHALL ELIGIBLE AS ASSOCIATE INDIVIDUALS THEFOR PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ONMEMBERS: UNDERSTANDIN TIVES, EXAMPLE, THESE MAY INCLUDE: ¶ · AS ASSOCIATE EXEC N.(LEADING THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLE JOURNALISTS GROUP): PERSONS OPERATINGOBJECTIVES: INJOURNALISTIC C ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING ¶ • THE F NCIES, EDITORIAL WRITERS, COPY EDITORS, BUREAU CHIEFS, CORRESPOND EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ •AND THE ACH ALPOSITIONSONINTERNETSERVICES.¶THENUMBEROFASSOCIATE AFF RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRA WS AGENCY IS NOT LIMITED. AFFILIATE MEMBERSHIP (LEADING JOURNALIS ND¶ONE ANOTHER, ITAND IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFO EF. 6. ASSOCIATE AFFILIATE MEMBERSHIP CAN BE ACQUIRED AS FOLLO WHICH SHALL HAVE THE POWER TO INITIALLY DETERMINE WHETHER S OF THEALONE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN RSHIP SHALLISBE MADEFREE TOTHE INSTITUTE’S DIRECTOR, WHOALONESHALL HAV S,TO BYTHE WHICH MEANT: ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS ULTIMATE AUTHORITY OFTHEEXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶7.ASSOCIATE AN ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURAT HE DUES FOR ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE HALF THE DUES FOR FULL M RSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ON PAGE 3¶8.IS INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERSHIP SHALL BEOPEN UNDER THECONDI NG PEOPLES TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF T AND CENTRES OF JOURNALISM, PRESS INSTITUTES AND JOURNALISTS’ ORG ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OFTO FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BYMEM WH CTIVITIES. THE DIRECTOR SHALL HAVE POWER ENROL INSTITUTIONAL S.ES ¶ •FOR THEINSTITUTIONAL ACHIEVEMENT OFMEMBERS UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AM SHALL BE FIXED BY THE DIRECTOR IN ACCO OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACEDUES DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDIN AR AS ASSOCIATE MEMBERS ARE CONCERNED, FOR CERTAIN CATEGOR N.ARD. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLE ¶ 10. THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL HAVE POWER TO SUSPEND OR EXPE ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE F SPENSION OF A MEMBER MAY BE ORDERED BY A MAJORITY VOTE OF THE MEM EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACH DS OF THE MEMBERS PRESENT OF THE BOARD. ¶ 11. WRITTEN NOTICE OF THE RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRA R CONCERNED SIXTY (60) DAYS PREVIOUS TO THE MEETING OF THE EXECUTI ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEYBY HAVE INFORMATION. RSO ORDERED SUSPENDED OREXPELLED THEGOOD EXECUTIVE BOARDTHEREFO SHALLH SEOF THE WORLD.AS ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITHOF THIS BELIEF THERE IS¶ESTABLISHED AN RECOGNISED THE FINAL DECISION THE INSTITUTE. 12. ANY MEMBE S, BY WHICHOR IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TOANY THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS OMMITTEE TOTHEDIRECTOR. ¶13. MEMBER RESIGNING OREXPELLED SION EFFECTIVE. ¶14. MEMBERSHIP SHOULD BECANCELLED INCAS ND SOBECOMES AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURAT ERSHIPHAS BEENGRANTED AND WHERE THESE CHANGES ARE INCONTRAD RSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ON O RECOGNITION BY THEABOUT EXECUTIVE BOARDANDAMONG CONSEQUENTLY TORATIFICAT NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING UNDERSTANDING THE JOURNALISTS OF T ARE AT LEAST FIVE FULL MEMBERS FORMALLY COMMITTED TO THE PRINCIPLE ES: ¶EXECUTIVE • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THEIN PRESS, BY WH THE BOARD ALSO RECOGNISES THAT THE COUNTRY WHICH TH S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AM EOF THE AIMS OFTHEOF INSTITUTE INTHEIRCOUNTRIES, RECRUIT MEMBERS ANDM THE PRACTICES JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDIN PRESS ORTOA THE FREEFLOWOF NEWS. ATTHE REQUESTOFTHE NATIONAL C N. THEREFORE, FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLE TH ADMINISTRATIVE TASKS SUCH ASTHETHE COLLECTING OFOBJECTIVES: MEMBERSHIP DUES ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS FOLLOWING ¶ • THE F ND-RAISING ACTIVITIES SHOULD BE COORDINATED WITH THE IPI DIRECTOR EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACH HAVE POWER TO DECLARE A NATIONAL COMMITTEE INACTIVE OR SUSPEND RE RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRA OR 3ONE ABOVE HAVENOT BEEN FULFILLED ORTHERE IS AFUNDAMENTAL CHANGE ND ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFO OF A NATIONAL COMMITTEE’S INACTIVITY OR SUSPENSION OF A NATIONAL CO SCTION OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN WILLBECONSIDEREDBYTHEEXECUTIVEBOARD,WITHASTATEMENT S, BY WHICH IS MEANT:OF FREE ACCESS TO THEBOARD. NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS EFORE THE MEETING THE EXECUTIVE THE NATIONAL COMMITTEE ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶OR • THE PROMOTION OFNATIONAL THE FREE EXCHANGE OFAT ACCURAT ARANCE OFAMEMBER MEMBERS OFTHE COMMITTEE THEEX ROMWHICH RECOGNITION HAS BEEN ORDERED TOBEARE SUSPENDED BYTHEON EX RSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IFPEOPLES TOUNDERSTAND XTGENERALASSEMBLY,INWHICHCASEAMAJORITYVOTEOFMEMBERSPRES Below right: Ricardo Uceda, also above and right, at the Award Ceremony for best Investigative Journalism in Latin America. rICardo I uCeda PERU 1953– n July 1992, a group of nine students from La Cantuta UniverSíty and their professor went missing. A year later, in what would become a career-long pattern of ground-breaking investigative journalism, Ricardo Uceda, editor of the newsweekly Sí, uncovered the existence of a secret mass grave and linked the killings to a military death squad. As he had done the year before when his reporting implicated military officers in the 1991 massacre of 15 people in the Barrios Altos district of Lima, Uceda refused the demands of the Peru government to reveal his sources. Uceda’s stance resulted in several legal and physical threats from the government as well as attempts to censor his work, but he persisted on his mission to uncover corruption at its highest levels. His dogged determination to spotlight government wrongdoing made his name synonymous with investigative reporting in Latin America and established Uceda as a renowned defender of press freedom. Born 24 July 1953 in Chiclayo, Peru, Uceda studied journalism at the Mayor de San Marcos National University. Upon graduation, he joined El Mundo magazine in 1974. He held a host of reporting jobs for several daily newspapers and worked as an investigative reporter for TV station Canal 2 and, briefly, as editor in chief of La Razon newspaper before he was appointed deputy editor of Sí in 1988. While at Sí, Uceda revolutionised investigative reporting in Peru, reporting on government corruption and human rights abuses with unparalleled bravery and tenacity. Together with his team of investigative reporters, Uceda conducted numerous investigations into all corners of the Peruvian establishment, from the connections between government officials and drug traffickers to the misappropriation of state funds. He did so amidst a hostile climate in the country that sought to suffocate independent voices with threats, intimidation and harassment. It was not uncommon in this environment for a reporter to be ‘disappeared’ for writing a story that offended the government. In 1992, President Alberto Fujimori suspended the constitution and dissolved Congress, creating a dictatorship that violated virtually every imaginable constitutional and human right as well as freedom of expression. At the behest of the president, the military routinely jailed, detained and surveyed journalists who reported on the government’s corrupt activities and many were forced into exile. But Uceda was not a runner, he was a fighter. When Uceda’s Barrios Altos massacre story ran in 1992, Minister of Defence, Victor Malca Villanueva, sought criminal charges against Uceda alleging that he lied about the military’s involvement in the massacre. Uceda fought the charge, as well as pressure from the government to reveal the source he based his story on. The case was eventually closed when a provincial criminal prosecutor determined that Sí had exercised its right of free expression in publishing the article and was without fault. Uceda again refused to name his sources for his story on the military death squad execution of the group from La Cantuta University. When he was accused of obstruction of justice and threatened, he again fought back, winning over the Peruvian Congress, which voted to protect him and to order that his safety be guaranteed by government officials. An inquiry into the episode led to the arrest of several high-ranking officers. In 1994, Uceda left Sí to create and lead the investigations unit of El Comercio, Peru’s largest and most influential daily newspaper. Between 1994 and 2000, he spearheaded some of the most important investigative journalism in the country, including the revelation of Peru’s military death squad unit in the 1990s and the forging of more than one million signatures on petitions in the 2000 elections. In 2004, Uceda published the best-selling book, “Death in the Little Pentagon: The Secret Killing Fields of the Peruvian Army,” an investigation into military crimes committed in the country between1983 and 1993. Uceda is currently the director of the Instituto Prensa y Sociedad (Institute for Press and Society), where he works to support investigative journalism and press freedom throughout Latin America. In a 2008 article in Focus Point magazine entitled, “Fighting Corruption in Latin America: Media Challenges,” Uceda wrote about the indispensable role investigative journalism plays in reining in rouge governments. “Without the ‘good press,’ unscrupulous rulers would have no limits, especially given the weakness of democratic institutions in the region,” he wrote. “If anyone has fought Latin American corruption with any effectiveness, it is the independent journalists, especially the investigative ones.” 127 elenI vlaChou GREECE 1911–1995 I n the event I was stopped to express myself freely ...,” Greece’s shining light, Eleni Vlachou, wrote in an open letter to the world’s press in September 1967. Addressing the envelope to the International Press Institute, she sealed and sent her plea. Her impending arrest would see only a pause in her crusade to resist “the regime of the colonel’s” press censorship. Knowing the tyrants’ egos, she implored the international press to keep writing about Greece and the junta government’s abhorrent removal of civil rights, institution of censorship and refusal to restore freedom of the press. As publisher of the daily Kathimerini, she urged: “Don’t believe for a moment that what the foreign press writes leaves the colonels cool and undisturbed, that they don’t care. They care desperately. They publish with delight the smallest crumb of flattery ... by now people with sense the world over know what has happened in Greece. And I ask them to worry about it. It may prove contagious.” Vlachou was a determined anti-Communist and respected conservative, yet also among those the new government most wanted to ingratiate. When the right-wing junta assumed rule in April 1967, Vlachou, beautiful in her defiance and very much against her personal interests, protected her father’s daily, Athens’ Kathimerini and her own afternoon imprint Messimvrini. In characteristic good humour and light-heartedness, she refused to kowtow to military censorship, immediately stopping the presses and playing with the government for three months in a ‘will-she-won’t-she’ battle to start printing again. Instead she marched onwards, denouncing the colonels in interviews given to foreign reporters to keep Greece’s plight at the fore. 128 When she branded Brigadier Stylianos Pattakos “a clown” in Turin’s La Stampa, she was arrested. Charged with breaking martial law and insulting the authorities, she endured days of none-too-gentle questioning before being moved under house arrest on 4 October to await a military trial. Her open letter reached Zurich and her predicament made front-page headlines throughout the world. Regardless of her incarceration, she continued to defy the junta principals. Shining the light constantly on Greece’s situation, Vlachou’s assertions prompted fact-finding missions on behalf of the International Press Institute and Amnesty International, amongst others, that confirmed extreme press submission and evidence of horrendous detainee torture. Her international education had taught her that her crusade would find more fertile ground abroad. In December 1967 Vlachou dyed her hair with shoe polish to match her false passport and kissed goodbye her husband – who was tapping around their home in her high-heels in order to trick the guards – and fled to England. There Helen Vlachos, as she came to be known, burst onto the London scene fighting to return freedom and civil rights to her countrymen and women in a flurry of anti-junta publicity. Stripped of her citizenship, the one-womanwarrior’s exile in London was soon made less lonely when Greek actress Melina Mercouri and Sir Alexander Fleming’s widow, Amalia Fleming, joined her crusade, shoulder-to-shoulder speaking out against the self-important tyrants. Turning once again to her mighty pen, Vlachou released the graphic account of her months under house arrest; she also published the Hellenic Review magazine, but was blackmailed into stopping. “They sent a man from Athens” she wrote, “who told me that if I wanted my husband to receive medical attention and to be released from solitary confinement, I would have to stop publication. Well, I couldn’t play heroine in London at his expense. I had to kill the magazine.” Nonetheless, her single-minded commitment eventually saw the fall of the junta in 1974, when she hurtled back home to celebrate with her loved ones and revel in starting the presses again. Her election to parliament as a member of the conservative New Democracy party was testament to the love felt for her by her compatriots. Born into a wealthy publishing family on 18 December 1911, Vlachou’s popularity burgeoned through her pithy, pointed political column in her father’s respected and widely-read daily. The powerful father-daughter team entertained and informed until Georgios Vlachos died in 1951. Eleni took her father’s success and ran with it; she was the driving force behind Greece’s first mass-circulation illustrated magazine, Eikones. In 1987, she sold her newspaper empire and returned to her first love – writing – penning the typically witty, gloriously verbose multi-volume memoir “Dimosiographika Khronia: peninda kai kati ...” (“Journalistic Years. Fifty and more ...”), which she saw published in the early 1990s before her death in Athens on 14 October 1995. Such was her country’s adoration of their last Greek heroine, that Eleni Vlachou was buried with full state honours and lauded by Prime Minister Andreas Papandreou as a “truly great figure in Greek journalism ... She was unwavering in her principles and her beliefs,” the prime minister said. “Her immediate reaction to the coup of April 21, 1967, with the cessation of publication of Kathimerini and her other publications, is a crowning moment of resistance in the field of journalism.” HED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM URATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTIC ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A TS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FRE ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AN RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE W VES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS T HED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM URATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTIC ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A TS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FRE ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AN RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE W VES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS T HED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM URATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTIC ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A TS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FRE ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AN RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE W VES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO HED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTH NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEM URATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTIC ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A TS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGA SS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FRE ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AN RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANO NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE W VES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BET D MISSIONS TO COUNTRIES AND GOVERNMEN EN AND MEN IN ITS STRUCTURES AND IN ITS A TUTE, AND THE INSTITUTE ASSUMES NO LIABI PENTOPERSONSWITHRESPONSIBILITIESFOR NET,WHOSUPPORTTHEPRINCIPLEOFFREED ITTENSTATEMENTTHEIRWILLINGNESSTOWO ERETHEREARENATIONALCOMMITTEES,APP PPLICANTS.INCOUNTRIESWHERETHEREARE LLYDETERMINEWHETHERORNOTTOENROLT DUAL BASIS. HOWEVER, IF A NATIONAL COMM TERNET SERVICE. ¶ 4. A NEWSPAPER, JOURN F TEN. ¶ 5. THERE SHALL BE ELIGIBLE AS ASS TIVES,FOREXAMPLE,THESEMAYINCLUDE:¶ S(LEADINGJOURNALISTSGROUP):PERSONS ENCIES, EDITORIAL WRITERS, COPY EDITORS, IALPOSITIONSONINTERNETSERVICES.¶THE WS AGENCY IS NOT LIMITED. AFFILIATE MEM IEF. ¶ 6. ASSOCIATE AND AFFILIATE MEMBERS , WHICH ALONE SHALL HAVE THE POWER TO ERSHIPSHALLBEMADETOTHEINSTITUTE’SDI TTOTHEULTIMATEAUTHORITYOFTHEEXECU THE DUES FOR ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP SHA NPAGE3¶8.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSHIPSH AND CENTRES OF JOURNALISM, PRESS INST CTIVITIES.THEDIRECTORSHALLHAVEPOWE UESFORINSTITUTIONALMEMBERSSHALLBE FARASASSOCIATEMEMBERSARECONCERN OARD. ¶ 10. THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL HA Above: Eleni Vlachou. Below: Vlachou, fourth from left, at a meeting of Greek and Turkish editors in Rhodes, March 1961. ED AN ORGANISATION WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS MISSIONS TOTOCOUNTRIES AND GOVERNMENTS, ANDOFCOLLABORATION WITH OTH EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND N AND MEN IN ITS STRUCTURES AND IN ITS ACTIVITIES. ¶ IPI CONSTITUTION RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ONPAG UNDER ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEYASSUMES HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, ALEGAL FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON UTE, INSTITUTE LIABILITY, OTHERWISE, FOROBJECTI ANY S OF THEAND WORLD.THE ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE ISNO ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TOOR WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING EN TO PERSONS EDITORIAL OR NEWS POLICY IN NEW S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREEWITH ACCESS TORESPONSIBILITIES THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSIONFOR OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEME NET, WHO SUPPORT THE PRINCIPLE OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS AND DESIRE TO CO-O RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATIO NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUTTHEIR UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTAB TEN STATEMENT WILLINGNESS TO WORK FOR THE ACHIEVEMENT OF PRESS ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION ERE THERE ARE COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BEOFMADE THEOF N S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OFNATIONAL UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION THE FREETO EXCHANGE OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERS PLICANTS. INCOUNTRIES WHERE THERE ARE NOISTO NATIONAL COMMITTEES, APPLIC N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALI LY DETERMINE OR NOT TO ENROL THE APPLICANTS. IN ALL CASES, ENRO ED AN ORGANISATION TOWHETHER WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS,IF FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTSMAY AND UAL BASIS. HOWEVER, A NATIONAL COMMITTEE SO DECIDES MEMBERSHIP RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER TERNET SERVICE. ¶THAT 4.WITH ATHEY NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, AGENCY, TV OR RADIO BR ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, ANEWS FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI FS,TEN. ¶IS5. THERE SHALL BE ELIGIBLE AS ASSOCIATE MEMBERS INDIVIDUALS WHO BY WHICH MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE TIVES, FOR EXAMPLE, THESE MAY INCLUDE: ¶ · AS ASSOCIATE MEMBERS: ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • EXECUTIV THE IMPROVEME RSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFGROUP): PEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONE ANOTHER,ITISESSENTIAL THATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATIO (LEADING JOURNALISTS INJOURNALISTIC CATEG NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THEPERSONS JOURNALISTS OFOPERATING THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTAB ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION NCIES, EDITORIAL WRITERS, COPY EDITORS, BUREAU CHIEFS, CORRESPONDENTS S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SONUMBER AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREEAFFILIAT EXCHANGE OF AL POSITIONS ON INTERNET SERVICES. ¶ THE OF ASSOCIATE AND OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERS N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING(LEADING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALI WS AGENCY ISTONOT LIMITED. AFFILIATE MEMBERSHIP JOURNALISTS GR ED AN ORGANISATION WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS EF. 6.PUBLICATION ASSOCIATE AND AFFILIATE MEMBERSHIP CAN ACQUIRED ASDEPENDS FOLLOWS. EWS,¶ FREE OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OFBE UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE ON UNDER WHICH ALONE SHALL HAVE THE POWER TO INITIALLY DETERMINE WHETHER OR N ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON RSHIP SHALL BE MADE TO THE INSTITUTE’S DIRECTOR, WHO ALONE HAVE TH S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDSSHALL THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI S,TO BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE ULTIMATE AUTHORITY OFEXCHANGE THEEXECUTIVE ¶7.AMONG ASSOCIATE AND AFF ND SOTHE AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE OF ACCURATE ANDBOARD. BALANCED NEWS NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEME RSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES ANDPEOPLES.MEMBERSHIP IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTAND ONEBE ANOTHER, ITISTHE ESSENTIAL THATTHEY HAVE GOODINFORMATIO HE DUES FOR ASSOCIATE SHALL HALF DUES FOR FULL MEMB NG PEOPLES3IS¶ TO8. BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDINGMEMBERSHIP AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTAB PAGE INSTITUTIONAL SHALL BE OPEN UNDER THE CONDITION ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION S. ¶ • THECENTRES ACHIEVEMENT OFOF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREEORGANIS EXCHANGE OF AND JOURNALISM, PRESS INSTITUTES AND JOURNALISTS’ OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERS CTIVITIES. THE DIRECTOR SHALL HAVE POWER INSTITUTIONAL N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLESTO IS TOENROL BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONGMEMBER THE JOURNALI ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWINGSHALL OBJECTIVES:BE ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS ES FOR INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS FIXED BYOFTHE DIRECTOR INJOURNALISTS ACCORDA EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT UNDERSTANDING AMONGST AND AR ASSOCIATE MEMBERS ARE CONCERNED, DUES FOR CERTAIN CATEGORIES O RATE AS AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON ARD. ¶ 10. THE EXECUTIVE HAVE POWERTOTO SUSPEND EXPEL AN S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THISBOARD BELIEF THERESHALL IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION WORK TOWARDS THEOR FOLLOWING OBJECTI OFFREE A• THE MEMBER MAY BETRANSMISSION ORDERED BYA MAJORITY VOTENATIONS.¶ OFFREE THE MEMBER S,SPENSION BY WHICH IS MEANT: ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, EXPRESSION OF VIE ND SOOF AMONG PEOPLES.¶ PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE¶ AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG • THE IMPROVEME DS THE MEMBERS PRESENT OF THE BOARD. 11. WRITTEN NOTICE OF THE CON RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOODINFORMATIO NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONGPREVIOUS THE JOURNALISTSTO OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTAB R CONCERNED SIXTY (60) DAYS THE MEETING OFTOWITH THE EXECUTIVE BO ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION ORDERED SUSPENDED OREXPELLED THEPEOPLES.¶ EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL HAVE S.R ¶ •SO THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS ANDBY SO AMONG • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERS E RECOGNISED AS THE FINAL DECISION OF THE INSTITUTE. ¶ 12. ANY MEMBER SHA N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONGMEMBER PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALI OMMITTEE OR THE DIRECTOR. ¶ 13. ANY RESIGNING OR EXPELLED SHA ED AN ORGANISATION TOTO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SION 14. MEMBERSHIP SHOULD BECANCELLED INCASES W RATE ANDBECOMES BALANCED NEWSEFFECTIVE. AMONG NATIONS.¶¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER ERSHIP HAS BEEN GRANTED AND WHERE THESE CHANGES ARE IN CONTRADICTIO ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THEREBOARD IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI OS,SRECOGNITION THE EXECUTIVE CONSEQUENTLY TORATIFICATION BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREEBY ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OFAND NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEME ARE AT LEAST FIVE FULL MEMBERS FORMALLY COMMITTED TO THE PRINCIPLES OF RSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATIO THE EXECUTIVE BOARD ALSOAMONG RECOGNISES THE¶COUNTRY IN WHICH THEIS ESTAB NA NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING THE JOURNALISTSTHAT OF THE WORLD. IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION ES.THE AIMSOFOF THE INSTITUTE INTHEIR COUNTRIES, RECRUIT MEMBERS AND MAYOFR ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE PRESS OR TO THEFREE FLOW NEWS. ATPEOPLES THEREQUEST OFUNDERSTANDING THE NATIONAL OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE OF DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARECOMM TO UNDERS N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEPTASKS TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG IS TO BRING ABOUT AMONG THE JOURNALI TH ADMINISTRATIVE SUCH AS THE COLLECTING OF MEMBERSHIP DUES. THE ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS ND-RAISING SHOULD COORDINATED WITH THE IPI DIRECTOR. AN EWS, FREE PUBLICATIONACTIVITIES OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSIONBE OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS ANDA RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER HAVE POWER TODECLARE ANATIONAL COMMITTEE INACTIVE SUSPEND RECOG ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEPOR TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON OR ABOVE NOT BEEN OR THERE IS A FUNDAMENTAL CHANGE IN TH S OF3THE WORLD. ¶HAVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH THISFULFILLED BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTI S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE OF ANATIONAL ORSUSPENSION OFAMONG ANATIONAL ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ •COMMITTEE’S THE PROMOTION OF THEINACTIVITY FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS NATIONS.¶ • THECOMMIT IMPROVEME RSTANDING BETWEENBE PEOPLES ANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLES TOUNDERSTAND ONEANOTHER, ITISESSENTIAL THEYHAVEGOODINFORMATIO CTION WILL CONSIDERED BYARE THE EXECUTIVE BOARD, WITHTHAT AWITH STATEMENT OF TH NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTAB EFORE THE MEETING OF THE BOARD. THE NATIONAL COMMITTEE SHA ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OFEXECUTIVE FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SONATIONAL AMONG PEOPLES.¶COMMITTEE • THE PROMOTION OFAT THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ARANCE OF A MEMBER OR MEMBERS OF THE THE EXECU OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERS WHICH RECOGNITION HASBEEN ORDERED BEABOUT SUSPENDED BY THETHE EXECUT N.ROM THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES ISTO TO BRING UNDERSTANDING AMONG JOURNALI ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESSS XT GENERAL ASSEMBLY, IN WHICH CASE A MAJORITY VOTE OF MEMBERS PRESENT EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREETO EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND E RESTORE RECOGNITION A NATIONAL COMMITTEE. ¶ NOTWITHSTANDING TH RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDER ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMON TO CONSIDER A NATIONAL INACTIVE SHALL NOT THE SOARD OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERECOMMITTEE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THEAFFECT FOLLOWING OBJECTI HE AND TOTOPARTICIPATE FULLYOFINNEWS, ITSFREE AFFAIRS. EXECUTIV S, BYINSTITUTE WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION PUBLICATION¶ OFWHERE NEWSPAPERS,THE FREE EXPRESSION OF VIE Clockwise from left: Lasantha Wickrematunge around the age of 4; Wickrematunge pictured with his first wife Raine and eldest son Avinash when Avinash was a year old; from left, daughter Ahimsa, Raine holding youngest son Aadesh, and Wickrematunge with his arm around Avinash; a commemorative vigil to honour Wickrematunge who was killed on 8 January 2009. Lasantha WICKrematunge SRI LANKA 1958–2009 l asantha Wickrematunge was the youngest child born on 5 April 1958 to Harris and Chandra Wickrematunge of Kotahena, a multi-ethnic town situated in the north of Colombo, the then-capital of Sri Lanka. Being the youngest of six siblings, Lasantha grew up with the confidence that comes with having five elder brothers and sisters around to show the way forward. Lasantha’s father Harris was a member of the local borough and a one-time deputy mayor of Colombo City; politics became second nature in the Wickrematunge family home. Lasantha had his primary education at St. Benedict’s College, a Catholic missionary school just a stone’s throw from his family home. Here he learnt values imparted by the De La Salle brothers, who were part of the teaching staff. His impish sense of humour and penchant for schoolboy pranks masked his scholarly abilities, which blossomed later when he completed his legal studies in the United Kingdom. He also loved sports. Cricket was his forté but he never pursued it with commitment other than at junior level, where he showed promise as a left arm leg spinner. Had he stuck to cricket, destiny would have written a different epitaph. Lasantha’s father was a hard task master and a stern disciplinarian of his children. Lasantha, however, was able to work his way around the strict regiment set by his father by using to his advantage the argument that the youngest be given more room to bend the rules that were set for the elder siblings. He questioned authority when others silently obeyed. He fought for the underdog though the cause was not his. These traits were visible at a very early stage of his life. Born a Buddhist, Lasantha questioned the priests in school on certain aspects of the Holy Bible. On one occasion, a reverend brother admonished Lasantha by saying that he would go straight to hell. Lasantha was quick to reply in front of a full classroom: “I would most certainly prefer to go to hell than heaven as Brother Director will be there and so would you. But look at who I would be keeping company in hell – Marilyn Monroe, Jayne Mansfield!” His response was met with six of the best on his buttocks. Armed with a degree in law, Lasantha quickly returned to Sri Lanka, the land he loved. He practiced law in the chambers of a senior and respected president’s counsel and showed the potential of a good legal brain. This was to be shortlived as he quickly shelved his lucrative legal career to take up a position at the soon-to-be launched Sunday Leader, of which I was the managing director. He first joined the now defunct Sun Newspaper Group as a cub reporter, then the Upali Newspapers Group and finally The Sunday Times as the political correspondent where he set a new style in motion for political commentary. The Sunday Leader was started in June 1994 and Lasantha made me promise that he would have total freedom over editorial content, which he jealously guarded to the very end. Often he flew close to the wind. He pushed the limits. He exposed corruption and bad governance. There was no one that escaped his probing pen. He set an ‘inyour-face’ style, which was a new phenomenon in editorial style and content within a very mild, and often seen as subservient, press at that time. It took less than a year into publication before Lasantha was physically attacked. His vehicle was waylaid on his journey home from office, set upon by masked goons who clubbed him and his wife. Investigating and exposing the highest in the land for being economical with the truth as he did, more attacks were to follow. His home was sprayed with automatic fire, the printing presses were burnt down twice, the newspaper was shut down under a draconian piece of legislation and an attempt was made to arrest and detain him under Emergency Regulations – all of which he faced with the courage and strength to prevail. None of this diminished his zeal or vigour to go after the truth. There was another person hidden within Lasantha, totally at odds with the public perception of who he was. He loved children. He loved to watch movies. Lasantha never drank alcohol or smoked a cigarette in his life. He read as much as he could. He would give the shirt off his back to anyone in need. He was soft at heart and was moved to tears when confronted with others’ misfortunes. He did sense that his life was in danger – writing an editorial that would become his own obituary – but he simply pushed that thought away and concentrated on what he was good at. Many a friend and colleague warned him of the dangers of fighting the state. He was referred to as the “Leader of the Opposition” by the people. On that fateful day, 8 January 2009, Lasantha was on his way to the office when he noticed that four motorcyclists were following him. He did call a few friends and politicians but continued on his way. Perhaps he expected another physical attack at best. But this was the final straw. The lone voice for upholding the right to information, the watchdog of the nation was silenced. Written by Lal Wickrematunge, brother of Lasantha Wickrematunge, and managing director of The Sunday Leader in Sri Lanka. 131 C.e.l. WICKremesInghe SRI LANKA 1920–1985 C yril Esmond Lucien (C.E.L.) Wickremesinghe passionately believed that freedom of opinion and expression are as fundamental to human progress as economic growth and social advancement. Twenty-five years after his death on 29 September 1985, his message lives on. Born into two prominent families on 29 May 1920, Wickremesinghe was destined for greatness. While he trained as an attorney, his true passion was political science, a subject in which he dabbled during his short stint as a journalist in his youth. Regarded as the maker and breaker of governments, as the director of Associated Newspapers of Ceylon, the largest and most influential newspaper group in Sri Lanka, he was the catalyst and leader in defending press freedom and in laying the foundation for a robust, privately-owned media in Sri Lanka. Established by his father-in-law during Sri Lanka’s struggle for colonial independence, the Lake House newspaper group, consisting of five dailies and three Sunday papers, was the powerhouse of the nation’s journalism. Esmond was groomed from a young age by press magnate, D.R. Wijewardene, to marry both his daughter and his paper; the latter Esmond wed in 1948 when he took up the Lake House Group torch as managing director of editorial operations. He guided the company, gently streamlining and modernising it as he nurtured journalistic excellence and editorial independence. A motto he insisted on was: “News is sacred; comment is free.” He worked hard to develop strong links both at home and abroad – links that would prove incredibly valuable in the darkness of the years to come. When, on 12 August 1960, Prime Minister Sirimavo Bandaranaike’s government announced 132 that its intention was “to take over the newspapers controlled by the Associated Newspapers of Ceylon,” Wickremesinghe, famous for ‘fixing a tomorrow with his newspaper,’ moved tactically. Knowing that a battle of words focusing on the negative would kill both motivation and interest in his crusade, he ran campaigns to grow more food, to improve national heritage and to follow the green revolution, all of which encouraged a positive national rallying and served his beloved country. His compassion for the ‘small’ man, often the less literate among his readers, resulted in his cartoonists poking fun at the bigger issues of the day, bringing the lofty issues down to scale for readers. Having aroused the country and many politicians, Wickremesinghe was placed firmly as the figurehead of the press-freedom fight against the state-owned Commission of Inquiry that four times called for press control. During his outspoken opposition of press censorship and manipulation, he was attacked metaphorically and literally, publically and personally, but these attacks merely strengthened his resolve. Calling for national and international support, Wickremesinghe and his editors continued to resist the regime and defend freedom of expression and of the press. He united rival newspapers to join the common cause of survival. Supported by international bodies, his nationwide campaign created a climate of public opinion that gave local politicians the courage to defend society against attacks on press freedom. The campaign ardently supported Bandaranaike’s opposition to the coalition, the United National Party (UNP) and Federal Party pact that Wickremesinghe himself moderated. It ended the fourand-a-half-year battle for press freedom when, on 3 December 1964, the government’s second-rank- SES, ACADE D MISSIONS T EN AND MEN TUTE, AND TH PENTOPERS NET,WHOSU ITTENSTATEM ing member, defected, wanting to “ensure that [their] people shall continue to live as free men, and that [he] may continue to live as a free man among free men.” As chairman of the International Press Institute from 1966 to 1968, Wickremesinghe’s outstanding contributions to press freedom earned him worldwide recognition. In March 1967, Lake House hosted the first local IPI-organised Asian Newspapers Conference, which called for the newspaper industry to provide affordable reporting for everyone – not just the academic elite – thus building nationwide support from loyal readers if the government tried to clamp down and remove the right to a free press. Along with other Asian freedom press fighters, Wickremesinghe founded the Press Foundation of Asia. In 1973, three years after Bandaranaike returned to power, the prime minister succeeded in nationalising the Lake House Group. But the joke was on her, when she learned that the dismissed journalists had already formed a trust. With Wickremesinghe as chairman, they started publishing three new papers in English, Tamil and Sinhala. Wickremesinghe told the 24th General Assembly of the IPI in Zurich, Switzerland in 1975, “They are run on a very simple formula: publishing all the news the government wants to hide.” Although long involved in fighting government interference, Wickremesinghe’s natural flair for diplomacy also led him to play an important role in negotiating his country’s admission to the United Nations, and he also headed Sri Lanka’s delegation to UNESCO for many years. Wickremesinghe died of natural causes, a heart attack, in 1985. His legacy lives on with his son, who, as a high-ranking Sri Lankan politician and one-time Prime Minister, continues to call for protection of media freedom. HED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOUR URATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTA TS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW SS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPR ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • TH RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOO NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF T VES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE E OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES A N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG T HED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOUR URATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTA TS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW SS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPR ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • TH RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOO NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF T VES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE E OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES A N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG T HED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOUR URATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTA TS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW SS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPR ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • TH RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOO NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF T VES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE E OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES A N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG T HED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOUR URATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTA TS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW SS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPR ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • TH Above: Members of IPI’s Below left: WickRSTANDINGBETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL South Korea CommisremesingheTHAT pictured THEY HAVE GOO NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF T sion in conference at talking to his hostess, Seoul airport, AND 1960, Mrs. Hernelius, during VES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE from left, OF Allan Herthe Chairman’s recepS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE E nelius, Charles Eade, tion at the IPI’s Twelfth OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES A Mahesh Chandra, General Assembly in N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG T C.E.L. Wickremesinghe. Stockholm, 1963. HED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOUR URATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTA TS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW SS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPR ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • TH RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOO NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF T VES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE E OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTANDING BETWEEN PEOPLES AND PEOPLES. IF PEOPLES A N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG T HED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOUR URATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPEN ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTA TS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOW SS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF NEWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPR ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • TH RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTANDONEANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATTHEYHAVEGOO NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF T VES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE E G AMONG PEOPLES IS TO BRING AB S THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ José ruBén ICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE ZAMORA F ACCURATE AND BALANCED NEW F PEOPLES ARE TO UNDERSTAND BOUTUNDERSTANDINGAMONGTH ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEG A PRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE ACH S AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPRO ANOTHER,ITISESSENTIALTHATT OURNALISTSOFTHEWORLD.¶INA NGOFFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS,BY NT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM OODINFORMATION.THEREFORE,A E WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTA EANT:FREEACCESSTOTHENEWS TS AND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • TH D PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTA DAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDER HED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK EETRANSMISSIONOFNEWS,FREE ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • T EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF TH ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THE S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF N ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTAND NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND S OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTAN N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PE ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • T EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF TH ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THE S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF N ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTAND NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND S OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTAN N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PE ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • T EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF TH ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THE S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF N ND SO AMONG PEOPLES.¶ • THE PROMOTION OF THE FREE EXCHANGE OF ACC RSTANDINGBETWEENPEOPLESANDPEOPLES.IFPEOPLESARETOUNDERSTAND NG PEOPLES IS TO BRING ABOUT UNDERSTANDING AMONG THE JOURNALISTS ES: ¶ • THE FURTHERANCE AND SAFEGUARDING OF FREEDOM OF THE PRESS, B S. ¶ • THE ACHIEVEMENT OF UNDERSTANDING AMONGST JOURNALISTS AND S OF THE PRACTICES OF JOURNALISM.¶WORLD PEACE DEPENDS ON UNDERSTAN N. THEREFORE, A FUNDAMENTAL STEP TOWARDS UNDERSTANDING AMONG PE ED AN ORGANISATION TO WORK TOWARDS THE FOLLOWING OBJECTIVES: ¶ • T EWS, FREE PUBLICATION OF NEWSPAPERS, FREE EXPRESSION OF VIEWS. ¶ • THE RATE AND BALANCED NEWS AMONG NATIONS.¶ • THE IMPROVEMENT OF TH ND ONE ANOTHER, IT IS ESSENTIAL THAT THEY HAVE GOOD INFORMATION. THE S OF THE WORLD. ¶ IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS BELIEF THERE IS ESTABLISHED S, BY WHICH IS MEANT: FREE ACCESS TO THE NEWS, FREE TRANSMISSION OF N José Rubén Zamora, shown in these shots, founded three of the most influential newspapers in Guatemala. Below right: Zamora, pictured second from right. GUATEMALA 1956– s founder of three of the most influential newspapers in Guatemala, José Rubén Zamora Marroquín, president of El Periódico, helped revolutionise journalism in the country, ushering in an era of unprecedented investigative reporting that challenged Guatemala’s government at its highest levels. Throughout his near quarter century in journalism, Zamora has faced down countless death threats and efforts to persecute him and censor his publications. He has also endured numerous physical attacks. But throughout it all, Zamora has remained committed to press freedom and to keeping Guatemalans informed. Born 19 August 1956, Zamora began in journalism at age 17, working for his family’s newspaper, La Hora, first as a reporter and then as editor of national news. He also did sport and international news reporting. Zamora later took a 12year hiatus from journalism to study industrial engineering before returning to journalism in 1986. That year, he founded ANC, a news and documentary production company. He later expanded the company to include an independent print publication, a risky endeavor in a country in which the print media was systematically repressed by the authoritarian military regime. Dozens of journalists had been killed for exercising free expression. But Zamora was undeterred. In 1990, he founded Siglo Veintiuno, or 21st Century, waging war against repression and taking on the fight for press freedom. The pages of Siglo Veintiuno were filled with stories about government corruption, military-sponsored assassinations, drug trafficking, kidnappings and other crimes that the Guatemalan media had typically shied away from. The paper became an outlet for the progressive right, the guerrilla movement and human rights organizations that hadn’t before had a voice in the media. Siglo Veintiuno advocated for a fairer tax system and a more equitable distribution of the country’s resources. Zamora’s campaign against the corrupt legal system led to the resignation of 116 military police officers and nine members of the Supreme Court of Justice. He also took on the military, accusing high ranking officials of a number of major crimes. Siglo Veintiuno’s journalistic daring vexed an establishment fearful of having its power eroded, and it soon retaliated. Zamora received a number of death threats and was shot at on more than one occasion. In 1993, President Jorge Serrano Elias suspended the Constitution, dissolved Congress and the Supreme Court and imposed a system of comprehensive censorship of the media. National police units surrounded Siglo Veintiuno’s offices hurling threats and demanding that censors be allowed in the office. In a clever response, Zamora altered the masthead to read Siglo Catorce, or 14th Century, likening Serrano’s acts to those of the Dark Ages. The paper ran solid blocks of ink in place of censored stories. And as army troops seized copies of the paper and burned them in the streets, Zamora faxed the uncensored versions of the paper around the world. The paper’s coverage of Serrano’s actions sparked international outrage, which forced the president into exile. Following Serrano’s departure, threats to Zamora and Siglo Veintiuno continued. Zamora was once run off the road and received anonymous death threats. In 1995, Zamora received both the Maria Moors Cabot Prize from Columbia University and the Committee to Protect Journalists’ International Press Freedom Award. In 1996, Zamora resigned as editor of Siglo Veintiuno over a conflict with the board of directors. Two days later, he was the victim of a grenade attack that was designed to prevent him from starting another paper. He was uninjured in the attack and went on to found the daily El Periódico that same year with the help of donations from 125 citizens. El Periódico was purchased in 1997, though Zamora stayed on as editor. In 1998, Zamora founded Nuestro Diario paper, which he later sold. In June 2003, armed men entered Zamora’s home and held him and his family hostage for several hours. Zamora was stripped, blindfolded, held at gunpoint and told to stop publishing stories that the government deemed negative. His children were beaten. The hostage episode prompted Zamora to send his family into exile in the U.S. until the presidential election was over. He himself stayed in Guatemala to report on the elections. That same year, Zamora won the Knight International Press Prize from the International Center for Journalists. “I have no other choice but to continue working to inform the Guatemalan people of what is going on,” Zamora said in a BBC News interview shortly after the attack. “Yes, I fear for the safety of my family and I have personally suffered aggression in the past, but we are all vulnerable to delinquency in this country and I have a duty to carry on.” In 2008, Zamora was kidnapped outside a restaurant and severely beaten for more than 10 hours before he was found, nearly naked and unconscious, on the outskirts of Guatemala City. In an interview earlier this year with El Faro newspaper, Zamora spoke of the toll his unwavering commitment to independent journalism has taken on himself and his family. At age 52, he estimated that he was physically 114 years old. In five years’ time Zamora plans to retire to live out his remaining days enjoying the company of the family he has spent much time away from. “I have the obligation to spend time with my children and my wife, who has been exceptional and has always behaved firmly with me,” Zamora said. “After many attacks, kidnappings… I hope to die at home, in my bed and surrounded by the love of my children. That is all I aspire to now.” 135 NERAL ¶ 1. THE ORGANISATION DEFENDS EVERYONE’S PERSON THEUNUNIVERSALDECLARATIONOFHUMANRIGHTS,(DEC.10 ATIONALDELAPRESSE,INFRENCH;INSTITUTOINTERNACIONA AL LANGUAGES OF THE INSTITUTE SHALL BE ENGLISH, FRENCH URSUANT TO SECTION 60 ET SEQ. OF THE SWISS CIVIL CODE. TH TV SYSTEMS FOUNDATIONS, OTHER INSTITUTIONS AND BUSIN INGS,IFANY,OFTHEINSTITUTESHALLENURETOTHEBENEFITO S, SEMINARS, CONFERENCES, EXCHANGE PROGRAMMES, TRA CTRONIC MATERIAL ON THE INTERNET, THE SENDING OF DELEG E PURPOSES, THE INSTITUTE SHALL PROMOTE A FAIR BALANC OMMITTEE ASSUMES ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL OR OTHERWISE, FO E.¶ARTICLEII¶MEMBERSHIP¶1.FULLMEMBERSHIPOFTHEINS WSAGENCIESORTVANDRADIOBROADCASTINGSYSTEMSORO VESANDWHO,INSEEKINGMEMBERSHIP,DECLAREFORMALLY ¶2.FULLMEMBERSHIPCANBEACQUIREDASFOLLOWS:INCOU ETHEPOWERTOINITIALLYDETERMINEWHETHERORNOTTOE HEINSTITUTE’SDIRECTOR,WHOALONESHALLHAVETHEPOWE RITY OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶ 3. MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE ON JOURNAL, NEWS AGENCY, TV OR RADIO BROADCASTING SYST MAY BE REPRESENTED BY MORE THAN ONE FULL MEMBER UP OFTHEPRESSANDDESIROUSOFCO-OPERATINGINTHEINSTITU RNALISMFACULTIES,LAWYERSANDADVISORS.¶·ASAFFILIA /SECTIONS OF NEWSPAPERS, MAGAZINES, BROADCASTING O ROGRAMMEEDITORSORPRESENTERS,PERSONSHOLDINGSIMI ROM ANY ONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, RADIO, TV ORGANISA E APPLICANTS PROCURE WRITTEN APPROVAL FROM THEIR ED MMITTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BE MADE TO THE NATIONAL WHERETHEREARENONATIONALCOMMITTEES,APPLICATIONS NOTTOENROLTHEAPPLICANTS.INALLCASES,ENROLMENTSA CTIVITIES OF THE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY SHALL HAVE NO VOTIN HALLBEHALFTHEDUESFORASSOCIATEMEMBERSHIP.¶IPICO MUNICATIONS DEPARTMENTS OF UNIVERSITIES AND COLLEGE DS.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSMAYPARTICIPATEINALLTHEIN EEXECUTIVEBOARD.THENUMBEROFTHEIRDELEGATESISNOT ARD.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSSHALLHAVENOVOTINGRIGHT BOARD SHALL BE FIXED BY THE DIRECTOR WITH THE AGREEME CONTRARYTOTHEPRINCIPLESSETOUTINTHEPRESENTCONS ULSION SHALL NOT BE ORDERED EXCEPT ON THE APPROVAL O THE STATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED CAUSES, SHALL BE GIVEN TO RANTEDTOSUCHMEMBER,IFTHATMEMBERSHALLSODESIRE SEMBLY IN WHICH CASE A MAJORITY VOTE OF MEMBERS PRES edItor’s Note There are so many people to thank and to whom we are grateful for their assistance in putting this project together. First of all, we would like to thank those heroes who gave their time for interviews and the families and colleagues of those who are no longer with us who helped with photos, research and answering questions and who, in some cases, wrote the entry themselves. A special thanks to my assistant editor and budding journalist, Louise Hallman, who is not only thorough, but a tiger when it comes to organisation! And to IPI conference manager Michael Kudlak, who did a great deal of the ground work on the biographies of 50 of the Heroes back in 2000. I would like to personally thank Lucy Cripps, Kayce Ataiyero and Mý Huê McGowran for their infectious enthusiasm about the project. Thanks also to the AFP, Associated Press, Reuters and Getty Images for donating the use of their pictures. During the preparation of this book, we received shocking news of the tragic death of one of our heroes, Pius Njawé. His death, just like his life, reminds us all of the impact that just one person can have on freedom and democracy. Last, but not least, without the kind and generous contribution of Bank Austria/UniCredit Group, this project would not have been possible. Thank you! Alison Bethel McKenzie 137 IC MATERIAL ON THE INTERNET, THE SENDING OF DELEGATION POSES, THE INSTITUTE SHALL PROMOTE A FAIR BALANCE OF W TEE ASSUMES ANY LIABILITY, LEGAL OR OTHERWISE, FOR THE TICLEII¶MEMBERSHIP¶1.FULLMEMBERSHIPOFTHEINSTITUT ENCIESORTVANDRADIOBROADCASTINGSYSTEMSORONTHE DWHO,INSEEKINGMEMBERSHIP,DECLAREFORMALLYANDB ULLMEMBERSHIPCANBEACQUIREDASFOLLOWS:INCOUNTRIE POWERTOINITIALLYDETERMINEWHETHERORNOTTOENROLT TITUTE’SDIRECTOR,WHOALONESHALLHAVETHEPOWERTOIN F THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. ¶ 3. MEMBERSHIP SHALL BE ON AN IN NAL, NEWS AGENCY, TV OR RADIO BROADCASTING SYSTEM OR BE REPRESENTED BY MORE THAN ONE FULL MEMBER UP TO A L PRESSANDDESIROUSOFCO-OPERATINGINTHEINSTITUTE’SO ISMFACULTIES,LAWYERSANDADVISORS.¶·ASAFFILIATEME IONS OF NEWSPAPERS, MAGAZINES, BROADCASTING OR NEW MMEEDITORSORPRESENTERS,PERSONSHOLDINGSIMILARED NY ONE NEWSPAPER, JOURNAL, RADIO, TV ORGANISATION O ICANTS PROCURE WRITTEN APPROVAL FROM THEIR EDITOR-I EES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BE MADE TO THE NATIONAL COMM ETHEREARENONATIONALCOMMITTEES,APPLICATIONSFORM OENROLTHEAPPLICANTS.INALLCASES,ENROLMENTSARESU TIES OF THE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY SHALL HAVE NO VOTING RIG BEHALFTHEDUESFORASSOCIATEMEMBERSHIP.¶IPICONSTIT ATIONS DEPARTMENTS OF UNIVERSITIES AND COLLEGES, SCH STITUTIONALMEMBERSMAYPARTICIPATEINALLTHEINSTITU CUTIVEBOARD.THENUMBEROFTHEIRDELEGATESISNOTLIMIT NSTITUTIONALMEMBERSSHALLHAVENOVOTINGRIGHTS.¶9. D SHALL BE FIXED BY THE DIRECTOR WITH THE AGREEMENT OF RARYTOTHEPRINCIPLESSETOUTINTHEPRESENTCONSTITUT N SHALL NOT BE ORDERED EXCEPT ON THE APPROVAL OF TWO TATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED CAUSES, SHALL BE GIVEN TO THE M EDTOSUCHMEMBER,IFTHATMEMBERSHALLSODESIRE.ANYM LY IN WHICH CASE A MAJORITY VOTE OF MEMBERS PRESENT S NOTICEOFSUCHACTIONSHALLBEGIVENEITHERTOTHENATIO INSTITUTE,UPTOTHETIMETHATMEMBER’SRESIGNATIONOR ISFUNDAMENTALCHANGEINTHECONDITIONSUNDERWHICH NSTITUTION.¶ARTICLEIII¶NATIONALCOMMITTEES¶1A)SUBJ TTEEMAYBEFORMEDPROVISIONALLYINACOUNTRYWHERET ON BY THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL NOT NECESSARILY IMPLY OFTHEPRESS.¶2.NATIONALCOMMITTEESSHALLACTIVELYP ECTINGTHEPRESS,PARTICULARLYONTHREATSTOFREEDOM The Authors Lucy Cripps Born and educated as an English teacher in England, Lucy Cripps lives, for now, in Salzburg, Austria with her young family. Lucy works as a hired pen, proofreader and copy-editor. She runs her own online writing services company helping corporates in need and teaches English at Salzburg University of Applied Sciences. She will start working towards a master’s degree in professional writing in January 2011. Kayce Ataiyero Kayce Ataiyero is a freelance journalist and former columnist with The Chicago Tribune who's also written for The Washington Post, The Boston Globe and the Philadelphia Inquirer. Originally from Washington, D.C., she currently resides in Chicago, Illinois, USA. Additional Contributors: Yurdanur Atadan, Owais Aslam Ali, Fadi Baaklini, Alison Bethel McKenzie, Elizabeth Garrett, José Luis Gutiérrez, Louise Hallman, Naomi Hunt, Nayana Jayarajan, Ronald Koven, Michael Kudlak, Raymond Louw, Sam Mujuda, Paweł Smoleński, Barbara Trionfi, Oliver Vujovic and Lal Wickrematunge. 139 SATION OR NEWS AGENCY IS NOT LIMITED. AFFILIATE MEMBE EDITOR-IN-CHIEF. ¶ 6. ASSOCIATE AND AFFILIATE MEMBERSHI AL COMMITTEE, WHICH ALONE SHALL HAVE THE POWER TO INI NSFORMEMBERSHIPSHALLBEMADETOTHEINSTITUTE’SDIRE SARESUBJECTTOTHEULTIMATEAUTHORITYOFTHEEXECUTI TING RIGHTS. THE DUES FOR ASSOCIATE MEMBERSHIP SHALL B CONSTITUTIONPAGE3¶8.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSHIPSHAL GES, SCHOOLS AND CENTRES OF JOURNALISM, PRESS INSTITU INSTITUTE’SACTIVITIES.THEDIRECTORSHALLHAVEPOWERT NOTLIMITED.DUESFORINSTITUTIONALMEMBERSSHALLBEFIX HTS.¶9.INSOFARASASSOCIATEMEMBERSARECONCERNED, MENT OF THE BOARD. ¶ 10. THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL HAVE NSTITUTION.SUSPENSIONOFAMEMBERMAYBEORDEREDBYA L OF TWO-THIRDS OF THE MEMBERS PRESENT OF THE BOARD. TO THE MEMBER CONCERNED SIXTY (60) DAYS PREVIOUS TO T RE.ANYMEMBERSOORDEREDSUSPENDEDOREXPELLEDBYTH ESENT SHALL BE RECOGNISED AS THE FINAL DECISION OF THE HENATIONALCOMMITTEEORTOTHEDIRECTOR.¶13.ANYMEM ATIONOREXPULSIONBECOMESEFFECTIVE.¶14.MEMBERSHIPS RWHICHMEMBERSHIPHASBEENGRANTEDANDWHERETHES 1A)SUBJECTTORECOGNITIONBYTHEEXECUTIVEBOARDAND WHERETHEREAREATLEASTFIVEFULLMEMBERSFORMALLYC LY IMPLY THAT THE EXECUTIVE BOARD ALSO RECOGNISES THA TIVELYPURSUETHEAIMSOFTHEINSTITUTEINTHEIRCOUNTR REEDOMOFTHEPRESSORTOTHEFREEFLOWOFNEWS.ATTHE ENTRUSTEDWITHADMINISTRATIVETASKSSUCHASTHECOLLE CRETARIAT. FUND-RAISING ACTIVITIES SHOULD BE COORDIN EBOARDSHALLHAVEPOWERTODECLAREANATIONALCOMMIT PARAGRAPH2OR3ABOVEHAVENOTBEENFULFILLEDORTHERE DECLARATIONOFANATIONALCOMMITTEE’SINACTIVITYORSU CETHATSUCHACTIONWILLBECONSIDEREDBYTHEEXECUTIV TY (60) DAYS BEFORE THE MEETING OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD ERSONALAPPEARANCEOFAMEMBERORMEMBERSOFTHENA LCOMMITTEEFROMWHICHRECOGNITIONHASBEENORDERED PEALTOTHENEXTGENERALASSEMBLY,INWHICHCASEAMAJO AY AT ANY TIME RESTORE RECOGNITION TO A NATIONAL COM HE EXECUTIVE BOARD TO CONSIDER A NATIONAL COMMITTEE MEMBERS OF THE INSTITUTE AND TO PARTICIPATE FULLY IN ITS CTIVE,THETASKSFORMERLYEXECUTEDBYTHISCOMMITTEEW ONFERENCES, SEMINARS, WORKSHOPS, ETC, TO DISCUSS MED TY. THEY ARE ALSO ENCOURAGED TO COLLABORATE WITH OR Words of Freedom A Tribute to 60 IPI World Press Freedom Heroes Editor: Alison Bethel McKenzie Sales & Marketing: Grace Pardy Assistant Editor: Louise Hallman Sub-Editor: Mý Huê McGowran Layout & Design Editor: Fuhrer visuelle Gestaltung, Stefan Fuhrer Photo Editor: Brigitt Roveti IPI Press Freedom & Publications Manager: Anthony Mills 141 NAL COMMITTEES, APPLICATIONS SHALL BE MADE TO THE NAT NTRIESWHERETHEREARENONATIONALCOMMITTEES,APPLIC HERORNOTTOENROLTHEAPPLICANTS.INALLCASES,ENROLM L THE ACTIVITIES OF THE INSTITUTE, BUT THEY SHALL HAVE N RSHIPSHALLBEHALFTHEDUESFORASSOCIATEMEMBERSHIP. O COMMUNICATIONS DEPARTMENTS OF UNIVERSITIES AND C NGFIELDS.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSMAYPARTICIPATEINAL YOFTHEEXECUTIVEBOARD.THENUMBEROFTHEIRDELEGATE TIVEBOARD.INSTITUTIONALMEMBERSSHALLHAVENOVOTIN CUTIVE BOARD SHALL BE FIXED BY THE DIRECTOR WITH THE AG LLACTCONTRARYTOTHEPRINCIPLESSETOUTINTHEPRESEN UT EXPULSION SHALL NOT BE ORDERED EXCEPT ON THE APPR R WITH THE STATEMENT OF THE ALLEGED CAUSES, SHALL BE G ALLBEGRANTEDTOSUCHMEMBER,IFTHATMEMBERSHALLSO RAL ASSEMBLY IN WHICH CASE A MAJORITY VOTE OF MEMBER HEINSTITUTE;NOTICEOFSUCHACTIONSHALLBEGIVENEITHER ATIONSTOTHEINSTITUTE,UPTOTHETIMETHATMEMBER’SRES STHATTHEREISFUNDAMENTALCHANGEINTHECONDITIONSU EPRESENTCONSTITUTION.¶ARTICLEIII¶NATIONALCOMMITT ONALCOMMITTEEMAYBEFORMEDPROVISIONALLYINACOUN H RECOGNITION BY THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL NOT NECESS ULLFREEDOMOFTHEPRESS.¶2.NATIONALCOMMITTEESSHA OPMENTSAFFECTINGTHEPRESS,PARTICULARLYONTHREATS ETHEEIGHTYEARTERMLIMIT.¶3.NATIONALCOMMITTEESMAY R THE PURPOSES OF THE INSTITUTE, WITH THE APPROVAL OF TH EDTOTHEDIRECTOR.¶IPICONSTITUTIONPAGE4¶4.THEEXECU ESWHERETHEEXECUTIVEBOARDCONSIDERSTHEOBJECTIVE ACCREDITATIONOFANATIONALCOMMITTEEHASBEENGRANTE EOFMEMBERSOFTHEEXECUTIVEBOARDPRESENT.WRITTENN N, SHALL BE GIVEN TO THE NATIONAL COMMITTEE CONCERNED ATIONSTOTHEEXECUTIVEBOARD,EITHERINWRITINGORBYT VEBOARDSHALLCONSIDERSUCHREPRESENTATIONS.¶ANAT EEXECUTIVEBOARDTOBEINACTIVESHALLHAVETHERIGHTTO SION OF THE INSTITUTE, PROVIDED THAT THE EXECUTIVE BOA SUSPENSIONS OF A NATIONAL COMMITTEE OR THE DECISION AND INSTITUTIONAL MEMBERS IN THAT COUNTRY TO CONTINU NATIONALCOMMITTEEORDECLARESANATIONALCOMMITTEE OURAGED TO HOLD THEIR OWN "MEDIA EVENTS" IN THE FORM SS-ORIENTED ISSUE WHICH HAS A BEARING ON EDITORIAL AC VEFREEDOMOFEXPRESSIONAND/ORFREEDOMOFTHEMEDIA E MEDIA. ¶ 2. THEIR TASK SHALL BE TO: ¶ · ADVISE THE EXECUT Photo material was researched by the International Press Institute. Every effort has been made to identify copyright holders, in case of oversight, and upon notification to the publisher, corrections will be made in subsequent printings. Unless otherwise noted, all photos are from the IPI’s collection. © AFP [2010]: p 41, top left and middle left; p 58, bottom. Agencja Gazeta/ Krzysztof Miller: p 89, top right. Agencja Gazeta/Piotr Wójcik: p 88. AP Photo: p 18, top, middle; p 19, top right; p 53, middle right; p 56; p 61, lower right; p 62, right and top left; p 64; p 92; p 124, top. AP Photo/Alexander Andjic: p 86, lower left. AP Photo/Aris Saris: p 129, top. AP Photo/Collin Reid: p 69, right. AP Photo/Darko Vojinovic: p 86, right. AP Photo/David Pickoff: p 63. AP Photo/Eduardo di Baia: p 125. AP Photo/Eric Risberg: p 62, bottom. AP Photo/Francisco Rivas: p 38, lower left. AP Photo/Heribert Proepper: p 19, lower right. AP Photo/HO: p 18, bottom. AP Photo/Hussein Malla: p 41, top right. AP Photo/Ibrahim Usta: p 117. AP Photo/Jacques Brinon: p 60. AP Photo/Javier Galeano: p 113, top right and bottom right. AP Photo/Joel Merino: p 33. AP Photo/Milliyet: page 73, top right. AP Photo/Misha Japaridze: p 102, right. AP Photo/Murad Sezer: p 49, bottom. AP Photo/Raoul Fornezza: p 93. AP Photo/Rodrigo Abd: p 135. AP Photo/Rosario Esposito: p 65. AP Photo/Sasa Kralj: p 90, top right. AP Photo/Schaber: p 53, left. AP Photo/Str: p 19, top left. AP Photo/Themba Hadebe: p 99. AP Photo/Vahid Salemi: p 59. Archiwum Uniwersytetu Warszawskiego (University of Warsaw’s Archive): p 89, lower right. Aubrey Makilan/Bulatlat: p 31, top. Avusa Media Library: p 57. Bony Mbouwe: p 20, bottom; p 98. B92: p 87. Daoud Kuttab: p 77. David T. Hill: p 81, left and right. Didien Malifa: p 84. Dogan Özgüden Archive: p 73, bottom. El Espectador/Cano Family Archive: p 34. El Periódico: p 134. Eugenio Fontán: pp 54-55. Flor Ruiz: p 126, top right and lower right. Fred M’membe: p 90, top left and lower left. Freedom Neruda: pp 96-97. Galina Salova-Lyubarskaya: pp 82-83. Getty Images: p 53, top right and lower right; p 69, left; p 78, bottom; p 89, left. Gwen Lister: p 78, top, middle right and middle left. Hayer Family Archive: pp 70-71. IAPA: p 101. Kemal Kurspahic Private Archive: p 72, bottom; p 75. K.L. Kamat: p 119. Lydia Cacho: p 32. Michelene Baaklini: p 41, bottom. Nizar Nayouf: pp 94-95. Owais Aslam Ali: p 16, left and lower right. Pap Saine: p 110, right and top left. Prime Time Crime/ Tomislav Peternik: p 74, top. REUTERS/Alexander Demianchuk: p 102, top left. REUTERS/Alexander Natruskin: p 102, lower left. REUTERS/Bobby Yip: p 61, top. REUTERS/Carlos Linares: p 27. REUTERS/Claudia Daut: p 106, bottom; p 107. REUTERS/Denis Sinyakov: p 103. REUTERS/Enrique de la Osa: p 113, top left, lower left and middle left. REUTERS/Louafi Larbi: p 21. REUTERS/Michael Dalder: p 47, top. REUTERS/Michael Urban: p 19, lower left. REUTERS/Mohamed Azakir: p 40. REUTERS/Morteza Nikoubazl: p 58, top right. REUTERS/Petar Kujundzic: p 86, top left. REUTERS/Punit Paranjpe: p 118, bottom. REUTERS/Raheb Homavandi: p 58, top left. REUTERS/Siphiwe Sibeko: p 110, lower left. REUTERS/STR New: p 20, top; p 26; p 50; p 61, lower left; p 76. REUTERS/STR Old: p 124, bottom. REUTERS/Stringer: p 49, top. REUTERS/Stringer Turkey: p 48. REUTERS/Vijay Mathur: p 118, top left. Siv Dolmen: p 68. The Post: p 90, lower right; p 91. Thokozile Qoboza: p 105. Ulysses Award/Sergio Uday: p 126, left. Wickrematunge Family Archive: pp 130-131. Yomiuri Shimbun: pp 66-67. 143 OFHERORHISDEPUTIES.INGENERAL,COMMITTEEMEMBERSH ESTABLISHEDTOOVERSEETHEACTIVITIESOFTHEIPIPRESSFREE ECUTIVESANDACADEMICSINTHEFIELDOFCOMMUNICATION,W F THE INSTITUTE. THIS PERMANENT COMMITTEE MAY ALSO DE AL ASSEMBLIES ¶ 1. GENERAL ASSEMBLIES OF THE ENTIRE MEM PURPOSE OF THE GENERAL ASSEMBLIES IS TO PROVIDE A MEET BOTHORGANISEDANDINFORMALDISCUSSIONOFNEWSPAPE E PROBLEMS OF THE COUNTRY OR THE REGION IN WHICH THE C IONALISSUESOFTHEDAY.ASSEMBLYARRANGEMENTSMAYV ENERAL PROGRAMME AND POLICY, ELECT THE EXECUTIVE BOA AMENDMENTS TO THE CONSTITUTION PROVIDED THAT PROPO DATE.UNDERTHESAMECONDITIONSTHEYSHALLHAVEPOWE , IN SO FAR AS POSSIBLE. THE SITE AND DATE OF EACH GENERA L ASSEMBLY. ¶ 3. THE CHAIRPERSON OF THE EXECUTIVE BOAR FULL MEMBER PRESENT HAVING ONE VOTE. BALLOTING TO EL AND SECONDED. ¶ 5. NOMINATIONS FOR ELECTION TO THE EXEC NADVANCEOFTHEGENERALASSEMBLYTHEDIRECTORMUSTS MEMBERSOFTHEEXECUTIVEBOARDWHOSETERMSAREEXPIR ¶ 1. THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL HAVE FULL SUPERVISION OF T VITIES TO THE GENERAL ASSEMBLY. IT SHALL MEET AS OFTEN A ALL SELECT THE PLACE FOR EACH OF ITS MEETINGS. NOTICE OF OARD SHALL CONSIST OF 24 MEMBERS WHO SHALL BE ELECTED SIBLE,TOGEOGRAPHICALDISTRIBUTION,MEDIASKILLSANDG RM BOARD MEMBERS MAY OFFER THEMSELVES FOR RE-ELECTI MAY,AFTERFOURYEARSOUTOFOFFICE,BEELECTEDAGAIN.¶T HEORHEWASENGAGEDIN–I.E.RELATEDTOPRESSOREDITORI S PRESENT HAVE SO VOTED. WRITTEN NOTICE OF THE CONSID VEBOARDANDAHEARINGBYTHEBOARDSHALLBEGRANTED GENERALASSEMBLY.¶3.THEDUTIESOFTHENEWEXECUTIVEB D THREE VICE-CHAIRPERSONS REPRESENTING SO FAR AS PRAC FINED AS AFRICA, THE AMERICAS, ASIA AND THE PACIFIC AND CUTIVEBOARD,WHOWOULDNOTBEELIGIBLEFORSERVICEON S SHALL CONSTITUTE THE WORKING COMMITTEE OF THE EXEC ONS OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD. TWO ADDITIONAL MEMBERS M LLONLYBEELIGIBLEFORRE-ELECTIONFORAFURTHERSUCCES TE TO ANY MEETING ANY PERSON WHO HAS PARTICULAR COM BOARDBEPREVENTEDFROMTAKINGPARTATMEETINGOFTHE HORITY. ¶ 5. THE MEMBERS OF THE EXECUTIVE BOARD SHALL H HEEXECUTIVEBOARDSHALLHAVEPOWERTOACCREDITNATI NSTITUTION.¶7.TOIMPROVECOMMUNICATIONANDTHEFLOW O SET UP AN IPI FORUM, THAT IS, A SPECIAL MEETING OF THE BO INdeX Deceased 124 Jacobo Timerman 44 Júlio de Mesquita Neto 122 U Thaung 98 Pius Njawé 68 Tara Singh Hayer 34 Guillermo Cano 100 Germán Ornes 24 Hubert Beuve-Méry 18 Rudolf Augstein 128 Eleni Vlachou 80 Mochtar Lubis 62 Veronica Guerin 92 Indro Montanelli 64 Shiro Hara 42 Suk-Chae Choi 26 J. Jesús Blancornelas 38 Pedro Joaquín Chamorro 16 Aslam Ali 30 José Burgos, Jr. 102 Anna Politkovskaya 82 Kronid Lyubarsky 120 André Sibomana 54 Laurence Gandar* 104 Percy Qoboza 52 Antonio Fontán 132 C.E.L. Wickremesinghe 130 Lasantha Wickrematunge* 72 Abdi İpekçi 48 Hrant Dink* 60 Katharine Graham Argentina Brazil Burma Cameroon Canada Colombia Dominican Republic France Germany Greece Indonesia Ireland Italy Japan Korea Mexico Nicaragua Pakistan Philippines Russia Russia Rwanda South Africa South Africa Spain Sri Lanka Sri Lanka Turkey Turkey United States of America Living 20 Omar Belhouchet 74 Kemal Kurspahić 36 Juan Pablo Cárdenas 58 Gao Yu 96 Freedom Neruda 106 Raúl Rivero 112 Yoani Sánchez* 46 Jiří Dienstbier 110 Pap Saine* 134 José Rubén Zamora 118 Arun Shourie 56 Akbar Ganji* 114 Faraj Sarkohi 66 Amira Hass 40 May Chidiac* 22 Kenneth Best 32 Lydia Cacho* 78 Gwen Lister 28 Grémah Boukar Koura 76 Daoud Kuttab 126 Ricardo Uceda 88 Adam Michnik 108 Nuno Rocha 84 Savea Sano Malifa 86 Veran Matić 94 Nizar Nayouf 116 Nedim Şener* 50 Harold Evans 70 Đoàn Viˆ et Hoa∙t 90 Fred M’membe Algeria Bosnia and Herzegovina Chile China Côte d'Ivoire Cuba Cuba Czech Republic The Gambia Guatemala India Iran Iran Israel Lebanon Liberia Mexico Namibia Niger Palestine Peru Poland Portugal Samoa Serbia Syria Turkey United Kingdom Vietnam Zambia * These journalists were named IPI World Press Freedom Heroes in 2006, 2007 and 2010. The 50 remaining Heroes were selected in 2000. 145 147